22_CHEV_Spark_COV_en_US_84816219A_2021APR20.pdf 1 4/16/2021 9:58:04 AM
C
M
Y
CM
MY
CY
CMY
K
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Contents
Introduction
Refer to the purchase documentation
relating to your specific vehicle to confirm
the features.
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Keys, Doors, and Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Seats and Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Keep this manual in the vehicle for quick
reference.
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Instruments and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Driving and Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Service and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Customer Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Connected Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Litho in U.S.A.
Part No. 84816219 A First Printing
not be available in your region, or changes
subsequent to the printing of this owner’s
manual.
The names, logos, emblems, slogans, vehicle
model names, and vehicle body designs
appearing in this manual including, but not
limited to, GM, the GM logo, CHEVROLET,
the CHEVROLET Emblem, and SPARK are
trademarks and/or service marks of General
Motors LLC, its subsidiaries, affiliates,
or licensors.
For vehicles first sold in Canada, substitute
the name “General Motors of Canada
Company” for Chevrolet Motor Division
wherever it appears in this manual.
This manual describes features that may or
may not be on the vehicle because of
optional equipment that was not purchased
on the vehicle, model variants, country
specifications, features/applications that may
Canadian Vehicle Owners
A French language manual can be obtained
from your dealer, at www.helminc.com,
or from:
Propriétaires Canadiens
On peut obtenir un exemplaire de ce guide
en français auprès du concessionnaire ou à
l'adresse suivante:
Helm, Incorporated
Attention: Customer Service
47911 Halyard Drive
Plymouth, MI 48170
USA
©
2021 General Motors LLC. All Rights Reserved.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
2
Introduction
Using this Manual
Vehicle Symbol Chart
To quickly locate information about the
vehicle, use the Index in the back of the
manual. It is an alphabetical list of what is
in the manual and the page number where
it can be found.
Here are some additional symbols that may
be found on the vehicle and what they
mean. See the features in this manual for
information.
Danger, Warning, and Caution
Warning messages found on vehicle labels
and in this manual describe hazards and
what to do to avoid or reduce them.
{ Danger
Danger indicates a hazard with a high
level of risk which will result in serious
injury or death.
A circle with a slash through it is a safety
symbol which means “Do not,” “Do not do
this,” or “Do not let this happen.”
Symbols
The vehicle has components and labels that
use symbols instead of text. Symbols are
shown along with the text describing the
operation or information relating to a
specific component, control, message, gauge,
or indicator.
M : Shown when the owner’s manual has
{ Warning
Warning indicates a hazard that could
result in injury or death.
additional instructions or information.
* : Shown when the service manual has
additional instructions or information.
0 : Shown when there is more information
Caution
Caution indicates a hazard that could
result in property or vehicle damage.
on another page — “see page.”
u : Air Conditioning System
G : Air Conditioning Refrigerant Oil
9 : Airbag Readiness Light
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)
$ : Brake System Warning Light
9 : Dispose of Used Components Properly
P : Do Not Apply High Pressure Water
B : Engine Coolant Temperature
_ : Flame/Fire Prohibited
H : Flammable
[ : Forward Collision Alert
R : Fuse Block Cover Lock Location
+ : Fuses
j : ISOFIX/LATCH System Child Restraints
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Introduction
Q : Keep Fuse Block Covers Properly
Installed
| : Lane Change Alert
@ : Lane Departure Warning
A : Lane Keep Assist
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp
: : Oil Pressure
X : Park Assist
~ : Pedestrian Ahead Indicator
O : Power
7 : Rear Cross Traffic Alert
I : Registered Technician
/ : Remote Vehicle Start
h : Risk of Electrical Fire
> : Seat Belt Reminders
I : Side Blind Zone Alert
7 : Tire Pressure Monitor
d : Traction Control/StabiliTrak/Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)
a : Under Pressure
k : Vehicle Ahead Indicator
3
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
4
Introduction
Instrument Panel Overview
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Introduction
1. Air Vents 0 119.
2. Exterior Lamp Controls 0 91.
Instrument Panel Illumination Control
0 94.
3. Turn and Lane-Change Signals 0 93.
Driver Information Center (DIC) Controls.
See Driver Information Center (DIC) 0 82.
4. Instrument Cluster 0 71.
Driver Information Center (DIC) Display.
See Driver Information Center (DIC) 0 82.
5. Windshield Wiper/Washer 0 68.
Rear Window Wiper/Washer 0 69.
6. Hazard Warning Flashers 0 93.
7. Light Sensor. See Automatic Headlamp
System 0 92.
8. Infotainment. See Introduction 0 96.
9. Power Outlets 0 70.
10. Climate Control Systems 0 117.
11. Heated Front Seats 0 28 (If Equipped).
12. Shift Lever. See Automatic Transmission
0 141 (If Equipped) or Manual
Transmission 0 142 (If Equipped).
13. Parking Brake 0 144.
14. Auxiliary Jack 0 105.
15. Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) 0 134
or
Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 132.
16. Steering Wheel Controls 0 68 (If
Equipped).
17. Horn 0 68.
18. Steering Wheel Adjustment 0 68 (Out
of View).
19. Cruise Control 0 147 (If Equipped).
Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System
0 152 (If Equipped).
20. Traction Control/Electronic Stability
Control 0 145.
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) 0 154 (If
Equipped).
21. Instrument Panel Fuse Block 0 187.
22. Hood Release. See Hood 0 161.
23. Data Link Connector (DLC) (Out of View).
See Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Check
Engine Light) 0 75.
5
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
6
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Keys, Doors, and
Windows
Keys and Locks
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . 8
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Key Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Doors
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Vehicle Security
Vehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Vehicle Alarm System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Immobilizer Operation (Key Access) . . . . . 19
Immobilizer Operation (Keyless
Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Exterior Mirrors
Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Interior Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Manual Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Windows
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Manual Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Roof
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Keys and Locks
Keys
{ Warning
Leaving children in a vehicle with the
ignition key is dangerous and children or
others could be seriously injured or killed.
They could operate the power windows
or other controls or make the vehicle
move. The windows will function with
the keys in the ignition, and children or
others could be caught in the path of a
closing window. Do not leave children in
a vehicle with the ignition key.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
{ Warning
If the key is unintentionally rotated while
the vehicle is running, the ignition could
be moved out of the RUN position. This
could be caused by heavy items hanging
from the key ring, or by large or long
items attached to the key ring that could
be contacted by the driver or steering
wheel. If the ignition moves out of the
RUN position, the engine will shut off,
braking and steering power assist may be
impacted, and airbags may not deploy.
To reduce the risk of unintentional
rotation of the ignition key, do not
change the way the ignition key and
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter,
if equipped, are connected to the
provided key rings.
The ignition key and key rings, and RKE
transmitter, if equipped, are designed to
work together as a system to reduce the
risk of unintentionally moving the key out
of the RUN position. The ignition key has a
small hole to allow attachment of the
provided key ring. It is important that any
replacement ignition keys have a small hole.
See your dealer if a replacement key is
required.
The combination and size of the rings that
came with your keys were specifically
selected for your vehicle. The rings are
connected to the key like two links of a
chain to reduce the risk of unintentionally
moving the key out of the RUN position. Do
not add any additional items to the ring
attached to the ignition key. Attach
additional items only to the second ring,
and limit added items to a few essential
keys or small, light items no larger than an
RKE transmitter.
Interference from radio-frequency
identification (RFID) tags may prevent the
key from starting the vehicle. Keep RFID
tags away from the key when starting the
vehicle.
7
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
8
Keys, Doors, and Windows
The key that is part of the Remote Keyless
Entry (RKE) transmitter can be used for the
ignition and all locks.
If it becomes difficult to turn the key,
inspect the key blade for debris. Periodically
clean with a brush or pick.
Press the button on the front of the RKE
transmitter to extend the key. Never extend
the key without pressing the button.
If you are locked out of the vehicle, see
Roadside Assistance Program 0 244.
Press the button and the key blade to
retract the key.
With an active OnStar or connected service
plan, an OnStar Advisor may remotely
unlock the vehicle. See OnStar Overview
0 252.
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System
LS
See Radio Frequency Statement 0 248.
2LT
The 2LT key can be used for all locks. This
vehicle has pushbutton start.
1LT
Press the button on the side of the RKE
transmitter to release the key. Never take
the key out without pressing the button.
See your dealer if a new key is needed.
If there is a decrease in the Remote Keyless
Entry (RKE) operating range:
. Check the distance. The transmitter may
be too far from the vehicle.
. Check the location. Other vehicles or
objects may be blocking the signal.
. Check the transmitter's battery. See
“Battery Replacement” later in this
section.
. If the transmitter is still not working
correctly, see your dealer or a qualified
technician for service.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System Operation (Key Access)
The RKE transmitter may work up to 60 m
(167 ft) away from the vehicle.
Other conditions can affect the performance
of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) System 0 8.
If the driver door is open when Q is pressed
and Open Door Anti Lock Out is enabled
through the vehicle personalization, all doors
will lock and then the driver door will
immediately unlock. If the passenger door is
open when Q is pressed, all doors lock. See
Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
Pressing Q may also arm the theft-deterrent
system. See Vehicle Alarm System 0 18.
K : Press to unlock the driver door and the
Programming with Two Recognized Keys
See Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
Pressing K may also disarm the
theft-deterrent system. See Vehicle Alarm
System 0 18.
The following buttons are on the
transmitter:
Q : Press once to lock all doors, the fuel
door, and the liftgate. The turn signal
indicators may flash and/or the horn may
sound on the second press to indicate
locking.
Programming Keys to the Vehicle
Only keys programmed to this vehicle will
work. If a key is lost or stolen, a
replacement can be purchased and
programmed through your dealer. When the
replacement key is programmed to this
vehicle, all remaining keys must also be
reprogrammed. Any lost or stolen keys will
no longer work once the new key is
programmed.
fuel door. Press again within five seconds to
unlock all doors and the liftgate. The turn
signal indicators flash to indicate unlocking
has occurred.
1LT
9
7 : Press and release one time to initiate
vehicle locator. The exterior lamps flash and
the horn chirps three times. Press and hold
7 for at least three seconds to sound the
panic alarm. The horn sounds and the turn
signals flash for 30 seconds, or until 7 is
pressed again, or the key is placed in the
ignition and turned on.
To program a new key:
1. Insert the original, already programmed
key in the ignition and turn the ignition
on without starting the vehicle.
2. Turn the ignition off, and remove
the key.
3. Quickly, within five seconds, insert the
second original already programmed key
in the ignition and turn the ignition on
without starting the vehicle.
4. Turn the ignition off, and remove
the key.
5. Insert the new key to be programmed,
and within five seconds, turn the ignition
on without starting the vehicle.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
10
Keys, Doors, and Windows
The security light will turn off once the
key has been programmed.
6. Repeat Steps 1–5 if additional keys are to
be programmed.
If a key is lost or damaged, see your dealer
to have a new key made.
Programming without a Recognized Key
Program a new key to the vehicle when a
recognized key is not available. Canadian
regulations require that owners see their
dealer.
If two currently recognized keys are not
available, follow this procedure to program
the first key.
This procedure will take approximately
30 minutes to complete for the first key.
The vehicle must be off and all of the keys
you wish to program must be with you.
1. Insert the new vehicle key into the
ignition.
2. Turn the ignition on without starting the
vehicle. The security light will come on.
3. Wait 10 minutes until the security light
turns off.
4. Turn the ignition off.
5. Repeat Steps 2–4 two more times. After
the third time, turn the ignition on
without starting the vehicle; the key is
learned and all previously known keys
will no longer work with the vehicle.
6. To program the second key, turn the
ignition off and insert the second key to
be learned and turn the ignition on
without starting the vehicle.
After the two keys are learned, remaining
keys can be learned by following the
procedure in “Programming with Two
Recognized Keys.”
Battery Replacement (1LT Only)
Caution
When replacing the battery, do not touch
any of the circuitry on the transmitter.
Static from your body could damage the
transmitter.
Caution
If the RKE transmitter is not reassembled
properly, liquids could enter the housing
and damage the circuitry, resulting in an
RKE transmitter malfunction and/or
failure. To prevent damage, always follow
the steps for RKE transmitter reassembly
in this manual to ensure the transmitter
is sealed properly whenever the RKE
transmitter is opened.
The battery is not rechargeable. To replace
the battery:
1. Press the button on the side of the RKE
transmitter to extend the key. Never pull
the key out without pressing the button.
2. Remove the battery cover by prying it
with a finger.
3. Remove the battery by pushing on the
battery and sliding it toward the key
blade.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Pressing Q may also arm the theft-deterrent
system. See Vehicle Alarm System 0 18.
4. Insert the new battery, positive side
facing up. Push the battery down until it
is held in place. Replace with a CR2032 or
equivalent battery.
5. Ensure that the silicon mat is correctly
positioned with no gaps or wrinkles.
6. Set transmitter button side down on a
hard surface and press the other half
straight down to force the halves
together.
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System Operation (Keyless Access)
The Keyless Access system allows for vehicle
entry when the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft). See “Keyless
Access Operation” later in this section.
The RKE transmitter may work up to 60 m
(167 ft) away from the vehicle.
Other conditions can affect the performance
of the RKE transmitter. See Remote Keyless
Entry (RKE) System 0 8.
11
K : Press to unlock the driver door and the
fuel door. Press again within five seconds to
unlock all doors and the liftgate. The turn
signal indicators flash to indicate unlocking
has occurred.
See Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
2LT
The following buttons are on the
transmitter:
Q : Press once to lock all doors, the fuel
door, and the liftgate. The turn signal
indicators may flash and/or the horn may
sound on the second press to indicate
locking.
If the driver door is open when Q is pressed
and Open Door Anti Lock Out is enabled
through the vehicle personalization, all doors
will lock and then the driver door will
immediately unlock. If the passenger door is
open when Q is pressed, all doors lock. See
Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
Pressing K may also disarm the
theft-deterrent system. See Vehicle Alarm
System 0 18.
7 : Press and release one time to initiate
vehicle locator. The exterior lamps flash and
the horn chirps three times. Press and hold
7 for at least three seconds to sound the
panic alarm. The horn sounds and the turn
signals flash for 30 seconds, or until 7 is
pressed again or the ignition is turned on.
Keyless Access Operation
If equipped, the Keyless Access system lets
you lock and unlock the doors and access
the liftgate without removing the RKE
transmitter from your pocket, purse,
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
12
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Keyless Unlocking/Locking from the
Passenger Doors
briefcase, etc. The RKE transmitter should be
within 1 m (3 ft) of the liftgate or door being
opened. If the vehicle has this feature, there
will be buttons on the outside front door
handles.
When the doors are locked and the RKE
transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft) of the
passenger door handle, pressing the lock/
unlock button on the passenger door handle
will unlock all doors.
The vehicle can be customized to always
unlock all doors on the first lock/unlock
button press. See Vehicle Personalization
0 88.
Keyless Unlocking/Locking from the
Driver Door
When the doors are locked and the RKE
transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft) of the driver
door handle, pressing the lock/unlock button
on the driver door handle will unlock the
driver door. If the lock/unlock button is
pressed again within five seconds, all
passenger doors will unlock. Pull the door
handle to unlatch the door.
Driver Side Shown, Passenger Similar
Pressing the lock/unlock button will cause
all doors to lock if any of the following
occur:
. It has been no more than five seconds
since the first lock/unlock button press.
. Two lock/unlock button presses were
used to unlock all doors.
. Any vehicle door has opened and all
doors are now closed.
Pressing the lock/unlock button will cause
all doors to lock if any of the following
occur:
. The lock/unlock button was used to
unlock all doors.
. Any vehicle door has opened and all
doors are now closed.
Disable/Enable Keyless Unlocking of Exterior
Door Handles and Liftgate
If equipped, keyless unlocking of the exterior
door handles and liftgate can be disabled
and enabled.
Disabling Keyless Unlocking:
With the vehicle off, press and hold Q and
K on the RKE transmitter at the same time
for approximately three seconds. The turn
signal lamps will flash four times quickly to
indicate access is disabled. Using any
exterior handle to unlock the doors or open
the liftgate will cause the turn signal lamps
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
to flash four times quickly, indicating access
is disabled. If disabled, disarm the alarm
system before starting the vehicle.
Enabling Keyless Unlocking:
With the vehicle off, press and hold Q and
K on the RKE transmitter at the same time
for approximately three seconds. The turn
signal lamps will flash twice quickly to
indicate access is enabled.
Passive Locking
If equipped with Keyless Access, the vehicle
will lock several seconds after all doors are
closed if the vehicle is off and at least one
transmitter has been removed or none
remain in the vehicle.
The fuel door will lock.
If other electronic devices interfere with the
RKE transmitter signal, the vehicle may not
detect the RKE transmitter inside the vehicle.
If passive locking is enabled, the doors may
lock with the RKE transmitter inside the
vehicle. Do not leave the RKE transmitter in
an unattended vehicle.
13
Temporary Disable of Passive Locking
Keyless Liftgate Opening
Temporarily disable passive locking by
pressing and holding K on the interior door
switch with a door open for at least
four seconds, or until three chimes are
heard. Passive locking will then remain
disabled until Q on the interior door is
pressed, or until the vehicle is turned on.
To open the liftgate, press the touch pad on
the rear of the liftgate above the license
plate. The doors must be unlocked or the
RKE transmitter must be within 1 m (3 ft).
To customize the doors to automatically lock
when exiting the vehicle, see Vehicle
Personalization 0 88.
Remote Left In Vehicle Alert
When the vehicle is turned off and an RKE
transmitter is left in the vehicle, the horn
will chirp three times after all doors are
closed. To turn on or off see Vehicle
Personalization 0 88.
Remote No Longer in Vehicle Alert
If the vehicle is on with a door open, and
then all doors are closed, the vehicle will
check for RKE transmitters inside. If an RKE
transmitter is not detected, the Driver
Information Center (DIC) will display NO
REMOTE DETECTED and the horn will chirp
three times. This occurs only once each time
the vehicle is driven. To turn on or off see
Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
Key Access
To access a vehicle with a weak transmitter
battery, see Door Locks 0 15.
Programming Transmitters to the Vehicle
Only RKE transmitters programmed to the
vehicle will work. If a transmitter is lost or
stolen, a replacement can be purchased and
programmed through your dealer. The
vehicle can be reprogrammed so that lost or
stolen transmitters no longer work. Any
remaining transmitters will need to be
reprogrammed. Each vehicle can have up to
eight transmitters matched to it.
Starting the Vehicle with a Low
Transmitter Battery
If the RKE transmitter battery is weak, the
DIC may display NO REMOTE DETECTED
when trying to start the vehicle. The DIC
may also display REPLACE BATTERY IN
REMOTE KEY.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
14
Keys, Doors, and Windows
For improved vehicle security, the RKE
transmitter is equipped with a motion
sensor. When starting the vehicle, if the RKE
transmitter has been idle for a while, move
the RKE transmitter slightly and try starting
the vehicle. When starting the vehicle, if the
RKE transmitter battery is depleted or there
is signal interference, the DIC may display
NO REMOTE DETECTED, REPLACE BATTERY IN
KEY, or NO REMOTE DETECTED PLACE KEY IN
KEY POCKET THEN START YOUR VEHICLE,
follow the steps shown below.
To start the vehicle:
1. Place the RKE transmitter in the
transmitter pocket with the buttons
facing the front of the vehicle.
2. With the vehicle in P (Park) or
N (Neutral), press the brake pedal, and
press ENGINE START/STOP.
Replace the transmitter battery as soon
as possible.
Battery Replacement (2LT Only)
Replace the battery in the transmitter soon
if the DIC displays REPLACE BATTERY IN
REMOTE KEY.
{ Warning
Never allow children to play with the RKE
transmitter. The transmitter contains a
small battery, which can be a choking
hazard. If swallowed, internal burns can
occur, resulting in severe injury or death.
Seek medical attention immediately if a
battery is swallowed.
{ Warning
To avoid personal injury, do not touch
metal surfaces on the RKE transmitter
when it has been exposed to extreme
heat. These surfaces can be hot to the
touch at temperatures above 59 °C
(138 °F).
Caution
When replacing the battery, do not touch
any of the circuitry on the transmitter.
Static from your body could damage the
transmitter.
Caution
Always replace the battery with the
correct type. Replacing the battery with
an incorrect type could potentially create
a risk of battery explosion. Dispose of
used batteries according to instructions
and local laws. Do not attempt to burn,
crush, or cut the used battery, and avoid
exposing the battery to environments
with extremely low air pressures or high
temperatures.
Caution
If the RKE transmitter is not reassembled
properly, liquids could enter the housing
and damage the circuitry, resulting in an
RKE transmitter malfunction and/or
failure. To prevent damage, always follow
the steps for RKE transmitter reassembly
in this manual to ensure the transmitter
is sealed properly whenever the RKE
transmitter is opened.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
To replace the battery:
7. Set transmitter button side down on a
hard surface and press the other half
straight down to force the halves
together.
8. Reinsert the key.
Door Locks
{ Warning
Unlocked doors can be dangerous.
. Passengers, especially children, can
1. Remove the key from the RKE
transmitter.
2. Insert a flat, thin object in the center of
the transmitter to separate and remove
the back cover.
3. Lift the battery with a flat object.
4. Remove the battery.
5. Insert the new battery, positive side
toward the back cover. Replace with a
CR2032 or equivalent battery.
6. Ensure that the silicon mat is correctly
positioned with no gaps or wrinkles.
easily open the doors and fall out of a
moving vehicle. The doors can be
unlocked and opened while the vehicle
is moving. The chance of being thrown
out of the vehicle in a crash is
increased if the doors are not locked.
So, all passengers should wear seat
belts properly and the doors should be
locked whenever the vehicle is driven.
. Young children who get into unlocked
vehicles may be unable to get out.
A child can be overcome by extreme
heat and can suffer permanent injuries
or even death from heat stroke.
Always lock the vehicle whenever
leaving it.
(Continued)
15
Warning (Continued)
. Outsiders can easily enter through an
unlocked door when you slow down
or stop the vehicle. Locking the doors
can help prevent this from happening.
To lock or unlock the doors from outside the
vehicle, use the key in the driver door or
press Q or K on the RKE transmitter. See
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Key Access) 0 9 or
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) 0 11.
Keyless Access
If equipped, the RKE transmitter must be
within 1 m (3 ft) of the door or liftgate being
opened.
Press the button on the door handle to
open. See “Keyless Access Operation” under
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Key Access) 0 9 or
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) 0 11.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
16
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Power Door Locks
When Q is pressed on the power door lock
switch while the door is open, a chime will
sound three times indicating delayed locking
is active.
. If equipped with a manual transmission,
The doors will lock automatically
five seconds after all doors are closed. If a
door is reopened before that time, the
five-second timer will reset when all doors
are closed again.
Lockout Protection
Press Q on the door lock switch again or
press Q on the RKE transmitter to lock the
doors immediately.
To lock and unlock the doors from inside the
vehicle:
. Press Q or K, if equipped.
. Use the lock knob on the top of the door
panel.
Delayed Locking
This feature delays the locking of the doors
until five seconds after all doors are closed.
Delayed locking can only be turned on when
the Open Door Anti-Lockout feature has
been turned off.
This feature can also be programmed. See
Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
Automatic Door Locks
If equipped, when the doors are closed, the
ignition is on, and the shift lever is moved
out of P (Park) for automatic transmissions,
or the vehicle speed is above 13 km/h
(8 mph) for manual transmissions, the doors
and the liftgate will lock.
To unlock the doors and the liftgate:
. Press K on the door.
. If equipped with an automatic
transmission, shift the transmission into
P (Park).
remove the key from the ignition.
Automatic unlocking can be programmed.
See Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
Key Access : When locking is requested with
the driver door open and the key in the
ignition, all the doors will lock and then the
driver door will unlock.
This can be manually overridden by pressing
and holding Q on the power door lock
switch.
Keyless Access : When locking is requested
with the driver door open and the vehicle is
on or in ACC/ACCESSORY, all the doors will
lock and then the driver door will unlock.
If the vehicle is off and locking is requested
while a door is open, when all doors are
closed the vehicle will check for RKE
transmitters inside. If an RKE transmitter is
detected and the number of RKE
transmitters inside has not reduced, the
driver door will unlock and the horn will
sound three times.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
This can be manually overridden by pressing
and holding Q on the power door lock
switch.
Open Door Anti-Lockout
If Open Door Anti-Lockout is turned on and
the vehicle is off, the driver door is open,
and locking is requested, all the doors will
lock and the driver door will remain open.
The Open Door Anti-Lockout feature can be
turned on or off. See Vehicle Personalization
0 88.
Safety Locks
Using the Rear Door Safety Lock
1. Move the lever up to lock.
2. Close the door.
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 for the other rear
door lock.
Caution
Pulling the inside door handle while the
rear door safety locks are engaged could
damage your vehicle. Do not pull the
inside door handle while the rear door
safety locks are engaged.
The rear doors on the vehicle cannot be
opened from the inside while this feature is
in use.
Opening a Rear Door When the Safety
Lock Is On
1. Unlock the door from the inside.
2. Open the door from the outside.
For the rear doors to open from the inside,
the safety locks have to be moved back to
the unlock position.
The vehicle has rear door safety locks on
each rear door that prevent passengers from
opening the rear doors from the inside.
Canceling a Rear Door Safety Lock
1. Unlock the door from the inside and
open the door from the outside.
17
2. Move the lever down to unlock.
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 for the other rear
door lock.
The rear door locks can now be locked and
unlocked normally.
Doors
Liftgate
{ Warning
Exhaust gases can enter the vehicle if it
is driven with the liftgate, hatch/trunk
open, or with any objects that pass
through the seal between the body and
the hatch/trunk or liftgate. Engine
exhaust contains carbon monoxide (CO)
which cannot be seen or smelled. It can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
If the vehicle must be driven with the
liftgate or hatch/trunk open:
. Close all of the windows.
. Fully open the air outlets on or under
the instrument panel.
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
18
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Vehicle Alarm System
Warning (Continued)
This vehicle has an anti-theft alarm system.
. Adjust the climate control system to a
setting that brings in only outside air
and set the fan speed to the highest
setting. See “Climate Control Systems”
in the Index.
. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power liftgate, disable the power
liftgate function.
For more information about carbon
monoxide, see Engine Exhaust 0 140.
Caution
To avoid damage to the liftgate or
liftgate glass, make sure the area above
and behind the liftgate is clear before
opening it.
To unlock the liftgate, press K on the
power door lock switch or on the RKE
transmitter to unlock all doors. If equipped,
use the key in the key cylinder.
Press the touch pad and lift to open or,
if equipped, pull the handle and lift up.
To lock the liftgate, press Q on the power
door lock switch or on the RKE transmitter.
If equipped, lock using the key in the key
cylinder. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System Operation (Key Access) 0 9 or
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) 0 11.
When closing the liftgate, close from the
center so that it fully latches.
Vehicle Security
This vehicle has theft-deterrent features;
however, they do not make the vehicle
impossible to steal.
The security light, on the instrument panel
near the windshield, indicates the status of
the system:
Off : Alarm system is disarmed.
On Solid : Vehicle is secured during the
delay to arm the system.
Fast Flash : Vehicle is unsecured. A door, the
hood, or the liftgate is open.
Slow Flash : Alarm system is armed.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Arming the Alarm System
1. Turn off the vehicle.
2. Lock the vehicle with one of the
following:
. Use the RKE transmitter.
. With a door open, press Q on the
interior.
3. After 30 seconds the alarm system will
arm, and the indicator light will begin to
slowly flash indicating the alarm system
is operating. Pressing Q on the RKE
transmitter a second time will bypass
the 30-second delay and immediately
arm the alarm system.
The vehicle alarm system will not arm if the
doors are locked with the key.
If the driver door or liftgate is opened
without first unlocking with the RKE
transmitter, the horn will chirp and the
lights will flash to indicate a pre-alarm.
If the vehicle is not started, or the door is
not unlocked by pressing K on the RKE
transmitter during the 10-second pre-alarm,
the alarm will be activated.
The alarm will also be activated if the
passenger door, the liftgate, or the hood is
opened without first disarming the system.
19
When the alarm is activated, the turn
signals flash and the horn sounds for about
30 seconds. The alarm system will then
re-arm to monitor for the next unauthorized
event.
If the alarm has been activated, a message
will appear on the DIC. See Vehicle Messages
(Base Level Cluster) 0 86 or
Vehicle Messages (Uplevel Cluster) 0 87 for
more information.
Disarming the System
Immobilizer
To disarm the system or turn off the alarm
if it has been activated, do one of the
following:
. Press K on the RKE transmitter.
. Start the vehicle.
See Radio Frequency Statement 0 248.
To avoid setting off the alarm by accident:
. Lock the vehicle with the RKE transmitter
after all occupants have left the vehicle
and all doors are closed.
. Always unlock the vehicle with the RKE
transmitter. Unlocking the driver door
with the key will not disarm the alarm.
Unlocking the driver door with the key
will not disarm the system or turn off the
alarm.
How to Detect a Tamper Condition
If K is pressed on the RKE transmitter and
the horn chirps or the lights flash three
times, a previous alarm occurred while the
system was armed.
Immobilizer Operation (Key
Access)
This vehicle has a passive theft-deterrent
system.
The system does not have to be manually
armed or disarmed.
The vehicle is automatically immobilized
when the key is removed from the ignition.
The system is automatically disarmed when
the vehicle is started with the correct key.
The key uses a transponder that matches an
immobilizer control unit in the vehicle and
automatically disarms the system. Only an
authorized key starts the vehicle. The vehicle
may not start if the key is damaged.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
20
Keys, Doors, and Windows
The security light, in the instrument cluster,
comes on if there is a problem with arming
or disarming the theft-deterrent system.
When trying to start the vehicle, the
security light comes on briefly when the
ignition is turned on.
Immobilizer Operation (Keyless
Access)
When trying to start the vehicle, the
security light comes on briefly when the
ignition is turned on.
This vehicle has a passive theft-deterrent
system.
If the engine does not start and the security
light stays on, there is a problem with the
system. Turn the vehicle off and try again.
The system does not have to be manually
armed or disarmed.
The vehicle is automatically immobilized
when the transmitter leaves the vehicle.
The immobilization system is disarmed
when the ignition button is pressed and a
valid transmitter is found in the vehicle.
If the engine does not start and the security
light stays on, there is a problem with the
system. Turn the ignition off and try again.
If the engine still does not start, and the
key appears to be undamaged or the light
continues to stay on, try another ignition
key. If the engine does not start with the
other key, the vehicle needs service. If the
vehicle does start, the first key may be
damaged. See your dealer who can service
the theft-deterrent system and have a new
key made.
Do not leave the key or device that disarms
or deactivates the theft-deterrent system in
the vehicle.
The security light in the instrument cluster
comes on when there is a problem with
arming or disarming the theft-deterrent
system.
The system has one or more transmitters
matched to an immobilizer control unit in
your vehicle. Only a correctly matched
transmitter will start the vehicle. If the
transmitter is ever damaged, you may not
be able to start your vehicle.
If the RKE transmitter appears to be
undamaged, try another transmitter. Or, you
may try placing the transmitter in the
transmitter pocket in the center console. See
“Starting the Vehicle with a Low Transmitter
Battery” under Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System Operation (Key Access) 0 9 or
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) 0 11.
If the engine does not start with the other
transmitter or when the transmitter is in the
pocket in the center console, your vehicle
needs service. See your dealer who can
service the theft-deterrent system and have
a new transmitter programmed to the
vehicle.
Do not leave the transmitter or device that
disarms or deactivates the theft-deterrent
system in the vehicle.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Exterior Mirrors
21
Manual Mirrors
Power Mirrors
If equipped, controls for the outside manual
mirrors are next to each mirror. Adjust to
see a little of the side of the vehicle.
1. If equipped, move the selector switch to
L (Left) or R (Right) to choose the driver
or passenger mirror.
2. Use the control knob to adjust the mirror
so the side and the area behind the
vehicle can be seen.
3. Return the selector switch to the center
when done.
Convex Mirrors
{ Warning
A convex mirror can make things, like
other vehicles, look farther away than
they really are. If you cut too sharply
into the right lane, you could hit a
vehicle on the right. Check the inside
mirror or glance over your shoulder
before changing lanes.
The passenger side mirror is convex shaped.
A convex mirror's surface is curved so more
can be seen from the driver seat.
Folding Mirrors
Manual Folding Mirrors
The vehicle has manual folding mirrors.
These mirrors can be folded inward to
prevent damage when going through an
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
22
Keys, Doors, and Windows
automatic car wash. To fold, pull the mirror
toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward
to return it to the original position.
Manual Rearview Mirror
Heated Mirrors
Push the tab forward for daytime use and
pull it rearward for nighttime use to avoid
glare of the headlamps from behind.
If equipped, the rear window defogger also
heats the outside mirrors.
Windows
1 : Press to heat the outside mirrors.
See “Rear Window Defogger” under Climate
Control Systems 0 117.
Interior Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirrors
Adjust the rearview mirror for a clear view
of the area behind your vehicle.
If equipped with OnStar, the vehicle may
have three control buttons at the bottom of
the mirror. See OnStar Overview 0 252.
To avoid accidental OnStar calls, clean the
mirror with the ignition off. Do not spray
glass cleaner directly on the mirror. Use a
soft towel dampened with water.
The vehicle aerodynamics are designed to
improve fuel economy performance. This
may result in a pulsing sound when either
rear window is down and the front windows
are up. To reduce the sound, open a front
window.
Manual Windows
{ Warning
Never leave a child, a helpless adult, or a
pet alone in a vehicle, especially with the
windows closed in warm or hot weather.
They can be overcome by the extreme
heat and suffer permanent injuries or
even death from heat stroke.
If equipped, turn the hand crank on each
door to manually raise or lower the manual
windows.
The rear windows do not open fully.
Power Windows
{ Warning
Children could be seriously injured or
killed if caught in the path of a closing
window. Never leave keys in a vehicle
with children. When there are children in
the rear seat, use the window lockout
button to prevent operation of the
windows. See Keys 0 6.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Window Express Movement
All windows can be opened without holding
the window switch. Press the switch down
fully and quickly release to express open the
window.
If equipped, pull the window switch up fully
and quickly release to express close the
window.
Briefly press or pull the window switch in
the same direction to stop that window’s
express movement.
Power windows work when the ignition is
on, in ACC/ACCESSORY, or when Retained
Accessory Power (RAP) is active. See
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 138.
Using the window switch, press to open or
pull to close the window.
The windows may be temporarily disabled if
they are used repeatedly within a
short time.
Window Lockout
This feature stops the rear door passenger
window switches from working.
. Press Z to engage the rear window
lockout feature.
. Press Z again to disengage.
Window Automatic Reversal System
The express-close feature will reverse
window movement if it comes in contact
with an object. Extreme cold or ice could
cause the window to auto-reverse. The
window will operate normally after the
object or condition is removed.
Automatic Reversal System Override
{ Warning
If automatic reversal system override is
active, the window will not reverse
automatically. You or others could be
injured and the window could be
(Continued)
23
Warning (Continued)
damaged. Before using automatic reversal
system override, make sure that all
people and obstructions are clear of the
window path.
When the engine is on, override the
automatic reversal system by pulling and
holding the window switch if conditions
prevent it from closing.
Programming the Power Windows
Programming may be necessary if the
vehicle battery has been disconnected or
discharged. If the window is unable to
express-up, program each express-close
window:
1. Close all doors.
2. Turn the ignition on or to ACC/
ACCESSORY.
3. Partially open the window to be
programmed. Then close it and continue
to pull the switch briefly after the
window has fully closed.
4. Open the window and continue to press
the switch briefly after the window has
fully opened.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
24
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Sun Visors
movement. The sunshade automatically
opens with the sunroof, but must be closed
manually.
Pull the sun visor down to block out glare.
Detach the sun visor from the center mount
and swing it to the side.
Close : Press and hold g (2) to close.
Release the switch to stop movement.
Visor Vanity Mirror
The sunroof cannot be opened or closed if
the vehicle has an electrical failure.
The vehicle may have vanity mirrors and
card holders on the back of the sun visors.
Swing down the sun visor to expose the
vanity mirror.
Roof
Sunroof
If equipped, the ignition must be on or in
ACC/ACCESSORY, or Retained Accessory
Power (RAP) must be active to operate the
sunroof. See Ignition Positions (Keyless
Access) 0 134 or
Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 132 and
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 138.
Express-Vent/Open : Press and release
e (1) to express-vent. Press and release
e (1) again to express-open the sunroof.
Press the switch again to stop movement.
The sunshade automatically opens with the
sunroof, but must be closed manually.
Sunroof Comfort Stop Position : This vehicle
may be equipped with a comfort stop to
prevent excessive wind noise. The sunroof
will stop approximately halfway open during
an express open. To fully open the sunroof,
press and release g (1) again.
Vent/Open : Press and hold e (1) to vent.
Press and hold e (1) again to open the
sunroof. Release the switch to stop
Dirt and debris may collect on the sunroof
seal or in the track. This could cause an
issue with sunroof operation or noise.
It could also plug the water drainage
system. Periodically open the sunroof and
remove any obstacles or loose debris. Wipe
the sunroof seal and roof sealing area using
a clean cloth, mild soap, and water. Do not
remove grease from the sunroof.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
Seats and Restraints
Head Restraints
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Front Seats
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Front Seat Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Heated Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Rear Seats
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Seat Belts
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
How to Wear Seat Belts Properly . . . . . . . 32
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Seat Belt Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . 35
Seat Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Safety System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Seat Belt Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Replacing Seat Belt System Parts after a
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Airbag System
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . 40
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . 41
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . 41
What Will You See after an Airbag
Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Servicing the Airbag-Equipped
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Adding Equipment to the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Airbag System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Replacing Airbag System Parts after a
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Child Restraints
25
Head Restraints
{ Warning
With head restraints that are not
installed and adjusted properly, there is a
greater chance that occupants will suffer
a neck/spinal injury in a crash. Do not
drive until the head restraints for all
occupants are installed and adjusted
properly.
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children
(LATCH System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Replacing LATCH System Parts After a
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat
Belt in the Rear Seat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat
Belt in the Front Seat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Adjust the head restraint so that the top of
the restraint is at the same height as the
top of the occupant's head. This position
reduces the chances of a neck injury in a
crash.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
26
Seats and Restraints
Front Seats
Rear Seats
The front seats have adjustable head
restraints in the outboard seating positions.
The vehicle's rear seats have adjustable head
restraints in the outboard seating positions.
If you are installing a child restraint in the
rear seat, see “Head Restraint Removal and
Reinstallation” under Lower Anchors and
Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 53.
Front Seats
Seat Adjustment
Manual Seats
{ Warning
You can lose control of the vehicle if you
try to adjust a driver seat while the
vehicle is moving. Adjust the driver seat
only when the vehicle is not moving.
The height of the head restraint can be
adjusted. Pull the head restraint up to raise
it. Try to move the head restraint to make
sure that it is locked in place.
The height of the head restraint can be
adjusted. Pull the head restraint up to raise
it. Try to move the head restraint to make
sure that it is locked in place.
To lower the head restraint, press the
button, located on the top of the seatback,
and push the head restraint down. Try to
move the head restraint after the button is
released to make sure that it is locked in
place.
To lower the head restraint, press the
button, located on the top of the seatback,
and push the head restraint down. Try to
move the head restraint after the button is
released to make sure that it is locked in
place.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
To adjust the seat:
1. Lift the bar under the front edge of the
seat cushion to unlock the seat.
2. Slide the seat to the desired position and
release the bar.
3. Try to move the seat back and forth to
be sure it is locked in place.
Seat Height Adjuster
Reclining Seatbacks
{ Warning
If either seatback is not locked, it could
move forward in a sudden stop or crash.
That could cause injury to the person
sitting there. Always push and pull on
the seatbacks to be sure they are locked.
27
To return the seatback to the upright
position:
1. Lift the lever fully without applying
pressure to the seatback, and the
seatback will return to the upright
position.
2. Push and pull on the seatback to make
sure it is locked.
{ Warning
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the seat belts
cannot do their job.
The shoulder belt will not be against
your body. Instead, it will be in front of
you. In a crash, you could go into it,
receiving neck or other injuries.
If available, move the lever up or down to
manually raise or lower the seat.
To recline the seatback:
1. Lift the lever.
2. Move the seatback to the desired
position, and then release the lever to
lock the seatback in place.
3. Push and pull on the seatback to make
sure it is locked in place.
The lap belt could go up over your
abdomen. The belt forces would be there,
not at your pelvic bones. This could cause
serious internal injuries.
For proper protection when the vehicle is
in motion, have the seatback upright.
Then sit well back in the seat and wear
the seat belt properly.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
28
Seats and Restraints
There is an armrest on the inboard side of
the driver seat. To raise or lower the
armrest, push up or pull down on the
armrest.
Heated Front Seats
{ Warning
Do not have a seatback reclined if the
vehicle is moving.
Front Seat Armrest
If temperature change or pain to the skin
cannot be felt, the seat heater may cause
burns. To reduce the risk of burns, use
care when using the seat heater,
especially for long periods of time. Do
not place anything on the seat that
insulates against heat, such as a blanket,
cushion, cover, or similar item. This may
cause the seat heater to overheat. An
overheated seat heater may cause a burn
or may damage the seat.
If equipped, the buttons are on the center
console. To operate, the engine must be
running.
Press L or M to heat the driver or
passenger seat. The indicator light on the
control turns on when this feature is on.
Press the control again to turn this
feature off.
The passenger seat may take longer to
heat up.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
Rear Seats
Folding the Seatback
Rear Seat Reminder
Either side of the seatback can be folded
down for more cargo space. Fold a seatback
only when the vehicle is not moving.
If equipped, the message REAR SEAT
REMINDER LOOK IN REAR SEAT displays
under certain conditions indicating there
may be an item or passenger in the rear
seat. Check before exiting the vehicle.
This feature will activate when a second row
door is opened while the vehicle is on or up
to 10 minutes before the vehicle is turned
on. There will be an alert when the vehicle
is turned off. The alert does not directly
detect objects in the rear seat; instead,
under certain conditions, it detects when a
rear door is opened and closed, indicating
that there may be something in the
rear seat.
The feature is active only once each time
the vehicle is turned on and off, and will
require reactivation by opening and closing
the second row doors. There may be an
alert even when there is nothing in the rear
seat; for example, if a child entered the
vehicle through the rear door and left the
vehicle without the vehicle being shut off.
The feature can be turned on or off. See
Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
Caution
Folding a rear seat with the seat belts
still fastened may cause damage to the
seat or the seat belts. Always unbuckle
the seat belts and return them to their
normal stowed position before folding a
rear seat.
To fold a seatback down:
1. Slide the front seats forward and place
the front seatbacks in the upright
position. See Seat Adjustment 0 26 and
Reclining Seatbacks 0 27.
2. Remove the rear head restraints. See
“Head Restraint Removal and
Reinstallation” under Lower Anchors and
Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 53.
3. Pull up on the front edge of the rear
seat cushion to release it. Tilt the seat
cushion forward toward the front of the
vehicle.
4. Pull up the release knob on the top of
the seatback.
5. Fold the seatback forward and down.
29
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
30
Seats and Restraints
6. Repeat Steps 1–5 for the other seatback
and seat cushion, if desired.
Raising the Seatback
{ Warning
If either seatback is not locked, it could
move forward in a sudden stop or crash.
That could cause injury to the person
sitting there. Always push and pull on
the seatbacks to be sure they are locked.
{ Warning
With head restraints that are not
installed and adjusted properly, there is a
greater chance that occupants will suffer
a neck/spinal injury in a crash. Do not
drive until the head restraints for all
occupants are installed and adjusted
properly.
To return the rear seats to the normal
seating position:
2.
3.
4.
5.
{ Warning
A seat belt that is improperly routed, not
properly attached, or twisted will not
provide the protection needed in a crash.
The person wearing the belt could be
seriously injured. After raising the rear
seatback, always check to be sure that
the seat belts are properly routed and
attached, and are not twisted.
6.
7.
The seat belt should not cross the
seatback locking mechanism when raising
the seatback.
Lift the seatback up slightly and reinstall
the head restraint. See “Head Restraint
Removal and Reinstallation” under Lower
Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH
System) 0 53.
Push the seatback rearward all the way
to lock it in place.
Push and pull the top of the seatback to
be sure it is locked into position.
Return the seat cushion to its original
position and push down on the front
part of the seat cushion until it latches.
Remove the seat belt from the belt
guide on the trim.
Repeat Steps 1–6 for the other seatback
and seat cushion, if necessary.
If added cargo space is not needed, the
seatbacks should be kept in the upright,
locked position.
1. Move the seat belt out of the way by
putting the seat belts into the belt guide
on the trim.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
Seat Belts
This section describes how to use seat belts
properly, and some things not to do.
This vehicle has indicators as a reminder to
buckle the seat belts. See Seat Belt
Reminders 0 72.
strongest bones take the forces from the
seat belts. That is why wearing seat belts
makes such good sense.
Why Seat Belts Work
Questions and Answers About Seat Belts
{ Warning
Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle after a
crash if I am wearing a seat belt?
Do not let anyone ride where a seat belt
cannot be worn properly. In a crash,
if you or your passenger(s) are not
wearing seat belts, injuries can be much
worse than if you are wearing seat belts.
You can be seriously injured or killed by
hitting things inside the vehicle harder or
by being ejected from the vehicle. In
addition, anyone who is not buckled up
can strike other passengers in the vehicle.
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a
cargo area, inside or outside of a vehicle.
In a collision, passengers riding in these
areas are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed. Do not allow passengers
to ride in any area of the vehicle that is
not equipped with seats and seat belts.
Always wear a seat belt, and check that
all passenger(s) are restrained
properly too.
31
A: You could be — whether you are
wearing a seat belt or not. Your chance
of being conscious during and after a
crash, so you can unbuckle and get out,
is much greater if you are belted.
Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why should I
have to wear seat belts?
When riding in a vehicle, you travel as fast
as the vehicle does. If the vehicle stops
suddenly, you keep going until something
stops you. It could be the windshield, the
instrument panel, or the seat belts!
When you wear a seat belt, you and the
vehicle slow down together. There is more
time to stop because you stop over a longer
distance and, when worn properly, your
A: Airbags are supplemental systems only.
They work with seat belts — not instead
of them. Whether or not an airbag is
provided, all occupants still have to
buckle up to get the most protection.
Also, in nearly all states and in all
Canadian provinces, the law requires
wearing seat belts.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
32
Seats and Restraints
How to Wear Seat Belts Properly
. Sit up straight and always keep your feet
Follow these rules for everyone's protection.
. Wear the lap part of the belt low and
There are additional things to know about
seat belts and children, including smaller
children and infants. If a child will be riding
in the vehicle, see Older Children 0 47 or
Infants and Young Children 0 48. Review
and follow the rules for children in addition
to the following rules.
snug on the hips, just touching the
thighs. In a crash, this applies force to the
strong pelvic bones and you would be
less likely to slide under the lap belt.
If you slid under it, the belt would apply
force on your abdomen. This could cause
serious or even fatal injuries.
. Wear the shoulder belt over the shoulder
and across the chest. These parts of the
body are best able to take belt
restraining forces. The shoulder belt locks
if there is a sudden stop or crash.
It is very important for all occupants to
buckle up. Statistics show that unbelted
people are hurt more often in crashes than
those who are wearing seat belts.
There are important things to know about
wearing a seat belt properly.
on the floor in front of you (if possible).
{ Warning
You can be seriously injured, or even
killed, by not wearing your seat belt
properly.
Never allow the lap or shoulder belt to
become loose or twisted.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
33
{ Warning
The seat belt can be pinched if it is
routed under plastic trim on the seat,
such as trim around the rear seatback
folding handle or side airbag. In a crash,
pinched seat belts might not provide
adequate protection. Never allow seat
belts to be routed under plastic trim
pieces.
Always use the correct buckle for your
seating position.
Never wear the shoulder belt under both
arms or behind your back.
Never route the lap or shoulder belt over an
armrest.
{ Warning
You can be seriously injured or killed if
the shoulder belt is worn behind your
back, under your legs, or wrapped around
your neck. The shoulder belt can tighten
but cannot be loosened if it is locked. The
shoulder belt locks when it is pulled all
the way out of the retractor. It unlocks
when the shoulder belt is allowed to go
all the way back into the retractor, but it
cannot do this if it is wrapped around
you. You may have to cut the seat belt if
it is locked and tightened around you.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
34
Seats and Restraints
Lap-Shoulder Belt
All seating positions in the vehicle have a
lap-shoulder belt.
The following instructions explain how to
wear a lap-shoulder belt properly.
1. Adjust the seat, if the seat is adjustable,
so you can sit up straight. To see how,
see “Seats” in the Index.
2. Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt
across you. Do not let it get twisted.
The lap-shoulder belt may lock if you
pull the belt across you very quickly.
If this happens, let the belt go back
slightly to unlock it. Then pull the belt
across you more slowly.
If the shoulder portion of a passenger
belt is pulled out all the way, the child
restraint locking feature may be
engaged. See Child Restraint Systems
0 50. If this occurs, let the belt go back
all the way and start again. If the
locking feature stays engaged after
letting the belt go back to stowed
position on the seat, move the seat
rearward or recline the seat until the
shoulder belt retractor lock releases.
Engaging the child restraint locking
feature in the front outboard seating
position may affect the passenger
sensing system. See Passenger Sensing
System 0 42.
If the webbing locks in the latch plate
before it reaches the buckle, tilt the latch
plate to flat to unlock.
3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until
it clicks.
Pull up on the latch plate to make sure
it is secure. If the belt is not long
enough, see Seat Belt Extender 0 36.
Position the release button on the buckle
so that the seat belt could be quickly
unbuckled if necessary.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
To unlatch the belt, push the button on the
buckle. The belt should return to its stowed
position.
Always stow the seat belt slowly. If the seat
belt webbing returns quickly to the stowed
position, the retractor may lock and cannot
be pulled out. If this happens, pull the seat
belt straight out firmly to unlock the
webbing, and then release it. If the webbing
is still locked in the retractor, see your
dealer.
4. To make the lap part tight, pull up on
the shoulder belt.
Before a door is closed, be sure the belt is
out of the way. If a door is slammed against
a seat belt, damage can occur to both the
seat belt and the vehicle.
Seat Belt Pretensioners
This vehicle has seat belt pretensioners for
the front outboard occupants. Although the
seat belt pretensioners cannot be seen, they
are part of the seat belt assembly. They can
help tighten the seat belts during the early
stages of a moderate to severe frontal, near
frontal, or rear crash if the threshold
conditions for pretensioner activation are
met. Seat belt pretensioners can also help
tighten the seat belts in a side crash or a
rollover event.
35
Pretensioners work only once. If the
pretensioners activate in a crash, the
pretensioners and probably other parts of
the vehicle's seat belt system will need to
be replaced. See Replacing Seat Belt System
Parts after a Crash 0 37.
Do not sit on the outboard seat belt while
entering or exiting the vehicle or at any
time while sitting in the seat. Sitting on the
seat belt can damage the webbing and
hardware.
Rear Seat Belt Comfort Guides
Rear seat belt comfort guides may provide
added seat belt comfort for older children
who have outgrown booster seats and for
some adults. When installed on a shoulder
belt, the comfort guide positions the
shoulder belt away from the neck and head.
Comfort guides are available through your
dealer for the rear outboard seating
positions. Instructions are included with the
guides.
Seat Belt Use During Pregnancy
Seat belts work for everyone, including
pregnant women. Like all occupants, they
are more likely to be seriously injured if
they do not wear seat belts.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
36
Seats and Restraints
A pregnant woman should wear a
lap-shoulder belt, and the lap portion should
be worn as low as possible, below the
rounding, throughout the pregnancy.
The best way to protect the fetus is to
protect the mother. When a seat belt is
worn properly, it is more likely that the
fetus will not be hurt in a crash. For
pregnant women, as for anyone, the key to
making seat belts effective is wearing them
properly.
Seat Belt Extender
If the vehicle's seat belt will fasten around
you, you should use it.
But if a seat belt is not long enough, your
dealer will order you an extender. Only a
GM dealer issued extender should be used.
When you go in to order it, take the
heaviest coat you will wear, so the extender
will be long enough for you. To help avoid
personal injury, do not let someone else use
it, and use it only for the seat it is made to
fit. The extender has been designed for
adults. Never use it for securing child
restraints. For more information on the
proper use and fit of seat belt extenders see
the instruction sheet that comes with the
extender.
Safety System Check
Periodically check the seat belt reminder,
seat belts, buckles, latch plates, retractors,
shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped),
and seat belt anchorages to make sure they
are all in working order. Look for any other
loose or damaged seat belt system parts
that might keep a seat belt system from
performing properly. See your dealer to
have it repaired. Torn, frayed, or twisted
seat belts may not protect you in a crash.
Torn or frayed seat belts can rip apart under
impact forces. If a belt is torn or frayed,
have it replaced immediately. If a belt is
twisted, it may be possible to untwist by
reversing the latch plate on the webbing.
If the twist cannot be corrected, ask your
dealer to fix it.
Make sure the seat belt reminder light is
working. See Seat Belt Reminders 0 72.
Keep seat belts clean and dry. See Seat Belt
Care 0 36.
Seat Belt Care
Keep belts clean and dry.
Seat belts should be properly cared for and
maintained.
Seat belt hardware should be kept dry and
free of dust or debris. As necessary, exterior
hard surfaces and seat belt webbing may be
lightly cleaned with mild soap and water.
Ensure there is not excessive dust or debris
in the mechanism. If dust or debris exists in
the system please see the dealer. Parts may
need to be replaced to ensure proper
functionality of the system.
{ Warning
Do not bleach or dye seat belt webbing.
It may severely weaken the webbing. In
a crash, they might not be able to
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
Warning (Continued)
provide adequate protection. Clean and
rinse seat belt webbing only with mild
soap and lukewarm water. Allow the
webbing to dry.
Replacing Seat Belt System Parts
after a Crash
{ Warning
A crash can damage the seat belt system
in the vehicle. A damaged seat belt
system may not properly protect the
person using it, resulting in serious injury
or even death in a crash. To help make
sure the seat belt systems are working
properly after a crash, have them
inspected and any necessary
replacements made as soon as possible.
After a minor crash, replacement of seat
belts may not be necessary. But the seat
belt assemblies that were used during any
crash may have been stressed or damaged.
See your dealer to have the seat belt
assemblies inspected or replaced.
New parts and repairs may be necessary
even if the seat belt system was not being
used at the time of the crash.
Have the seat belt pretensioners checked if
the vehicle has been in a crash, or if the
airbag readiness light stays on after you
start the vehicle or while you are driving.
See Airbag Readiness Light 0 73.
Airbag System
The vehicle has the following airbags:
. A frontal airbag for the driver
. A frontal airbag for the front outboard
passenger
. A knee airbag for the driver
. A knee airbag for the front outboard
passenger
. A seat-mounted side impact airbag for the
driver
. A seat-mounted side impact airbag for the
front outboard passenger
. Seat-mounted side impact airbags for the
second row outboard passengers
. A roof-rail airbag for the driver and the
passenger seated directly behind the
driver
37
. A roof-rail airbag for the front outboard
passenger and the passenger seated
directly behind the front outboard
passenger
All vehicle airbags have the word AIRBAG on
the trim or on a label near the deployment
opening.
For frontal airbags, the word AIRBAG is on
the center of the steering wheel for the
driver and on the instrument panel for the
front outboard passenger.
For knee airbags, the word AIRBAG is on the
lower part of the instrument panel.
For seat-mounted side impact airbags, the
word AIRBAG is on the side of the seatback
or side of the seat closest to the door.
For roof-rail airbags, the word AIRBAG is on
the ceiling or trim.
Airbags are designed to supplement the
protection provided by seat belts. Even
though today's airbags are also designed to
help reduce the risk of injury from the force
of an inflating bag, all airbags must inflate
very quickly to do their job.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
38
Seats and Restraints
Here are the most important things to know
about the airbag system:
{ Warning
You can be severely injured or killed in a
crash if you are not wearing your seat
belt, even with airbags. Airbags are
designed to work with seat belts, not
replace them. Also, airbags are not
designed to inflate in every crash. In
some crashes seat belts are the only
restraint. See When Should an Airbag
Inflate? 0 40.
Wearing your seat belt during a crash
helps reduce your chance of hitting
things inside the vehicle or being ejected
from it. Airbags are “supplemental
restraints” to the seat belts. Everyone in
the vehicle should wear a seat belt
properly, whether or not there is an
airbag for that person.
{ Warning
{ Warning
Because airbags inflate with great force
and faster than the blink of an eye,
anyone who is up against, or very close
to, any airbag when it inflates can be
seriously injured or killed. Do not sit
unnecessarily close to any airbag, as you
would be if sitting on the edge of the
seat or leaning forward. Seat belts help
keep you in position before and during a
crash. Always wear a seat belt, even with
airbags. The driver should sit as far back
as possible while still maintaining control
of the vehicle. The seat belts and the
front outboard passenger airbags are
most effective when you are sitting well
back and upright in the seat with both
feet on the floor.
Children who are up against, or very
close to, any airbag when it inflates can
be seriously injured or killed. Always
secure children properly in the vehicle. To
read how, see Older Children 0 47 or
Infants and Young Children 0 48.
Occupants should not lean on or sleep
against the door or side windows in
seating positions with seat-mounted side
impact airbags and/or roof-rail airbags.
There is an airbag readiness light on the
instrument cluster, which shows the airbag
symbol. The system checks the airbag
electrical system for malfunctions. The light
tells you if there is an electrical problem.
See Airbag Readiness Light 0 73.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
Where Are the Airbags?
39
The driver and front outboard passenger
seat-mounted side impact airbags are in the
side of the seatbacks closest to the door.
The roof-rail airbags for the driver, front
passenger, and second row outboard
passengers are in the ceiling above the side
windows.
The driver frontal airbag is in the center of
the steering wheel.
The driver knee airbag is below the steering
column. The front outboard passenger knee
airbag is below the glove box.
The front outboard passenger frontal airbag
is in the passenger side instrument panel.
Rear Seat Driver Side Shown, Passenger Side
Similar
On vehicles with second row seat-mounted
side impact airbags, they are in the sides of
the seatback closest to the door.
Driver Side Shown, Passenger Side Similar
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
40
Seats and Restraints
{ Warning
If something is between an occupant and
an airbag, the airbag might not inflate
properly or it might force the object into
that person causing severe injury or even
death. The path of an inflating airbag
must be kept clear. Do not put anything
between an occupant and an airbag, and
do not attach or put anything on the
steering wheel hub or on or near any
other airbag covering.
Do not use seat accessories that block the
inflation path of a seat-mounted side
impact airbag.
Never secure anything to the roof of a
vehicle with roof-rail airbags by routing a
rope or tie‐down through any door or
window opening. If you do, the path of
an inflating roof-rail airbag will be
blocked.
When Should an Airbag Inflate?
This vehicle is equipped with airbags. See
Airbag System 0 37. Airbags are designed to
inflate if the impact exceeds the specific
airbag system's deployment threshold.
Deployment thresholds are used to predict
how severe a crash is likely to be in time
for the airbags to inflate and help restrain
the occupants. The vehicle has electronic
sensors that help the airbag system
determine the severity of the impact.
Deployment thresholds can vary with
specific vehicle design.
Frontal airbags are designed to inflate in
moderate to severe frontal or near frontal
crashes to help reduce the potential for
severe injuries, mainly to the driver's or
front outboard passenger's head and chest.
Whether the frontal airbags will or should
inflate is not based primarily on how fast
the vehicle is traveling. It depends on what
is hit, the direction of the impact, and how
quickly the vehicle slows down.
Frontal airbags may inflate at different crash
speeds depending on whether the vehicle
hits an object straight on or at an angle,
and whether the object is fixed or moving,
rigid or deformable, narrow or wide.
Frontal airbags are not intended to inflate
during vehicle rollovers, in rear impacts,
or in many side impacts.
In addition, the vehicle has advanced
technology frontal airbags. Advanced
technology frontal airbags adjust the
restraint according to either crash severity
or occupant interaction.
Knee airbags are designed to inflate in
moderate to severe frontal or near frontal
impacts. Knee airbags are not designed to
inflate during vehicle rollovers, in rear
impacts, or in many side impacts.
Seat-mounted side impact airbags are
designed to inflate in moderate to severe
side crashes depending on the location of
the impact. Seat-mounted side impact
airbags are not designed to inflate in frontal
impacts, near frontal impacts, rollovers,
or rear impacts. A seat-mounted side impact
airbag is designed to inflate on the side of
the vehicle that is struck.
Roof-rail airbags are designed to inflate in
moderate to severe side crashes depending
on the location of the impact. In addition,
these roof-rail airbags are designed to inflate
during a rollover or in a severe frontal
impact. Roof-rail airbags are not designed to
inflate in rear impacts. Both roof-rail airbags
will inflate when either side of the vehicle is
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
struck, if the sensing system predicts that
the vehicle is about to roll over on its side,
or in a severe frontal impact.
In any particular crash, no one can say
whether an airbag should have inflated
simply because of the vehicle damage or
repair costs.
What Makes an Airbag Inflate?
In a deployment event, the sensing system
sends an electrical signal triggering a release
of gas from the inflator. Gas from the
inflator fills the airbag causing the bag to
break out of the cover. The inflator, the
airbag, and related hardware are all part of
the airbag module.
For airbag locations, see Where Are the
Airbags? 0 39.
How Does an Airbag Restrain?
In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal
collisions, even belted occupants can contact
the steering wheel or the instrument panel.
In moderate to severe side collisions, even
belted occupants can contact the inside of
the vehicle.
41
Airbags supplement the protection provided
by seat belts by distributing the force of the
impact more evenly over the
occupant's body.
some time after they inflate. Some
components of the airbag module may be
hot for several minutes. For location of the
airbags, see Where Are the Airbags? 0 39.
Rollover capable roof-rail airbags are
designed to help contain the head and chest
of occupants in the outboard seating
positions in the first and second rows. The
rollover capable roof-rail airbags are
designed to help reduce the risk of full or
partial ejection in rollover events, although
no system can prevent all such ejections.
The parts of the airbag that come into
contact with you may be warm, but not too
hot to touch. There may be some smoke
and dust coming from the vents in the
deflated airbags. Airbag inflation does not
prevent the driver from seeing out of the
windshield or being able to steer the
vehicle, nor does it prevent people from
leaving the vehicle.
But airbags would not help in many types
of collisions, primarily because the
occupant's motion is not toward those
airbags. See When Should an Airbag Inflate?
0 40.
Airbags should never be regarded as
anything more than a supplement to seat
belts.
What Will You See after an
Airbag Inflates?
After frontal, knee, and seat-mounted side
impact airbags inflate, they quickly deflate,
so quickly that some people may not even
realize the airbags inflated. Roof-rail airbags
may still be at least partially inflated for
{ Warning
When an airbag inflates, there may be
dust in the air. This dust could cause
breathing problems for people with a
history of asthma or other breathing
trouble. To avoid this, everyone in the
vehicle should get out as soon as it is
safe to do so. If you have breathing
problems but cannot get out of the
vehicle after an airbag inflates, then get
fresh air by opening a window or a door.
If you experience breathing problems
following an airbag deployment, you
should seek medical attention.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
42
Seats and Restraints
The vehicle has a feature that may
automatically unlock the doors, turn on the
interior lamps and hazard warning flashers,
and shut off the fuel system after the
airbags inflate. The feature may also
activate, without airbag inflation, after an
event that exceeds a predetermined
threshold. After turning the ignition off and
then on again, the fuel system will return to
normal operation; the doors can be locked,
the interior lamps can be turned off, and
the hazard warning flashers can be turned
off using the controls for those features.
If any of these systems are damaged in the
crash they may not operate as normal.
{ Warning
A crash severe enough to inflate the
airbags may have also damaged
important functions in the vehicle, such
as the fuel system, brake and steering
systems, etc. Even if the vehicle appears
to be drivable after a moderate crash,
there may be concealed damage that
could make it difficult to safely operate
the vehicle.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
Use caution if you should attempt to
restart the engine after a crash has
occurred.
In many crashes severe enough to inflate
the airbag, windshields are broken by
vehicle deformation. Additional windshield
breakage may also occur from the front
outboard passenger airbag.
. Airbags are designed to inflate only once.
After an airbag inflates, you will need
some new parts for the airbag system.
If you do not get them, the airbag
system will not be there to help protect
you in another crash. A new system will
include airbag modules and possibly other
parts. The service manual for the vehicle
covers the need to replace other parts.
. The vehicle has a crash sensing and
diagnostic module which records
information after a crash. See Vehicle
Data Recording and Privacy 0 250 and
Event Data Recorders 0 250.
. Let only qualified technicians work on the
airbag system. Improper service can mean
that an airbag system will not work
properly. See your dealer for service.
Passenger Sensing System
The vehicle has a passenger sensing system
for the front outboard passenger position.
The passenger airbag status indicator will
light on the overhead console when the
vehicle is started.
United States
Canada
The words ON and OFF, or the symbols for
on and off, will be visible during the system
check. When the system check is complete,
either the word ON or OFF, or the symbol
for on or off, will be visible. See Passenger
Airbag Status Indicator 0 74.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
The passenger sensing system turns off the
front outboard passenger frontal airbag and
knee airbag under certain conditions. No
other airbag is affected by the passenger
sensing system.
The passenger sensing system works with
sensors that are part of the front outboard
passenger seat and seat belt. The sensors
are designed to detect the presence of a
properly seated occupant and determine if
the front outboard passenger frontal airbag
and knee airbag should be allowed to inflate
or not.
According to accident statistics, children are
safer when properly secured in a rear seat
in the correct child restraint for their weight
and size.
Whenever possible, children aged 12 and
under should be secured in a rear seating
position.
Never put a rear-facing child seat in the
front. This is because the risk to the
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag
inflates.
43
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can
be seriously injured or killed if the
passenger frontal airbag inflates. This is
because the back of the rear-facing child
restraint would be very close to the
inflating airbag. A child in a
forward-facing child restraint can be
seriously injured or killed if the passenger
frontal airbag inflates and the passenger
seat is in a forward position.
The passenger sensing system is designed to
turn off the front outboard passenger
frontal airbag and knee airbag if:
. The front outboard passenger seat is
unoccupied.
. The system determines an infant is
present in a child restraint.
. A front outboard passenger takes his/her
weight off of the seat for a period
of time.
. There is a critical problem with the airbag
system or the passenger sensing system.
Even if the passenger sensing system has
turned off the front outboard passenger
airbag(s), no system is fail-safe. No one
can guarantee that an airbag will not
deploy under some unusual circumstance,
even though the airbag(s) are off.
When the passenger sensing system has
turned off the front outboard passenger
frontal airbag and knee airbag, the OFF
indicator will light and stay lit as a reminder
that the airbags are off. See Passenger
Airbag Status Indicator 0 74.
Never put a rear-facing child restraint in
the front seat, even if the airbag is off.
If securing a forward-facing child restraint
in the front outboard passenger seat,
always move the seat as far back as it
will go. It is better to secure child
restraints in the rear seat. Consider using
another vehicle to transport the child
when a rear seat is not available.
The passenger sensing system is designed to
turn on the front outboard passenger frontal
airbag and knee airbag anytime the system
senses that a person of adult size is sitting
properly in the front outboard passenger
seat. When the passenger sensing system
has allowed the airbags to be enabled, the
ON indicator will light and stay lit as a
reminder that the airbags are active.
{ Warning
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
44
Seats and Restraints
For some children, including children in child
restraints, and for very small adults, the
passenger sensing system may or may not
turn off the front outboard passenger
frontal airbag and knee airbag, depending
upon the person's seating posture and body
build. Everyone in the vehicle who has
outgrown child restraints should wear a seat
belt properly — whether or not there is an
airbag for that person.
{ Warning
If the airbag readiness light ever comes
on and stays on, it means that
something may be wrong with the airbag
system. To help avoid injury to yourself
or others, have the vehicle serviced right
away. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 73 for
more information, including important
safety information.
If the On Indicator Is Lit for a Child
Restraint
The passenger sensing system is designed to
turn off the front outboard passenger
frontal airbag and knee airbag if the system
determines that an infant is present in a
child restraint. If a child restraint has been
installed and the ON indicator is lit:
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Remove the child restraint from the
vehicle.
3. Remove any additional items from the
seat such as blankets, cushions, seat
covers, seat heaters, or seat massagers.
4. Reinstall the child restraint following the
directions provided by the child restraint
manufacturer and refer to Securing Child
Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear
Seat) 0 60 or
Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat
Belt in the Front Seat) 0 62.
5. If, after reinstalling the child restraint
and restarting the vehicle, the ON
indicator is still lit, turn the vehicle off.
Then slightly recline the vehicle seatback
and adjust the seat cushion,
if adjustable, to make sure that the
vehicle seatback is not pushing the child
restraint into the seat cushion. Also
make sure the child restraint is not
trapped under the vehicle head restraint.
If this happens, adjust the head restraint.
See Head Restraints 0 25.
6. Restart the vehicle.
The passenger sensing system may or may
not turn off the airbags for a child in a child
restraint depending upon the child’s size.
It is better to secure the child restraint in a
rear seat. Never put a rear-facing child
restraint in the front seat, even if the ON
indicator is not lit.
If the Off Indicator Is Lit for an
Adult-Sized Occupant
If a person of adult size is sitting in the
front outboard passenger seat, but the OFF
indicator is lit, it could be because that
person is not sitting properly in the seat or
that the child restraint locking feature is
engaged. Use the following steps to allow
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
the system to detect that person and enable
the front outboard passenger frontal airbag
and knee airbag:
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Remove any additional material from the
seat, such as blankets, cushions, seat
covers, seat heaters, or seat massagers.
3. Place the seatback in the fully upright
position.
4. Have the person sit upright in the seat,
centered on the seat cushion, with legs
comfortably extended.
5. If the shoulder portion of the belt is
pulled out all the way, the child restraint
locking feature will be engaged. This
may unintentionally cause the passenger
sensing system to turn the airbag off for
some adult-sized occupants. If this
happens, unbuckle the belt and let the
belt go back all the way, and then
buckle the belt again without pulling the
belt out all the way.
6. Restart the vehicle and have the person
remain in this position for two to
three minutes after the ON indicator
is lit.
{ Warning
If the front outboard passenger airbag is
turned off for an adult-sized occupant,
the airbag will not be able to inflate and
help protect that person in a crash,
resulting in an increased risk of serious
injury or even death. An adult-sized
occupant should not ride in the front
outboard passenger seat, if the passenger
airbag OFF indicator is lit.
Additional Factors Affecting System
Operation
Seat belts help keep the passenger in
position on the seat during vehicle
maneuvers and braking, which helps the
passenger sensing system maintain the
passenger airbag status. See “Seat Belts”
and “Child Restraints” in the Index for
additional information about the importance
of proper restraint use.
A thick layer of additional material, such as
a blanket or cushion, or aftermarket
equipment such as seat covers, seat heaters,
and seat massagers can affect how well the
passenger sensing system operates. We
recommend that you not use seat covers or
other aftermarket equipment except when
45
approved by GM for your specific vehicle.
See Adding Equipment to the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle 0 46 for more
information about modifications that can
affect how the system operates.
The ON indicator may be lit if an object,
such as a briefcase, handbag, grocery bag,
laptop, or other electronic device, is put on
an unoccupied seat. If this is not desired,
remove the object from the seat.
{ Warning
Stowing articles under the passenger seat
or between the passenger seat cushion
and seatback may interfere with the
proper operation of the passenger
sensing system.
Servicing the Airbag-Equipped
Vehicle
Airbags affect how the vehicle should be
serviced. There are parts of the airbag
system in several places around the vehicle.
Your dealer and the service manual have
information about servicing the vehicle and
the airbag system. To purchase a service
manual, see Publication Ordering
Information 0 248.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
46
Seats and Restraints
{ Warning
For up to 10 seconds after the vehicle is
turned off and the battery is
disconnected, an airbag can still inflate
during improper service. You can be
injured if you are close to an airbag
when it inflates. Avoid yellow connectors.
They are probably part of the airbag
system. Be sure to follow proper service
procedures, and make sure the person
performing work for you is qualified to
do so.
Adding Equipment to the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle
Adding accessories that change the vehicle's
frame, bumper system, height, front end,
or side sheet metal may keep the airbag
system from working properly.
The operation of the airbag system can also
be affected by changing, including
improperly repairing or replacing, any parts
of the following:
. Airbag system, including airbag modules,
front or side impact sensors, sensing and
diagnostic module, or airbag wiring
. Front seats, including stitching, seams or
zippers
. Seat belts
. Steering wheel, instrument panel,
overhead console, ceiling trim, or pillar
garnish trim
. Inner door seals, including speakers
Your dealer and the service manual have
information about the location of the airbag
modules and sensors, sensing and diagnostic
module, and airbag wiring along with the
proper replacement procedures.
In addition, the vehicle has a passenger
sensing system for the front outboard
passenger position, which includes sensors
that are part of the passenger seat. The
passenger sensing system may not operate
properly if the original seat trim is replaced
with non-GM covers, upholstery, or trim; or
with GM covers, upholstery, or trim
designed for a different vehicle. Any object,
such as an aftermarket seat heater or a
comfort-enhancing pad or device, installed
under or on top of the seat fabric, could
also interfere with the operation of the
passenger sensing system. This could either
prevent proper deployment of the passenger
airbag(s) or prevent the passenger sensing
system from properly turning off the
passenger airbag(s). See Passenger Sensing
System 0 42.
If the vehicle has rollover roof-rail airbags,
see Different Size Tires and Wheels 0 202 for
additional important information.
If the vehicle must be modified because you
have a disability and have questions about
whether the modifications will affect the
vehicle's airbag system, or if you have
questions about whether the airbag system
will be affected if the vehicle is modified for
any other reason, call Customer Assistance.
See Customer Assistance Offices 0 242.
Airbag System Check
The airbag system does not need regularly
scheduled maintenance or replacement.
Make sure the airbag readiness light is
working. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 73.
Caution
If an airbag covering is damaged, opened,
or broken, the airbag may not work
properly. Do not open or break the airbag
coverings. If there are any opened or
broken airbag coverings, have the airbag
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
Caution (Continued)
covering and/or airbag module replaced.
For the location of the airbags, see Where
Are the Airbags? 0 39. See your dealer
for service.
Replacing Airbag System Parts
after a Crash
If the airbag readiness light stays on after
the vehicle is started or comes on when you
are driving, the airbag system may not work
properly. Have the vehicle serviced right
away. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 73.
Child Restraints
Older Children
{ Warning
A crash can damage the airbag systems
in the vehicle. A damaged airbag system
may not properly protect you and your
passenger(s) in a crash, resulting in
serious injury or even death. To help
make sure the airbag systems are
working properly after a crash, have
them inspected and any necessary
replacements made as soon as possible.
If an airbag inflates, you will need to
replace airbag system parts. See your dealer
for service.
Older children who have outgrown booster
seats should wear the vehicle’s seat belts.
47
The manufacturer instructions that come
with the booster seat state the weight and
height limitations for that booster. Use a
booster seat with a lap-shoulder belt until
the child passes the fit test below:
. Sit all the way back on the seat. Do the
knees bend at the seat edge? If yes,
continue. If no, return to the booster seat.
. Buckle the lap-shoulder belt. Does the
shoulder belt rest on the shoulder? If yes,
continue. If no, try using the rear seat
belt comfort guide, if available. See “Rear
Seat Belt Comfort Guides” under
Lap-Shoulder Belt 0 34. If a comfort guide
is not available, or if the shoulder belt
still does not rest on the shoulder, then
return to the booster seat.
. Does the lap belt fit low and snug on the
hips, touching the thighs? If yes, continue.
If no, return to the booster seat.
. Can proper seat belt fit be maintained for
the length of the trip? If yes, continue.
If no, return to the booster seat.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
48
Seats and Restraints
Q: What is the proper way to wear seat
belts?
A: An older child should wear a lap-shoulder
belt and get the additional restraint a
shoulder belt can provide. The shoulder
belt should not cross the face or neck.
The lap belt should fit snugly below the
hips, just touching the top of the thighs.
This applies belt force to the child's
pelvic bones in a crash. It should never
be worn over the abdomen, which could
cause severe or even fatal internal
injuries in a crash.
Warning (Continued)
crash, they can be crushed together and
seriously injured. A seat belt must be
used by only one person at a time.
Warning (Continued)
injury. The child might also slide under
the lap belt. The belt force would then be
applied right on the abdomen. That could
cause serious or fatal injuries. The
shoulder belt should go over the shoulder
and across the chest.
Also see “Rear Seat Belt Comfort Guides”
under Lap-Shoulder Belt 0 34.
According to accident statistics, children are
safer when properly restrained in a rear
seating position.
In a crash, children who are not buckled up
can strike other people who are buckled up,
or can be thrown out of the vehicle. Older
children need to use seat belts properly.
{ Warning
Never allow more than one child to wear
the same seat belt. The seat belt cannot
properly spread the impact forces. In a
(Continued)
{ Warning
Never allow a child to wear the seat belt
shoulder belt under both arms or behind
their back. A child can be seriously
injured by not wearing the lap-shoulder
belt properly. In a crash, the child would
not be restrained by the shoulder belt.
The child could move too far forward
increasing the chance of head and neck
(Continued)
Infants and Young Children
Everyone in a vehicle needs protection! This
includes infants and all other children.
Neither the distance traveled nor the age
and size of the traveler changes the need,
for everyone, to use safety restraints. In
fact, the law in every state in the United
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
States and in every Canadian province says
children up to some age must be restrained
while in a vehicle.
{ Warning
Children can be seriously injured or killed
if the shoulder belt is worn behind their
back, under their legs, or wrapped around
their neck. The shoulder belt can tighten
but cannot be loosened if it is locked. The
shoulder belt locks when it is pulled all
the way out of the retractor. It unlocks
when the shoulder belt is allowed to go
all the way back into the retractor, but it
cannot do this if it is wrapped around the
child. Never leave children unattended in
a vehicle and never allow children to
improperly wear, or play with, the seat
belts.
49
{ Warning
{ Warning
Never hold an infant or a child while
riding in a vehicle. Due to crash forces, an
infant or a child will become so heavy it
is not possible to hold it during a crash.
For example, in a crash at only
40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb) infant
will suddenly become a 110 kg (240 lb)
force on a person's arms. An infant or
child should be secured in an appropriate
child restraint.
Children who are up against, or very
close to, any airbag when it inflates can
be seriously injured or killed. Never put a
rear-facing child restraint in the front
outboard seat. Secure a rear-facing child
restraint in a rear seat. It is also better to
secure a forward-facing child restraint in
a rear seat. If you must secure a
forward-facing child restraint in the front
outboard seat, always move the front
passenger seat as far back as it will go.
Every time infants and young children ride
in vehicles, they should have the protection
provided by appropriate child restraints.
Neither the vehicle's seat belt system nor its
airbag system is designed for them.
Children who are not restrained properly can
strike other people, or can be thrown out of
the vehicle.
Child restraints are devices used to restrain,
seat, or position children in the vehicle and
are sometimes called child seats or car seats.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
50
Seats and Restraints
There are three basic types of child
restraints:
. Forward-facing child restraints
. Rear-facing child restraints
. Belt-positioning booster seats
The proper child restraint for your child
depends on their size, weight, and age, and
also on whether the child restraint is
compatible with the vehicle in which it will
be used.
For each types of child restraints, there are
many different models available. When
purchasing a child restraint, be sure it is
designed to be used in a motor vehicle and
is certified to comply with US Federal or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.
If it is, the child restraint will have a label
saying that it meets federal motor vehicle
safety standards. The NHTSA website
includes a list of registered car seat
manufacturers (https://www.nhtsa.gov) and
links to their registration pages for
consumers. Registration helps manufacturers
identify purchasers for recall notices.
The instruction manual that is provided with
the child restraint states the weight and
height limitations for that particular child
restraint. In addition, there are many kinds
of child restraints available for children with
special needs.
Child Restraint Systems
{ Warning
To reduce the risk of neck and head
injury in a crash, infants and toddlers
should be secured in a rear-facing child
restraint until age two, or until they
reach the maximum height and weight
limits of their child restraint.
{ Warning
A young child's hip bones are still so
small that the vehicle seat belt may not
remain low on the hip bones, as it
should. Instead, it may settle up around
the child's abdomen. In a crash, the belt
would apply force on a body area that is
unprotected by any bony structure. This
alone could cause serious or fatal injuries.
To reduce the risk of serious or fatal
injuries during a crash, young children
should always be secured in an
appropriate child restraint.
Rear-Facing Infant Restraint
A rear-facing child restraint provides
restraint with the seating surface against
the back of the infant.
The harness system holds the infant in place
and, in a crash, acts to keep the infant
positioned in the restraint.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
51
Securing an Add-On Child Restraint in
the Vehicle
{ Warning
Forward-Facing Child Restraint
A forward-facing child restraint provides
restraint for the child's body with the
harness.
Booster Seats
A belt-positioning booster seat is used for
children who have outgrown their
forward-facing child restraint. Boosters are
designed to improve the fit of the vehicle's
seat belt system until the child is large
enough for the vehicle seat belts to fit
properly without a booster seat. See the
seat belt fit test in Older Children 0 47.
A child can be seriously injured or killed
in a crash if the child restraint is not
properly secured in the vehicle. Secure
the child restraint properly in the vehicle
using the vehicle seat belt or LATCH
system, following the instructions that
came with that child restraint and the
instructions in this manual.
To help reduce the chance of injury, the
child restraint must be secured in the
vehicle. Child restraints must be secured in
vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap belt
portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by the
LATCH system. See Lower Anchors and
Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 53 for
more information. Never use a seat belt
extender when installing a child restraint.
Use only seats and related equipment that
are certified to comply with US Federal or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards to
secure a child restraint. Children can be
endangered in a crash if the child restraint is
not properly secured in the vehicle.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
52
Seats and Restraints
When securing an add-on child restraint,
refer to the following:
1. Instruction labels provided on the child
restraint
2. Instruction manual provided with the
child restraint
3. This vehicle owner's manual
The child restraint instructions are
important, so if they are not available,
obtain a replacement copy from the
manufacturer.
Keep in mind that an unsecured child
restraint can move around in a collision or
sudden stop and injure people in the vehicle.
Be sure to properly secure any child
restraint in the vehicle — even when no
child is in it.
In some areas Certified Child Passenger
Safety Technicians (CPSTs) are available to
inspect and demonstrate how to correctly
use and install child restraints. In the U.S.,
refer to the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) website to locate
the nearest child safety seat inspection
station. For CPST availability in Canada,
check with Transport Canada or the
Provincial Ministry of Transportation office.
Securing the Child Within the Child
Restraint
{ Warning
A child can be seriously injured or killed
in a crash if the child is not properly
secured in the child restraint. Secure the
child properly following the instructions
that came with that child restraint.
Where to Put the Restraint
According to accident statistics, children and
infants are safer when properly restrained in
an appropriate child restraint secured in a
rear seating position.
Whenever possible, children aged 12 and
under should be secured in a rear seating
position.
Never put a rear-facing child restraint in the
front. This is because the risk to the
rear-facing child is so great if the airbag
deploys.
{ Warning
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can
be seriously injured or killed if the front
passenger airbag inflates. This is because
the back of the rear-facing child restraint
would be very close to the inflating
airbag. A child in a forward-facing child
restraint can be seriously injured or killed
if the front passenger airbag inflates and
the passenger seat is in a forward
position.
Even if the passenger sensing system has
turned off the front passenger frontal
airbag, no system is fail-safe. No one can
guarantee that an airbag will not deploy
under some unusual circumstance, even
though it is turned off.
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a
rear seat, even if the airbag is off. If you
secure a forward-facing child restraint in
the front seat, always move the front
passenger seat as far back as it will go.
It is better to secure the child restraint in
a rear seat.
See Passenger Sensing System 0 42 for
additional information.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
When securing a child restraint with the
seat belts in a rear seat position, study the
instructions that came with the child
restraint to make sure it is compatible with
this vehicle.
Child restraints and booster seats vary
considerably in size, and some may fit in
certain seating positions better than others.
Do not install a child restraint in any rear
seating position where it cannot be installed
securely.
Depending on where you place the child
restraint and the size of the child restraint,
you may not be able to access adjacent seat
belts or LATCH anchors for additional
passengers or child restraints. Adjacent
seating positions should not be used if the
child restraint prevents access to or
interferes with the routing of the seat belt.
The seat in front of an installed child
restraint should be adjusted to ensure
proper installation according to the child
restraint manual.
Wherever a child restraint is installed, be
sure to follow the instructions that came
with the child restraint and secure the child
restraint properly.
Keep in mind that an unsecured child
restraint can move around in a collision or
sudden stop and injure people in the vehicle.
Be sure to properly secure any child
restraint in the vehicle — even when no
child is in it.
Lower Anchors and Tethers for
Children (LATCH System)
The LATCH system secures a child restraint
during driving or in a crash. LATCH
attachments on the child restraint are used
to attach the child restraint to the anchors
in the vehicle. The LATCH system is designed
to make installation of a child restraint
easier.
In order to use the LATCH system in your
vehicle, you need a child restraint that has
LATCH attachments. LATCH-compatible
rear-facing and forward-facing child seats can
be properly installed using either the LATCH
anchors or the vehicle’s seat belts. Do not
use both the seat belts and the LATCH
anchorage system to secure a rear-facing or
forward-facing child seat.
53
Booster seats use the vehicle’s seat belts to
secure the child in the booster seat. If the
manufacturer recommends that the booster
seat be secured with the LATCH system, this
can be done as long as the booster seat can
be positioned properly and there is no
interference with the proper positioning of
the lap-shoulder belt on the child.
Make sure to follow the instructions that
came with the child restraint, and also the
instructions in this manual.
When installing a child restraint with a top
tether, you must also use either the lower
anchors or the seat belts to properly secure
the child restraint. A child restraint must
never be installed using only the top tether
and anchor.
For a forward-facing 5-pt harness child
restraint where the combined weight of the
child and restraint are up to 29.5 kg (65 lb),
use either the lower LATCH anchorages with
the top tether anchorage, or the seat belt
with the top tether anchorage. Where the
combined weight of the child and restraint
are greater than 29.5 kg (65 lb), use the seat
belt with the top tether anchorage only.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
54
Seats and Restraints
Recommended Methods for Attaching Child Restraints
Restraint Type
Combined Weight of
the Child + Child
Restraint
Rear-Facing Child
Restraint
Up to 29.5 kg (65 lb)
Rear-Facing Child
Restraint
Greater than
29.5 kg (65 lb)
Forward-Facing Child
Restraint
Up to 29.5 kg (65 lb)
Forward-Facing Child
Restraint
Greater than
29.5 kg (65 lb)
See Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat
Belt in the Rear Seat) 0 60 or
Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt
in the Front Seat) 0 62.
Use Only Approved Attachment Methods Shown with an X
LATCH – Lower
Anchors Only
X
Seat Belt Only
LATCH – Lower
Anchors and Top
Tether Anchor
Seat Belt and Top
Tether Anchor
X
X
X
X
X
Child restraints built after March 2014 will
be labeled with the specific child weight up
to which the LATCH system can be used to
install the restraint.
The following explains how to attach a child
restraint with these attachments in the
vehicle.
Not all vehicle seating positions or child
restraints have lower anchors and
attachments or top tether anchors and
attachments. In this case, the seat belt must
be used (with top tether where available) to
secure the child restraint. See Securing Child
Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear
Seat) 0 60 or
Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt
in the Front Seat) 0 62.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
Lower Anchors
Top Tether Anchor
the top tether always to be attached. In
Canada, the law requires that forward-facing
child restraints have a top tether, and that
the tether be attached. Be sure to read and
follow the instructions for your child
restraint.
Lower Anchor and Top Tether Anchor
Locations
Lower anchors (1) are metal bars built into
the vehicle. There are two lower anchors for
each LATCH seating position that will
accommodate a child restraint with lower
attachments (2).
A top tether (3, 4) is used to secure the top
of the child restraint to the vehicle. A top
tether anchor is built into the vehicle. The
top tether attachment hook (2) on the child
restraint connects to the top tether anchor
in the vehicle in order to reduce the forward
movement and rotation of the child restraint
during driving or in a crash.
The child restraint may have a single
tether (3) or a dual tether (4). Either will
have a single attachment hook (2) to secure
the top tether to the anchor.
Some child restraints that have a top tether
are designed for use with or without the
top tether being attached. Others require
55
I : Seating positions with top tether
anchors.
H : Seating positions with two lower
anchors.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
56
Seats and Restraints
Securing a Child Restraint Designed for
the LATCH System
{ Warning
A child could be seriously injured or killed
in a crash if the child restraint is not
properly attached to the vehicle using
either the LATCH anchors or the vehicle
seat belt. Follow the instructions that
came with the child restraint and the
instructions in this manual.
To assist in locating the lower anchors, each
seating position with lower anchors has two
labels, near the crease between the seatback
and the seat cushion.
The top tether anchors are located on the
rear seatbacks. Be sure to use an anchor
located directly behind the seating position
where the child restraint will be placed.
To assist in locating the top tether anchors,
the top tether anchor symbol is near the
trim opening used to access the anchor.
Do not secure a child restraint in a position
without a top tether anchor if a national or
local law requires that the top tether be
attached, or if the instructions that come
with the child restraint say that the top
tether must be attached.
According to accident statistics, children and
infants are safer when properly restrained in
a child restraint system or infant restraint
system secured in a rear seating position.
See Where to Put the Restraint 0 52 for
additional information.
{ Warning
To reduce the risk of serious or fatal
injuries during a crash, do not attach
more than one child restraint to a single
anchor. Attaching more than one child
restraint to a single anchor could cause
the anchor or attachment to come loose
or even break during a crash. A child or
others could be injured.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
{ Warning
Children can be seriously injured or
strangled if a shoulder belt is wrapped
around their neck. The shoulder belt can
tighten but cannot be loosened if it is
locked. The shoulder belt locks when it is
pulled all the way out of the retractor.
It unlocks when the shoulder belt is
allowed to go all the way back into the
retractor, but it cannot do this if it is
wrapped around a child’s neck. If the
shoulder belt is locked and tightened
around a child’s neck, the only way to
loosen the belt is to cut it.
Buckle any unused seat belts behind the
child restraint so children cannot reach
them. Pull the shoulder belt all the way
out of the retractor to set the lock, and
tighten the belt behind the child restraint
after the child restraint has been
installed.
Caution
Do not let the LATCH attachments rub
against the vehicle’s seat belts. This may
damage these parts. If necessary, move
buckled seat belts to avoid rubbing the
LATCH attachments.
Do not fold the rear seatback when the
seat is occupied. Do not fold the empty
rear seat with a seat belt buckled. This
could damage the seat belt or the seat.
Unbuckle and return the seat belt to its
stowed position, before folding the seat.
If you need to secure more than one child
restraint in the rear seat, see Where to Put
the Restraint 0 52.
1. Attach and tighten the lower
attachments to the lower anchors. If the
child restraint does not have lower
attachments or the desired seating
position does not have lower anchors,
secure the child restraint with the top
tether and the seat belt. Refer to the
child restraint manufacturer instructions
and the instructions in this manual.
1.1. Find the lower anchors for the
desired seating position.
1.2. Put the child restraint on the seat.
57
For rear outboard seating positions,
if the head restraint interferes with
the proper installation of the child
restraint, the head restraint may be
removed. See “Head Restraint
Removal and Reinstallation” at the
end of this section.
When installing a rear-facing child
restraint, it may be necessary to
move the front seat forward to
properly install the child restraint
per the child restraint manufacturer
instructions. See Seat Adjustment
0 26.
1.3. Attach and tighten the lower
attachments on the child restraint
to the lower anchors.
2. If the child restraint manufacturer
recommends that the top tether be
attached, attach and tighten the top
tether to the top tether anchor,
if equipped. Refer to the child restraint
instructions and the following steps:
2.1. Find the top tether anchor.
2.2. Attach the top tether to the top
tether anchor. The cargo cover can
be removed and placed in a secure
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
58
Seats and Restraints
area if it interferes with the
attachment of the top tether to the
top tether anchor.
2.3. Route, attach, and tighten the top
tether according to your child
restraint instructions and the
following instructions:
If you are using a dual tether in an
outboard seating position and the
head restraint has been removed,
route the tether over the seatback.
If you are using a single tether in
an outboard seating position and
the head restraint has been
removed, route the tether over the
seatback.
If the rear outboard seating position
you are using has an adjustable
head restraint and you are using a
single tether, raise the head
restraint and route the tether under
the head restraint and in between
the head restraint posts.
If the rear outboard seating position
you are using has an adjustable
head restraint and you are using a
dual tether, raise the head restraint
and route the tether under the
head restraint and around the head
restraint posts.
If the child restraint is installed next
to a center seat, make sure the top
tether does not interfere with the
center seating position shoulder
belt/retractor. If it does, find
another suitable seating position to
install the child restraint.
3. Before placing a child in the child
restraint, make sure it is securely held in
place. To check, grasp the child restraint
at the LATCH path and attempt to move
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
it side to side and back and forth. There
should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of
movement for proper installation.
Head Restraint Removal and
Reinstallation
The rear outboard head restraints can be
removed if they interfere with the proper
installation of the child restraint, see
“Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the
LATCH System” previously in this section.
Store the head restraints in a secure place.
To remove the head restraint:
1. Partially fold the seatback forward. See
Rear Seats 0 29 for more information.
2. Press both buttons on the head restraint
posts at the same time and pull up on
the head restraint.
3. Store the head restraints in a secure
place.
4. When the child restraint is removed,
reinstall the head restraint before the
seating position is used.
59
To reinstall the head restraint:
{ Warning
With head restraints that are not
installed and adjusted properly, there is a
greater chance that occupants will suffer
a neck/spinal injury in a crash. Do not
drive until the head restraints for all
occupants are installed and adjusted
properly.
1. Insert the head restraint posts into the
holes in the top of the seatback. The
notches on the posts must face the
driver side of the vehicle.
2. Push the head restraint down.
If necessary, press the height adjustment
release button to further lower the head
restraint. See Head Restraints 0 25.
3. Try to move the head restraint to make
sure that it is locked in place.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
60
Seats and Restraints
Replacing LATCH System Parts
After a Crash
{ Warning
A crash can damage the LATCH system in
the vehicle. A damaged LATCH system
may not properly secure the child
restraint, resulting in serious injury or
even death in a crash. To help make sure
the LATCH system is working properly
after a crash, see your dealer to have the
system inspected and any necessary
replacements made as soon as possible.
If the child restraint has the LATCH system,
see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children
(LATCH System) 0 53 for how and where to
install the child restraint using LATCH. If a
child restraint is secured in the vehicle using
a seat belt and it uses a top tether, see
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children
(LATCH System) 0 53 for top tether anchor
locations.
Do not secure a child seat in a position
without a top tether anchor if a national or
local law requires that the top tether be
anchored, or if the instructions that come
with the child restraint say that the top
tether must be anchored.
If the vehicle has the LATCH system and it
was being used during a crash, new LATCH
system parts may be needed.
In Canada, the law requires that
forward-facing child restraints have a top
tether, and that the tether be attached.
New parts and repairs may be necessary
even if the LATCH system was not being
used at the time of the crash.
If the child restraint or vehicle seat position
does not have the LATCH system, you will
be using the seat belt to secure the child
restraint. Be sure to follow the instructions
that came with the child restraint.
Securing Child Restraints (With
the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat)
When securing a child restraint in a rear
seating position, study the instructions that
came with the child restraint to make sure
it is compatible with this vehicle.
If more than one child restraint needs to be
installed in the rear seat, be sure to read
Where to Put the Restraint 0 52.
1. Put the child restraint on the seat.
If the head restraint interferes with the
proper installation of the child restraint,
the head restraint may be removed. See
“Head Restraint Removal and
Reinstallation” under Lower Anchors and
Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 53.
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap
and shoulder portions of the vehicle seat
belt through or around the child
restraint. The child restraint instructions
will show you how.
3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until
it clicks.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
Position the release button on the
buckle, away from the child restraint, so
that the seat belt could be quickly
unbuckled if necessary.
The push button used to release the
latch plate must be visible and not
obscured by the child restraint. There
must not be direct contact of the child
restraint to the push button.
4. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of
the retractor to set the lock. When the
retractor lock is set, the belt can be
tightened but not pulled out of the
retractor.
5. To tighten the belt, push down on the
child restraint, pull the shoulder portion
of the belt to tighten the lap portion of
the belt, and feed the shoulder belt back
into the retractor. When installing a
forward-facing child restraint, it may be
helpful to use your knee to push down
on the child restraint as you tighten
the belt.
Try to pull the belt out of the retractor
to make sure the retractor is locked.
If the retractor is not locked, repeat
Steps 4 and 5.
61
6. If the child restraint has a top tether,
follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions regarding the use of the top
tether. See Lower Anchors and Tethers
for Children (LATCH System) 0 53.
7. Before placing a child in the child
restraint, make sure it is securely held in
place. To check, grasp the child restraint
at the seat belt path and attempt to
move it side to side and back and forth.
When the child restraint is properly
installed, there should be no more than
2.5 cm (1 in) of movement.
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the
vehicle seat belt and let it return to the
stowed position. If the top tether is attached
to a top tether anchor, disconnect it. If the
head restraint was removed, reinstall it
before the seating position is used. See
“Head Restraint Removal and Reinstallation”
under Lower Anchors and Tethers for
Children (LATCH System) 0 53 for additional
information on installing the head restraint
properly.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
62
Seats and Restraints
Securing Child Restraints (With
the Seat Belt in the Front Seat)
This vehicle has airbags. A rear seat is a
safer place to secure a forward-facing child
restraint. See Where to Put the Restraint
0 52.
In addition, the vehicle has a passenger
sensing system which is designed to turn off
the front outboard passenger frontal airbag
and knee airbag under certain conditions.
See Passenger Sensing System 0 42 and
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 0 74 for
more information, including important
safety information.
Never put a rear-facing child seat in the
front. This is because the risk to the
rear-facing child is so great if the airbag
deploys.
{ Warning
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can
be seriously injured or killed if the front
outboard passenger frontal airbag
inflates. This is because the back of the
rear-facing child restraint would be very
close to the inflating airbag. A child in a
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
forward-facing child restraint can be
seriously injured or killed if the front
outboard passenger frontal airbag inflates
and the passenger seat is in a forward
position.
Even if the passenger sensing system has
turned off the front outboard passenger
airbag(s), no system is fail-safe. No one
can guarantee that an airbag will not
deploy under some unusual circumstance,
even though the airbag(s) are off.
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a
rear seat, even if the airbag(s) are off.
If you secure a forward-facing child
restraint in the front outboard passenger
seat, always move the seat as far back as
it will go. It is better to secure the child
restraint in a rear seat.
See Passenger Sensing System 0 42 for
additional information.
If the child restraint uses a top tether, see
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children
(LATCH System) 0 53 for top tether anchor
locations.
Do not secure a child seat in a position
without a top tether anchor if a national or
local law requires that the top tether be
anchored, or if the instructions that come
with the child restraint say that the top
tether must be anchored.
In Canada, the law requires that
forward-facing child restraints have a top
tether, and that the tether be attached.
When using the lap-shoulder belt to secure
the child restraint in this position, follow the
instructions that came with the child
restraint and the following instructions:
1. Move the seat as far back as it will go
before securing the forward-facing child
restraint. Move the seat upward or the
seatback to an upright position,
if needed, to get a tight installation of
the child restraint.
The push button used to release the
latch plate must be visible and not
obscured by the child restraint. There
must not be direct contact of the child
restraint to the push button.
When the passenger sensing system has
turned off the front outboard passenger
frontal airbag and knee airbag, the OFF
indicator on the passenger airbag status
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Seats and Restraints
63
indicator should light and stay lit when
you start the vehicle. See Passenger
Airbag Status Indicator 0 74.
2. Put the child restraint on the seat.
3. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap
and shoulder portions of the vehicle seat
belt through or around the restraint. The
child restraint instructions will show
you how.
4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until
it clicks.
Position the release button on the
buckle, away from the child restraint, so
that the seat belt could be quickly
unbuckled if necessary.
Tilt the latch plate to adjust the belt if
needed.
5. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of
the retractor to set the lock. When the
retractor lock is set, the belt can be
tightened but not pulled out of the
retractor.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
64
Seats and Restraints
7. Before placing a child in the child
restraint, make sure it is securely held in
place. To check, grasp the child restraint
at the seat belt path and attempt to
move it side to side and back and forth.
When the child restraint is properly
installed, there should be no more than
2.5 cm (1 in) of movement.
If the airbags are off, the OFF indicator in
the passenger airbag status indicator will
come on and stay on when the vehicle is
started.
6. To tighten the belt, push down on the
child restraint, pull the shoulder portion
of the belt to tighten the lap portion of
the belt, and feed the shoulder belt back
into the retractor. When installing a
forward-facing child restraint, it may be
helpful to use your knee to push down
on the child restraint as you tighten
the belt.
Try to pull the belt out of the retractor
to make sure the retractor is locked.
If the retractor is not locked, repeat
Steps 5 and 6.
If a child restraint has been installed and
the ON indicator is lit, see “If the On
Indicator Is Lit for a Child Restraint” under
Passenger Sensing System 0 42.
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the
vehicle seat belt and let it return to the
stowed position.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Storage
Storage
Storage Compartments
{ Warning
Storage Compartments
Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Additional Storage Features
Cargo Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Cargo Tie-Downs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Roof Rack System
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Do not store heavy or sharp objects in
storage compartments. In a crash, these
objects may cause the cover to open and
could result in injury.
Glove Box
Lift up on the glove box lever to open it.
65
{ Warning
Do not place objects on the cargo cover.
Sudden stops or turns can cause objects
to be thrown in the vehicle. You or
others could be injured.
The cargo cover can be used to cover items
in the rear of the vehicle. The cargo cover is
larger than the tailgate opening. Turn it for
easy removal or installation.
Additional Storage Features
Cargo Cover
{ Warning
An unsecured cargo cover could strike
people in a sudden stop or turn, or in a
crash. Store the cargo cover securely or
remove it from the vehicle.
To remove, pull the cargo cover upward.
To reinstall, align the cover with the hooks
on the trim panel edge and push downward.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
66
Storage
Cargo Tie-Downs
The cargo tie-downs can be used to secure
small loads.
Roof Rack System
The vehicle may be equipped with side-rails
for a roof rack system. Cargo must be
secured with properly installed cross rails
and other accessories designed to carry
cargo. These can be purchased from your
dealer.
{ Warning
Before driving and occasionally during a
trip, check that cargo is securely fastened,
rests evenly between the cross rails and
does not block the vehicle's lamps or
windows. Never load cargo directly on
the roof of the vehicle or allow cargo to
hang over the rear or sides of the vehicle.
Never load cargo without first properly
installing cross rails and other accessories
designed to carry cargo. Personal injury,
death or damage to the vehicle or other
property may occur.
If driving for a long distance, on rough
roads, or at high speeds, occasionally stop
the vehicle to make sure the cargo remains
in its place.
Cargo Weight Limits
Do not exceed the maximum cargo weight
for the roof rack system, including the
weight of the cross rails and any other
accessories used to carry the cargo such as
bike racks or roof boxes. The maximum
cargo weight that can be loaded onto the
roof rack system is 50 kg (110 lb) or the
weight designated in the instructions that
came with the cross rails or other roof rack
accessories, whichever is less.
{ Warning
Never load the roof rack with more
weight than specified in this section.
Loading cargo on the roof rack will make
the vehicle's center of gravity higher. To
avoid losing control of the vehicle, avoid
overloading, high speeds, sudden starts,
sharp turns, sudden braking, or abrupt
maneuvers when carrying cargo on the
roof rack.
The weight of any cargo carried on the roof
rack system must be included in calculating
the loaded weight of the vehicle. Do not
exceed the maximum vehicle capacity when
loading the vehicle, including cargo carried
on the roof rack system and passengers
and cargo carried in the vehicle. For more
information on vehicle capacity and loading,
see Vehicle Load Limits 0 129.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
Instruments and Controls
Controls
Steering Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Rear Window Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators
Warning Lights, Gauges, and
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Seat Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . 74
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Check
Engine Light) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Service Vehicle Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Owner Manual Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Brake System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Operate Pedal Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Up-Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Power Steering Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . 78
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Light . . . 78
Vehicle Ahead Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Ultrasonic Parking Sensor Light . . . . . . . . . 78
Traction Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
StabiliTrak OFF Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Traction Control System (TCS)/StabiliTrak
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Engine Coolant Temperature Warning
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Engine Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Immobilizer Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Reduced Engine Power Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Front Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Lamps On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Cruise Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Hood Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Door Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Information Displays
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . 82
67
Vehicle Messages
Vehicle Messages (Base Level
Cluster) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Vehicle Messages (Uplevel Cluster) . . . . . 87
Engine Power Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Vehicle Speed Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Vehicle Personalization
Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
68
Instruments and Controls
Controls
Steering Wheel Controls
Steering Wheel Adjustment
_ SRC ^ : Press to select a source or toggle
to change favorite stations.
+ x − : Press + to increase the volume.
Press − to decrease the volume.
Horn
Press a on the steering wheel pad to
sound the horn.
Windshield Wiper/Washer
To
1.
2.
3.
adjust the steering wheel:
Pull the lever down.
Move the steering wheel up or down.
Pull the lever up to lock the steering
wheel in place.
Do not adjust the steering wheel while
driving.
For vehicles with audio steering wheel
controls, some audio controls can be
adjusted at the steering wheel.
b / g : For vehicles with Bluetooth or
OnStar, press to interact with those systems.
See Bluetooth (Overview) 0 106 or
Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) 0 107
or
OnStar Overview 0 252.
The windshield wiper/washer lever is on the
right side of the steering column.
$ / i : Press to silence the vehicle
LO : Use for slow wipes.
speakers only. Press again to turn the sound
on. For vehicles with Bluetooth or OnStar
systems, press to reject an incoming call,
or to end a current call.
Move the lever to one of the following
positions:
HI : Use for fast wipes.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
Warning (Continued)
vehicle, including all lamps and windows.
Reduced visibility from snow and ice
buildup could lead to a crash.
INT : Move the lever up to INT for
intermittent wipes, then turn the x INT
band up for more frequent wipes or down
for less frequent wipes.
OFF : Use to turn the wipers off.
1X : For a single wipe, briefly move the
wiper lever down. For several wipes, hold
the wiper lever down.
{ Warning
In freezing weather, do not use the
washer until the windshield is warmed.
Otherwise the washer fluid can form ice
on the windshield, blocking your vision.
{ Warning
Before driving the vehicle, always clear
snow and ice from the hood, windshield,
washer nozzles, roof, and rear of the
(Continued)
Wiper Parking
If the ignition is turned off while the wipers
are on LO, HI, or INT, they will
immediately stop.
If the windshield wiper lever is then moved
to OFF before the driver door is opened or
within 10 minutes, the wipers will restart
and move to the base of the windshield.
69
Clear snow and ice from the wiper blades
before using them. If frozen to the
windshield, carefully loosen or thaw them.
Damaged wiper blades should be replaced.
See Wiper Blade Replacement 0 177.
Heavy snow or ice can overload the wiper
motor. A circuit breaker will stop the motor
until it cools down.
Rear Window Wiper/Washer
If equipped with the rear wiper/washer, the
controls are on the end of the windshield
wiper lever.
If the ignition is turned off while the wipers
are performing wipes due to windshield
washing, the wipers continue to run until
they reach the base of the windshield.
b : Pull the windshield wiper lever toward
you to spray windshield washer fluid and
activate the wipers. The wipers will continue
until the lever is released or the maximum
wash time is reached. When the windshield
wiper lever is released, additional wipes may
occur depending on how long the windshield
washer had been activated. See Washer
Fluid 0 172 for information on filling the
windshield washer fluid reservoir.
ON : Press the upper portion of the button
for continuous rear window wipes.
OFF : The rear wiper turns off when the
button is returned to the middle position.
INT : Press the lower portion of the button
to set a delay between wipes.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
70
Instruments and Controls
a : Push the windshield wiper lever
forward to spray washer fluid on the rear
window. The lever returns to its starting
position when released.
Auto Wipe in Reverse Gear
If the rear wiper control is off, the rear
wiper will automatically operate
continuously when the shift lever is in
R (Reverse), and the front windshield wiper
is performing low or high speed wipes.
If the rear wiper control is off, the shift
lever is in R (Reverse), and the front
windshield wiper is performing interval
wipes, then the rear wiper automatically
performs interval wipes.
This feature can be changed. See Vehicle
Personalization 0 88.
The windshield washer reservoir is used for
the windshield and the rear window. Check
the fluid level in the reservoir if either
washer is not working. See Washer Fluid
0 172.
Compass
The vehicle may have a compass display on
the Driver Information Center (DIC). The
compass receives its heading and other
information from the Global Positioning
System (GPS) antenna, StabiliTrak/Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), and vehicle speed
information.
The compass system is designed to operate
for a certain number of miles or degrees of
turn before needing a signal from the GPS
satellites. When the compass display shows
CAL, drive the vehicle for a short distance in
an open area where it can receive a GPS
signal. The compass system will
automatically determine when a GPS signal
is restored and provide a heading again.
Clock
Set the time and date using the
infotainment system. See "Time / Date"
under Settings 0 111.
Power Outlets
The accessory power outlets can be used to
plug in electrical equipment, such as a cell
phone or MP3 player.
The vehicle has an accessory power outlet
on the center stack.
Open the cover to access and replace when
not in use.
{ Warning
Power is always supplied to the outlets.
Do not leave electrical equipment
plugged in when the vehicle is not in use
because the vehicle could catch fire and
cause injury or death.
Caution
Leaving electrical equipment plugged in
for an extended period of time while the
vehicle is off will drain the battery.
Always unplug electrical equipment when
not in use and do not plug in equipment
that exceeds the maximum 20 amp
rating.
Certain accessory power plugs may not be
compatible with the accessory power outlet
and could overload vehicle or adapter fuses.
If a problem is experienced, see your dealer.
When adding electrical equipment, be sure
to follow the proper installation instructions
included with the equipment. See Add-On
Electrical Equipment 0 158.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
Caution
Instrument Cluster
Hanging heavy equipment from the
power outlet can cause damage not
covered by the vehicle warranty. The
power outlets are designed for accessory
power plugs only, such as cell phone
charge cords.
Warning Lights, Gauges, and
Indicators
Warning lights and gauges can signal that
something is wrong before it becomes
serious enough to cause an expensive repair
or replacement. Paying attention to the
warning lights and gauges could prevent
injury.
Some warning lights come on briefly when
the engine is started to indicate they are
working. When one of the warning lights
comes on and stays on while driving,
or when one of the gauges shows there
may be a problem, check the section that
explains what to do. Waiting to do repairs
can be costly and even dangerous.
English Shown, Metric Similar
1. Fuel Gauge 0 72
2. Tachometer 0 72
3. Speedometer 0 72
4. Driver Information Center (DIC) 0 82
71
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
72
Instruments and Controls
Speedometer
Caution (Continued)
The speedometer shows the vehicle speed in
kilometers per hour (km/h) and miles per
hour (mph).
Odometer
The odometer shows how far the vehicle has
been driven, in either kilometers or miles.
covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not
operate the engine with the rpm in the
warning area.
Fuel Gauge
Trip Odometer
The trip odometer shows how far the
vehicle has been driven since the trip
odometer was last reset.
The trip odometer is accessed and reset
through the Driver Information Center (DIC).
See Driver Information Center (DIC) 0 82.
Tachometer
The tachometer displays the engine speed in
revolutions per minute (rpm).
Caution
If the engine is operated with the rpm in
the warning area at the high end of the
tachometer, the vehicle could be
damaged, and the damage would not be
(Continued)
English Shown, Metric Similar
When the ignition is on, the fuel gauge
shows how much fuel is left in the
fuel tank.
There is an arrow near the fuel gauge
pointing to the side of the vehicle the fuel
door is on.
When the indicator nears empty, a message
in the Driver Information Center (DIC)
displays. There still is a little fuel left, but
the vehicle should be refueled soon.
Here are three things that some owners ask
about. None of these show a problem with
the fuel gauge:
. It takes a little more, or less fuel to fill up
than the gauge indicated. For example,
the gauge may have indicated the tank
was half full, but it actually took a little
more, or less than half the tank's capacity
to fill the tank.
. The gauge moves a little while turning a
corner, speeding up or braking.
. The gauge takes a few seconds to
stabilize after the ignition is turned on
and goes back to empty when the
ignition is turned off.
Seat Belt Reminders
Driver Seat Belt Reminder Light
There is a driver seat belt reminder light on
the instrument cluster.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
When the vehicle is started, this light
flashes and a chime may come on to remind
the driver to fasten the seat belt. Then the
light stays on solid until the belt is buckled.
This cycle may continue several times if the
driver remains or becomes unbuckled while
the vehicle is moving.
If the driver seat belt is buckled, neither the
chime nor the light comes on.
Front Passenger Seat Belt Reminder
Light
The vehicle may have a front passenger seat
belt reminder light near the passenger
airbag status indicator.
When the vehicle is started, this light
flashes and a chime may come on to remind
in front of passenger to fasten the seat belt.
Then the light stays on solid until the belt is
buckled. This cycle may continue several
times if the passenger remains or becomes
unbuckled while the vehicle is moving.
If the passenger seat belt is buckled, neither
the chime nor the light comes on.
The front passenger seat belt reminder light
and chime may turn on if an object is put
on the seat such as a briefcase, handbag,
grocery bag, laptop, or other electronic
device. To turn off the reminder light and/or
chime, remove the object from the seat or
buckle the seat belt.
Airbag Readiness Light
This light shows if there is an electrical
problem with the airbag system. It is
located in the instrument cluster. The
system check includes the airbag sensor(s),
the passenger sensing system, the
pretensioners, the airbag modules, the
wiring, and the crash sensing and diagnostic
module. For more information on the airbag
system, see Airbag System 0 37.
73
The airbag readiness light comes on for
several seconds when the vehicle is started.
If the light does not come on then, have it
fixed immediately.
{ Warning
If the airbag readiness light stays on
after the vehicle is started or comes on
while driving, it means the airbag system
might not be working properly. The
airbags in the vehicle might not inflate in
a crash, or they could even inflate
without a crash. To help avoid injury,
have the vehicle serviced right away.
If there is a problem with the airbag
system, a Driver Information Center (DIC)
message may also come on.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
74
Instruments and Controls
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator
The vehicle has a passenger sensing system.
See Passenger Sensing System 0 42 for
important safety information. The overhead
console has a passenger airbag status
indicator.
United States
Canada
When the vehicle is started, the passenger
airbag status indicator will light ON and OFF,
or the symbols for on and off, for several
seconds as a system check. Then, after
several seconds, the status indicator will
light either ON or OFF, or the on or off
symbol to let you know the status of the
front outboard passenger frontal airbag and
knee airbag.
If the word ON or the on symbol is lit on
the passenger airbag status indicator, it
means that the front outboard passenger
frontal airbag and knee airbag are allowed
to inflate.
Warning (Continued)
away. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 73 for
more information, including important
safety information.
Charging System Light
If the word OFF or the off symbol is lit on
the passenger airbag status indicator, it
means that the passenger sensing system
has turned off the front outboard passenger
frontal airbag and knee airbag.
If, after several seconds, both status
indicator lights remain on, or if there are no
lights at all, there may be a problem with
the lights or the passenger sensing system.
See your dealer for service.
The charging system light comes on briefly
when the ignition is turned on, but the
engine is not running, as a check to show
the light is working. It should go out when
the engine is started.
{ Warning
If the light stays on, or comes on while
driving, there may be a problem with the
electrical charging system. Have it checked
by your dealer. Driving while this light is on
could drain the battery.
If the airbag readiness light ever comes
on and stays on, it means that
something may be wrong with the airbag
system. To help avoid injury to yourself
or others, have the vehicle serviced right
(Continued)
When this light comes on, or is flashing, the
Driver Information Center (DIC) also displays
a message.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
If a short distance must be driven with the
light on, be sure to turn off all accessories,
such as the radio and air conditioner. Find a
safe place to stop the vehicle.
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(Check Engine Light)
This light is part of the vehicle’s emission
control on-board diagnostic system. If this
light is on while the engine is running, a
malfunction has been detected and the
vehicle may require service. The light should
come on to show that it is working when
the ignition is on with the engine not
running for Key Access or in Service Mode
for Keyless Access. See Ignition Positions
(Keyless Access) 0 134 or
Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 132.
Malfunctions are often indicated by the
system before any problem is noticeable.
Being aware of the light and seeking service
promptly when it comes on may prevent
damage.
Caution
If the vehicle is driven continually with
this light on, the emission control system
may not work as well, the fuel economy
may be lower, and the vehicle may not
run smoothly. This could lead to costly
repairs that might not be covered by the
vehicle warranty.
Caution
Modifications to the engine, transmission,
exhaust, intake, or fuel system, or the
use of replacement tires that do not
meet the original tire specifications, can
cause this light to come on. This could
lead to costly repairs not covered by the
vehicle warranty. This could also affect
the vehicle’s ability to pass an Emissions
Inspection/Maintenance test. See
Accessories and Modifications 0 160.
If the light is flashing : A malfunction has
been detected that could damage the
emission control system and increase vehicle
emissions. Diagnosis and service may be
required.
75
To help prevent damage, reduce vehicle
speed and avoid hard accelerations and
uphill grades.
If the light continues to flash, find a safe
place to park. Turn the vehicle off and wait
at least 10 seconds before restarting the
engine. If the light is still flashing, follow
the previous guidelines and see your dealer
for service as soon as possible.
If the light is on steady : A malfunction has
been detected. Diagnosis and service may be
required.
Check the following:
. A loose or missing fuel cap may cause
the light to come on. See Filling the Tank
0 156. A few driving trips with the cap
properly installed may turn the light off.
. Poor fuel quality can cause inefficient
engine operation and poor driveability,
which may go away once the engine is
warmed up. If this occurs, change the fuel
brand. It may require at least one full
tank of the proper fuel to turn the light
off. See Recommended Fuel 0 155.
If the light remains on, see your dealer.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
76
Instruments and Controls
Emissions Inspection and Maintenance
Programs
If the vehicle requires an Emissions
Inspection/Maintenance test, the test
equipment will likely connect to the
vehicle's Data Link Connector (DLC).
The DLC is under the instrument panel to
the left of the steering wheel. Connecting
devices that are not used to perform an
Emissions Inspection/Maintenance test or to
service the vehicle may affect vehicle
operation. See Add-On Electrical Equipment
0 158. See your dealer if assistance is
needed.
The vehicle may not pass inspection if:
. The light is on when the engine is
running.
. The light does not come on when the
ignition is on with the engine not running
for Key Access or in Service Mode for
Keyless Access.
. Critical emission control systems have not
been completely diagnosed. If this
happens, the vehicle would not be ready
for inspection and might require
several days of routine driving before the
system is ready for inspection. This can
happen if the 12-volt battery has recently
been replaced or run down, or if the
vehicle has been recently serviced.
Owner Manual Indicator
See your dealer if the vehicle will not pass
or cannot be made ready for the test.
This symbol is shown when you need to see
the owner’s manual for additional
instructions or information.
Service Vehicle Soon Light
Brake System Warning Light
Metric
For vehicles with this light, it comes on if a
condition exists that may require the vehicle
to be taken in for service.
If the light comes on, take the vehicle to
your dealer for service as soon as possible.
English
This light should come on briefly when the
vehicle is turned on. If it does not come on
then, have it fixed so it will be ready to
warn you if there is a problem.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
When the vehicle is on, the brake system
warning light also comes on when the
parking brake is set. The light stays on if
the parking brake does not fully release. If it
stays on after the parking brake is fully
released, there is a brake problem. Have the
brake system inspected right away.
If the light comes on while driving, pull off
the road and stop carefully. The brake pedal
might be harder to push, or the brake pedal
may go closer to the floor. It could take
longer to stop. If the light is still on, have
the vehicle towed for service. See Towing
the Vehicle 0 212.
{ Warning
The brake system might not be working
properly if the brake system warning
light is on. Driving with the brake system
warning light on can lead to a crash.
If the light is still on after the vehicle has
been pulled off the road and carefully
stopped, have the vehicle towed for
service.
77
Antilock Brake System (ABS)
Warning Light
See Brake System Warning Light 0 76.
This warning light should come on briefly
when the vehicle is turned on. If the light
does not come on, have it fixed so it will be
ready to warn if there is a problem.
This light comes on when the clutch or
brake pedal needs to be applied to start the
vehicle.
If the light comes on while driving, safely
stop as soon as it is possible and turn off
the vehicle. Then turn on the vehicle again
to reset the system.
Operate Pedal Light
Up-Shift Light
If the ABS warning light stays on, or comes
on again while driving, the vehicle needs
service. A chime may also sound when the
light stays on.
The vehicle may have an up-shift light.
If the ABS warning light is the only light on,
the vehicle has regular brakes, but ABS is
not functioning.
When this light comes on, shift to the next
higher gear if weather, road, and traffic
conditions allow.
If both the ABS warning light and the brake
system warning light are on, ABS is not
functioning and there is a problem with the
regular brakes. See your dealer for service.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
78
Instruments and Controls
Power Steering Warning Light
This light changes to amber and flashes to
indicate that the lane marking has been
crossed without using a turn signal in that
direction.
See Lane Departure Warning (LDW) 0 154.
Vehicle Ahead Indicator
If equipped, this light comes on briefly while
starting the vehicle. If it does not come on,
have the vehicle serviced.
This light indicates a malfunction in the
system. See your dealer for service.
See Park Assist 0 151.
Traction Off Light
This light comes on briefly when the
ignition is turned on as a check to show it is
working.
If it does not come on have the vehicle
serviced by your dealer.
If this light stays on, or comes on while
driving, the system may not be working.
If this happens, see your dealer for service.
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
Light
If equipped, this indicator will display green
when a vehicle is detected ahead and amber
when you are following a vehicle ahead
much too closely.
See Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System
0 152.
Ultrasonic Parking Sensor Light
This light is green if LDW is on and ready to
operate.
This light comes on briefly when the vehicle
is turned on. If it does not, have the vehicle
serviced by your dealer. If the system is
working normally, the indicator light then
turns off.
The traction off light comes on when the
Traction Control System (TCS) has been
turned off. If StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) is turned off, TCS is also
turned off. To turn TCS and ESC off and on,
see Traction Control/Electronic Stability
Control 0 145.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
If TCS is off, wheel spin is not limited unless
necessary to help protect the driveline from
damage. Adjust driving accordingly.
79
Traction Control System (TCS)/
StabiliTrak Light
Engine Coolant Temperature
Warning Light
This light comes on briefly when the vehicle
is turned on.
This light comes on briefly while starting
the vehicle.
If the light does not come on, have the
vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the
system is working normally, the indicator
light turns off.
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by
your dealer. If the system is working
normally the indicator light goes off.
StabiliTrak OFF Light
This light comes on briefly when the vehicle
is turned on. If the light does not come on,
have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.
If the system is working normally, the
indicator light then turns off.
This light comes on when the StabiliTrak/
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system is
turned off. If StabiliTrak/ESC is off, the
Traction Control System (TCS) is also off. To
turn ESC off and on, see Traction Control/
Electronic Stability Control 0 145.
If ESC and TCS are off, the systems do not
assist in controlling the vehicle. Adjust
driving accordingly.
If the light is on and not flashing, the TCS
and potentially the StabiliTrak/ESC system
are not fully operational and may not assist
in maintaining control. Adjust driving
accordingly. If the condition persists, see
your dealer as soon as possible. A Driver
Information Center (DIC) message may
display.
The light flashes when the TCS and/or the
StabiliTrak/ESC system is actively working.
See Traction Control/Electronic Stability
Control 0 145.
Caution
The engine coolant temperature warning
light indicates that the vehicle has
overheated. Driving with this light on can
damage the engine and it may not be
covered by the vehicle warranty. See
Engine Overheating 0 171.
The engine coolant temperature warning
light comes on when the engine has
overheated.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
80
Instruments and Controls
If this happens, pull over and turn off the
engine as soon as possible. See Engine
Overheating 0 171.
Tire Pressure Light
When the Light Flashes First and Then Is On
Steady
If the light flashes for about a minute and
then stays on, there may be a problem with
the TPMS. If the problem is not corrected,
the light will come on at every ignition
cycle. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation
0 196.
Engine Oil Pressure Light
For vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor
System (TPMS), this light comes on briefly
when the vehicle is started. It provides
information about tire pressures and
the TPMS.
When the Light Is On Steady
This indicates that one or more of the tires
are significantly underinflated.
A Driver Information Center (DIC) tire
pressure message may also display. Stop as
soon as possible, and inflate the tires to the
pressure value shown on the Tire and
Loading Information label. See Tire Pressure
0 194.
Caution
Lack of proper engine oil maintenance
can damage the engine. Driving with the
engine oil low can also damage the
engine. The repairs would not be covered
by the vehicle warranty. Check the oil
level as soon as possible. Add oil if
required, but if the oil level is within the
operating range and the oil pressure is
still low, have the vehicle serviced.
Always follow the maintenance schedule
for changing engine oil.
This light should come on briefly as the
engine is started. If it does not come on,
have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.
If the light comes on and stays on, it means
that oil is not flowing through the engine
properly. The vehicle could be low on oil
and might have some other system
problem. See your dealer.
Low Fuel Warning Light
A Low Fuel Warning Light near the fuel
gauge comes on briefly when the ignition is
turned on as a check to show it is working.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
It also comes on when the fuel gauge
indicator nears empty. The light turns off
when fuel is added. If it does not, have the
vehicle serviced.
Reduced Engine Power Light
High-Beam On Light
The reduced engine power light should come
on briefly as the engine is started. If it does
not come on, have the vehicle serviced by
your dealer.
This light comes on when the high-beam
headlamps are in use.
81
Immobilizer Light
The immobilizer light should come on briefly
as the engine is started. If it does not come
on, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.
If the system is working normally, the
indicator light turns off.
If the light stays on and the engine does
not start, there could be a problem with the
immobilizer system. See Immobilizer
Operation (Key Access) 0 19 or
Immobilizer Operation (Keyless Access) 0 19.
This light, along with the malfunction
indicator lamp, displays when a noticeable
reduction in the vehicle's performance
occurs.
The vehicle can be driven at a reduced
speed when the reduced engine power light
is on but acceleration and speed might be
reduced. If this light stays on, see your
dealer as soon as possible for diagnosis and
repair.
See Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer
0 91.
Front Fog Lamp Light
For vehicles with fog lamps, this light comes
on when the fog lamps are turned on.
The light goes out when the fog lamps are
turned off. See Fog Lamps 0 94.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
82
Instruments and Controls
Lamps On Reminder
Hood Ajar Light
Information Displays
Driver Information Center (DIC)
This light comes on when the exterior lamps
are in use, except when only the Daytime
Running Lamps (DRL) are active. See Exterior
Lamp Controls 0 91.
Cruise Control Light
This light comes on when the hood is open
or not securely latched. Before driving, check
that the hood is properly closed.
Door Ajar Light
The DIC displays information about the
vehicle. It also displays warning messages if
a system problem is detected. All messages
appear in the DIC display in the instrument
cluster.
DIC Operation and Displays
On some models, the trip odometer reset
stem is used to operate the DIC. On other
models, the controls for the DIC are on the
turn signal lever.
DIC Buttons
The cruise control light is white when the
cruise control is on and ready, and turns
green when the cruise control is set and
active.
The light goes out when the cruise control is
turned off. See Cruise Control 0 147.
This light comes on when a door is open or
not securely latched. Before driving, check
that all doors are properly closed.
1. SET/CLR: Press to set or clear the menu
item displayed.
2.
w / x: Turn the band to scroll
through the menus.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
83
3. MENU: Press to display the Trip/Fuel
menu and the Vehicle Information menu.
This button is also used to return to or
exit the last screen displayed on the DIC.
to the engine oil life system monitoring the
oil life, additional maintenance is
recommended. See Maintenance Schedule
0 226.
kilopascal (kPa) or pounds per square
inch (psi). See Tire Pressure Monitor System
0 195 and
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation 0 196.
Vehicle Information Menu Items (Base
Level DIC)
Remember, the Oil Life display must be
reset after each oil change. It will not reset
itself. Also, be careful not to reset the Oil
Life display accidentally at any time other
than when the oil has just been changed.
It cannot be reset accurately until the next
oil change. To reset, see Engine Oil Life
System 0 166.
Trip/Fuel Menu Items (Base Level DIC)
Press MENU to view the DIC menu. Some
items display in the upper display area,
some in the lower display area, and others
use both the upper and lower display areas.
Use w / x to scroll through the menu
items. Not all items are available on every
vehicle. The following is a list of possible
menu items:
. Remaining Oil Life
. Units
. Tire Learn
Remaining Oil Life
This menu is not available while the vehicle
is moving. This display shows an estimate of
the oil's remaining useful life. If 99 : % is
displayed, that means 99% of the current oil
life remains.
When the remaining oil life is low,
the : % CHANGE message will appear on
the display. The oil should changed as soon
as possible. See Engine Oil 0 164. In addition
Units
This menu is not available while the vehicle
is moving. Press SET/CLR while the unit
display is active and move w / x to
change units when UNIT SET is displayed.
Press SET/CLR to confirm the setting. Select
1, 2, or 3 for the unit display. 1 is metric
units, 2 is Imperial units, and 3 is US units.
This will change the displays on the cluster
and DIC to the type of measurements
selected.
Tire Learn
This display allows for matching of the
TPMS sensors. The display will show a
vehicle with the approximate pressures of all
four tires. Tire pressure is displayed in either
Press MENU until the Trip/Fuel menu is
displayed. Use w / x to scroll through the
menu items. On some models, use the trip
odometer reset stem to scroll through the
menu. Not all items are available on every
vehicle. The following is a list of possible
menu items:
. Trip Odometer
. Fuel Range
. Average Vehicle Speed
. Instantaneous Fuel Economy
. Average Fuel Economy
. Timer
Trip Odometer
This display shows the current distance
traveled, in either kilometers (km) or
miles (mi), since the last reset for the trip
odometer. The trip odometer can be reset to
zero by pressing SET/CLR or pressing and
holding the trip odometer reset stem while
the trip odometer display is showing.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
84
Instruments and Controls
Fuel Range
Average Fuel Economy
This display shows the approximate distance
the vehicle can be driven without refueling.
The fuel range estimate is based on an
average of the vehicle's fuel economy over
recent driving history and the amount of
fuel remaining in the fuel tank. Fuel range
cannot be reset.
This display shows the approximate average
liters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles
per gallon (mpg). This number is calculated
based on the number of L/100 km (mpg)
recorded since the last time this menu item
was reset. This number reflects only the
approximate average fuel economy that the
vehicle has right now, and will change as
driving conditions change. The fuel economy
can be reset by pressing SET/CLR or pressing
and holding the trip odometer reset stem
while the Average Fuel Economy display is
showing.
Average Vehicle Speed
This display shows the average speed of the
vehicle in kilometers per hour (km/h) or
miles per hour (mph). This average is
calculated based on the various vehicle
speeds recorded since the last reset of this
value. The average speed can be reset by
pressing SET/CLR or pressing and holding the
trip odometer reset stem while the Average
Vehicle Speed display is showing.
Instantaneous Fuel Economy
The instantaneous fuel economy display
shows the current fuel economy in liters per
100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles per
gallon (mpg). This number reflects only the
approximate fuel economy that the vehicle
has right now and changes frequently as
driving conditions change. This display
cannot be reset.
Timer
Available on some vehicles, this display can
be used as a timer. To start the timer, press
SET/CLR while Timer is displayed. The
display will show the amount of time that
has passed since the timer was last reset,
not including time the ignition is off. Time
will continue to be counted as long as the
ignition is on, even if another display is
being shown on the DIC. The timer will
record up to 9 hours, 59 minutes, and
59 seconds (9:59:59) after which the display
will return to zero. To stop the timer, press
SET/CLR briefly while Timer is displayed. To
reset the timer to zero, press and hold
SET/CLR.
Trip/Fuel Menu Items (Uplevel DIC)
Press MENU until the Trip/Fuel menu is
displayed. Use w / x to scroll through the
menu items. Not all items are available on
every vehicle. The following is a list of
possible menu items:
. Digital Speedometer
. Trip 1
. Trip 2
. Fuel Range
. Instantaneous Fuel Economy
. Average Fuel Economy
. Average Vehicle Speed
. Timer
Digital Speedometer
The digital speedometer, available on some
vehicles, shows how fast the vehicle is
moving in either kilometers per hour (km/h)
or miles per hour (mph). The speedometer
cannot be reset.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
Trip 1 and Trip 2
Average Fuel Economy
This display shows the current distance
traveled, in either kilometers (km) or
miles (mi), since the last reset for the trip
odometer. The trip odometer can be reset to
zero by pressing SET/CLR while the trip
odometer display is showing.
This display shows the approximate average
liters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles
per gallon (mpg). This number is calculated
based on the number of L/100 km (mpg)
recorded since the last time this menu item
was reset. This number reflects only the
approximate average fuel economy that the
vehicle has right now, and will change as
driving conditions change. The fuel economy
can be reset by pressing SET/CLR while the
Average Fuel Economy display is showing.
Fuel Range
This display shows the approximate distance
the vehicle can be driven without refueling.
The fuel range estimate is based on an
average of the vehicle's fuel economy over
recent driving history and the amount of
fuel remaining in the fuel tank. Fuel range
cannot be reset.
Instantaneous Fuel Economy
The instantaneous fuel economy display
shows the current fuel economy in liters per
100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles per
gallon (mpg). This number reflects only the
approximate fuel economy that the vehicle
has right now and changes frequently as
driving conditions change. Unlike average
economy, this display cannot be reset.
Average Vehicle Speed
This display shows the average speed of the
vehicle in kilometers per hour (km/h) or
miles per hour (mph). This average is
calculated based on the various vehicle
speeds recorded since the last reset of this
value. The average speed can be reset by
pressing SET/CLR while the Average Vehicle
Speed display is showing.
Timer
Available on some vehicles, this display can
be used as a timer. To start the timer, press
SET/CLR while Timer is displayed. The
display will show the amount of time that
has passed since the timer was last reset,
not including time the ignition is off. Time
85
will continue to be counted as long as the
ignition is on, even if another display is
being shown on the DIC. The timer will
record up to 99 hours, 59 minutes, and
59 seconds (99:59:59) after which the
display will return to zero. To stop the
timer, press SET/CLR briefly while Timer is
displayed. To reset the timer to zero, press
and hold SET/CLR.
Vehicle Information Menu Items
(Uplevel DIC)
Press MENU on the turn signal lever until
Vehicle Information menu is displayed. Use
w / x to scroll through the following
possible menu items:
. Display Units
. Tire Pressure
. Remaining Oil Life
Display Units
Move w / x to switch between metric or
US when the Unit display is active. Press
SET/CLR to confirm the setting. This will
change the displays on the cluster and DIC
to either metric or English (US)
measurements.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
86
Instruments and Controls
Tire Pressure
The display will show a vehicle with the
approximate pressures of all four tires. Tire
pressure is displayed in either
kilopascal (kPa) or pounds per square
inch (psi). See Tire Pressure Monitor System
0 195 and
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation 0 196.
Remaining Oil Life
This menu is not available while the vehicle
is moving. This display shows an estimate of
the oil's remaining useful life. If REMAINING
OIL LIFE 99 % is displayed, that means 99%
of the current oil life remains.
When the remaining oil life is low, the
CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message will
appear on the display. The oil should
changed as soon as possible. See Engine Oil
0 164. In addition to the engine oil life
system monitoring the oil life, additional
maintenance is recommended. See
Maintenance Schedule 0 226.
Remember, the Oil Life display must be
reset after each oil change. It will not reset
itself. Also, be careful not to reset the Oil
Life display accidentally at any time other
than when the oil has just been changed.
It cannot be reset accurately until the next
oil change. To reset, see Engine Oil Life
System 0 166.
Vehicle Messages
Vehicle Messages (Base Level
Cluster)
DIC messages display when the status of the
vehicle has changed and action may be
needed to correct the condition. Multiple
messages appear one after another. All
messages should be taken seriously.
On the base level cluster, vehicle messages
appear as code numbers. Some of these
codes may appear along with the service
vehicle soon light and the owner’s manual
symbol in the DIC display.
15 : Check High Mounted Brake Lamp
16 : Check Brake Lamps
17 : Headlamp Leveling Malfunction —
Contact Service
18 : Left Low Beam Failure
20 : Right Low Beam Failure
21 : Check Left Position Lamp
22 : Check Right Position Lamp
23 : Reversing Lamp Failure
24 : License Plate Lamp Failure
25 : Left Front Turn Indicator Failure
26 : Left Rear Turn Indicator Failure
27 : Right Front Turn Indicator Failure
28 : Right Rear Turn Indicator Failure
2 : No Remote Detected, Press Clutch To
Restart
35 : Replace Battery In Remote Key
4 : A/C Off Due to High Engine Temp
52 : Change Timing Belt – See Owner’s
Manual
5 : Steering Column Is Locked
49 : Lane Departure Warning Unavailable
7 : Turn Steering Wheel, Turn Key Off,
Then On
53 : Tighten Gas Cap
9 : Turn Steering Wheel, Start Vehicle Again
65 : Theft Attempted
10 : Brakes Overheated
66 : Service Theft Alarm
59 : Open, Then Close Driver Window
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
67 : Service Steering Column Lock
68 : Service Power Steering, Drive with Care
77 : Service Front Camera
79 : Engine Oil Low – Add Oil
81 : Service Transmission
84 : Engine Power Is Reduced
88 : Use Transmitter Pocket to Start
89 : Service Vehicle Soon
91 : No Remote Detected
92 : No Remote Detected, Press Brake To
Restart
93 : Press Button Again To Turn Engine Off
94 : Shift to Park
95 : Service Airbag
174 : Low Battery
258 : Park Assist Off
Engine Oil Messages
: % CHANGE
This message displays when the engine oil
needs to be changed. When changing the
engine oil, be sure to reset the Oil Life
System. See Engine Oil Life System 0 166,
Engine Oil 0 164, and Maintenance Schedule
0 226.
Vehicle Messages (Uplevel
Cluster)
Messages displayed on the DIC indicate the
status of the vehicle or some action that
may be needed to correct a condition.
Multiple messages may appear one after
another.
The messages that do not require
immediate action can be acknowledged and
cleared by pressing SET/CLR. The messages
that require immediate action cannot be
cleared until that action is performed.
All messages should be taken seriously;
clearing the message does not correct the
problem.
If a SERVICE message appears, see your
dealer.
Follow the instructions given in the
messages. The system displays messages
regarding the following topics:
. Service Messages
. Fluid Levels
. Vehicle Security
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
87
Brakes
Steering
Ride Control Systems
Driver Assistance Systems
Cruise Control
Lighting and Bulb Replacement
Wiper/Washer Systems
Doors and Windows
Seat Belts
Airbag Systems
Engine and Transmission
Tire Pressure
Battery
Engine Power Messages
ENGINE POWER IS REDUCED
This message displays when the vehicle's
propulsion power is reduced. A reduction in
propulsion power can affect the vehicle's
ability to accelerate. If this message is on,
but there is no observed reduction in
performance, proceed to your destination.
Under certain conditions the performance
may be reduced the next time the vehicle is
driven. The vehicle may be driven while this
message is on, but maximum acceleration
and speed may be reduced. Anytime this
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
88
Instruments and Controls
message stays on, or displays repeatedly,
the vehicle should be taken to your dealer
for service as soon as possible.
2. Touch Vehicle to display a list of
available options.
3. Touch to select the desired feature
setting.
Forward Collision System
Vehicle Speed Messages
5. Touch z to go to the top level of the
Settings menu.
This setting controls the vehicle response
when detecting a vehicle ahead of you. The
Off setting disables all FCA and AEB
functions. With the Alert and Brake setting,
both FCA and AEB are available. The Alert
setting disables AEB. See Automatic
Emergency Braking (AEB) 0 153.
The menu may contain the following:
Touch Off, Alert, or Alert and Brake.
SPEED LIMITED TO XXX KM/H (MPH)
Vehicle
Comfort and Convenience
This message shows that the vehicle speed
has been limited to the speed displayed. The
limited speed is a protection for various
propulsion and vehicle systems, such as
lubrication, thermal, brakes, suspension,
Teen Driver if equipped, or tires.
The menu may contain the following:
Touch and the following may display:
. Chime Volume
. Auto Wipe in Reverse Gear
Vehicle Personalization
Touch Off or On.
The following are all possible vehicle
personalization features. Depending on the
vehicle, some may not be available.
Collision / Detection Systems
Under certain operating conditions,
propulsion will be disabled. Try restarting
after the ignition has been off for
30 seconds.
For System and Apps features and functions,
see Settings 0 111.
To access the vehicle personalization menu:
1. Touch the Settings icon on the Home
Page of the infotainment display.
4. Touch
9 or R to turn a feature off or on.
Rear Seat Reminder
This allows for a chime and a message when
the rear door has been opened before or
during operation of the vehicle.
Touch and the following may display:
. Park Assist
. Forward Collision System
Park Assist
This feature can assist in backing up and
parking the vehicle. See Park Assist 0 151.
Touch Off or On.
Chime Volume
This allows the selection of the chime
volume level.
Touch the controls on the infotainment
display to adjust the volume.
Auto Wipe in Reverse Gear
When on and the front wiper is on, the rear
wiper will automatically activate when the
vehicle is shifted to R (Reverse).
Touch Off or On.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Instruments and Controls
Lighting
Open Door Anti Lock Out
Touch and the following may display:
. Vehicle Locator Lights
. Exit Lighting
When on, this feature will keep the driver
door from locking until the door is closed.
If this feature is turned on, the Delayed
Door Lock menu will not be available.
89
. Passive Door Lock
. Remote Left in Vehicle Alert
Remote Unlock Light Feedback
Touch Off or On.
When on, the exterior lamps will flash when
unlocking the vehicle with the RKE
transmitter
Auto Door Unlock
Touch Off or Flash Lights.
Remote Lock Feedback
Touch Off or On.
This allows selection of which of the doors
will automatically unlock when the vehicle is
shifted into P (Park) with an automatic
transmission or when the vehicle is turned
off with a manual transmission.
Exit Lighting
Touch Off, All Doors, or Driver Door.
This allows the selection of how long the
exterior lamps stay on when leaving the
vehicle when it is dark outside.
Delayed Door Lock
Vehicle Locator Lights
This feature will flash the exterior lamps and
allows some exterior lamps and most
interior lamps to turn on briefly when K on
the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
is pressed to locate the vehicle.
Touch Off, 30 Seconds, 60 Seconds,
or 120 Seconds.
Power Door Locks
Touch and the following may display:
. Open Door Anti Lock Out
. Auto Door Unlock
. Delayed Door Lock
When on, this feature will delay the locking
of the doors. To override the delay, press
the power door lock switch on the door.
Touch Off or On.
Remote Lock, Unlock, and Start
Touch and the following may display:
. Remote Unlock Light Feedback
. Remote Lock Feedback
. Remote Door Unlock
. Passive Door Unlock
This allows selection of what type of
feedback is given when locking the vehicle
with the RKE transmitter.
Touch Off, Lights and Horn, Lights Only,
or Horn Only.
Remote Door Unlock
This allows selection of which doors will
unlock when pressing K on the RKE
transmitter.
Touch All Doors or Driver Door.
Passive Door Unlock
This allows the selection of what doors will
unlock when using the button on the driver
door to unlock the vehicle.
Touch All Doors or Driver Door.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
90
Instruments and Controls
Passive Door Lock
Valet Mode
This feature specifies if the vehicle will
automatically lock, or lock and alert you
after all the doors are closed, and you walk
away from the vehicle with RKE transmitter.
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Key Access) 0 9 or
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) 0 11.
This will lock the infotainment system and
steering wheel controls. It may also limit
access to vehicle storage locations,
if equipped.
Touch Off, On with Horn Chirp, or On.
Remote Left in Vehicle Alert
This feature sounds an alert when the RKE
transmitter is left in the vehicle. This menu
also enables Remote No Longer in Vehicle
Alert.
Touch Off or On.
To enable valet mode:
1. Enter a four-digit code on the keypad.
2. Touch Enter to go to the confirmation
screen.
3. Re-enter the four-digit code.
Touch Lock or Unlock to lock or unlock the
system. Touch Back to go back to the
previous menu.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Lighting
91
Lighting
Exterior Lighting
; : Turns on the parking lamps including
all lamps except the headlamps.
Exterior Lighting
Exterior Lamp Controls
5 : Turns the headlamps on together with
the parking lamps and instrument panel
lights. A warning chime sounds if the driver
door is opened when the ignition switch is
off and the headlamps are on.
Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Exterior Lamps Off Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer . . . . . 91
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . 92
Automatic Headlamp System . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . 93
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Interior Lighting
Instrument Panel Illumination
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Courtesy Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Lighting Features
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . .
95
95
95
95
# : If equipped, press to turn the fog lamps
on or off.
See Fog Lamps 0 94.
The exterior lamp control is on the
instrument panel to the outboard side of
the steering column.
There are four positions:
O : Turns the exterior lamps off and
deactivates the AUTO mode. Turn to
again to reactivate the AUTO mode.
O
When the lights are on, ; will be lit. See
Lamps On Reminder 0 82.
Exterior Lamps Off Reminder
A reminder chime will sound when the
headlamps or parking lamps are manually
turned on when the ignition is off and a
door is open. To disable the chime, turn the
light off.
In Canada, the headlamps will automatically
reactivate when the vehicle is shifted out of
P (Park).
Headlamp High/Low-Beam
Changer
AUTO : If equipped, turns the exterior lamps
on and off automatically depending on
outside lighting.
The headlamps must be on for this feature
to work.
Push the turn signal lever away from you to
turn the high beams on.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
92
Lighting
The 3 light comes on in the instrument
cluster while the high beams are on and the
ignition is on.
To return to low beams, push the lever
again or pull the lever toward you and
release.
Flash-to-Pass
This feature is used to signal to the vehicle
ahead that you want to pass.
Pull the turn signal lever toward you until
the high-beam headlamps come on, then
release the lever to turn them off.
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)
DRL can make it easier for others to see the
front of your vehicle during the day. Fully
functional DRL are required on all vehicles
first sold in Canada.
The DRL system makes the headlamps come
on when the following conditions are met:
. The ignition is on.
. The exterior lamp control is in the AUTO.
. The vehicle is not parked.
. The light sensor determines it is daytime.
When the DRL system is on, the taillamps,
sidemarker lamps, parking lamps, and
instrument panel lights do not come on
unless the exterior lamp control is turned to
the parking lamp or headlamp position.
The DRL system turns off when one of the
following conditions is met:
. The ignition is off.
. The vehicle is parked.
. The high-beam headlamps are on.
. The low-beam headlamps are on.
. The light sensor determines it is
nighttime.
For vehicles first sold in Canada, the DRL can
only be turned off when the vehicle is
parked.
The regular headlamp system should be
used when needed.
Automatic Headlamp System
When it is dark enough outside and the
exterior lamp control is in the automatic
position, the headlamps come on
automatically. See Exterior Lamp Controls
0 91.
The vehicle has a light sensor on top of the
instrument panel. Make sure it is not
covered, or the headlamps will be on when
they are not needed.
The system may also turn on the headlamps
when driving through a parking garage or
tunnel.
If the vehicle is started in a dark garage, the
automatic headlamp system comes on
immediately. If it is light outside when the
vehicle leaves the garage, there is a slight
delay before the automatic headlamp
system changes to the Daytime Running
Lamp (DRL). During that delay, the
instrument cluster may not be as bright as
usual. Make sure the instrument panel
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Lighting
brightness control is in the full bright
position. See Instrument Panel Illumination
Control 0 94.
Hazard Warning Flashers
93
Turn and Lane-Change Signals
When it is bright enough outside, the
headlamps will turn off or may change
to DRL.
The automatic headlamp system turns off
when the exterior lamp control or the
ignition is off.
Lights On with Wipers
If the windshield wipers are activated in
daylight with the vehicle on, and the
exterior lamp control is in AUTO, the
headlamps, parking lamps, and other
exterior lamps come on. The transition time
for the lamps coming on varies based on
wiper speed. When the wipers are not
operating, these lamps turn off. Move the
exterior lamp control to P or ; to
disable this feature.
Move the lever all the way up or down to
signal a turn.
The hazard warning flasher button is on the
center stack.
| : Press to make the front and rear turn
signal lamps flash on and off. This warns
others that you are having trouble. Press
the button again to turn the flashers off.
When the hazard warning flashers are on,
the turn signals will not work.
An arrow on the instrument cluster flashes
in the direction of the turn or lane change.
Raise or lower the lever until the arrow
starts to flash to signal a lane change. Hold
it there until the lane change is completed.
If the lever is moved momentarily to the
lane change position, the arrow will flash
three times.
The lever returns to its starting position
whenever it is released.
If after signaling a turn or a lane change the
arrow flashes rapidly or does not come on, a
signal bulb may be burned out.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
94
Lighting
Replace any burned out bulbs. If a bulb is
not burned out, check the fuse. See Fuses
and Circuit Breakers 0 184.
Some localities have laws that require the
headlamps to be on along with the fog
lamps.
Fog Lamps
Interior Lighting
Instrument Panel Illumination
Control
Courtesy Lamps
The courtesy lamps come on when any door
is opened and the dome lamp is in the H
position.
Dome Lamps
If equipped with front fog lamps, the button
is on the outboard side of the instrument
panel.
# : Press to turn the front fog lamps on or
off. An indicator light on the instrument
cluster comes on when the fog lamps
are on.
This feature adjusts the brightness of all
illuminated controls. The instrument panel
illumination control is next to the exterior
lamp control.
The dome lamp controls are in the headliner
above the front seats.
The fog lamps come on together with the
parking lamps.
D : Move the thumbwheel up or down to
( : Press to turn the lamps off, even when
If the high-beam headlamps are turned on,
the fog lamps will turn off. If the high-beam
headlamps are turned off, the fog lamps will
turn back on again.
brighten or dim the lights.
a door is open.
The thumbwheel is functional at night,
or when the headlamps or parking lamps
are ON.
H : When the button is returned to the
middle position, the lamps turn on
automatically when a door is opened.
' : Press to turn on the dome lamps.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Lighting
Reading Lamps
Some exterior lamps also turn on when
pressing K on the RKE transmitter or
opening any doors. Low-Beam lamps will
only turn on briefly at night, or in areas
with limited lighting.
All lamps will gradually fade out after
about 30 seconds.
Entry lighting can be disabled manually by
closing all doors, pressing Q on the RKE
transmitter, or starting the vehicle.
The reading lamps are in the overhead
console.
Press the lamp lenses to turn the reading
lamps on or off.
Lighting Features
Entry Lighting
The interior lamps turn on when pressing K
on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
transmitter or opening any doors, and the
dome lamp control is in the DOOR position.
This feature can be changed. See “Vehicle
Locator Lights” under Vehicle Personalization
0 88.
Exit Lighting
Some exterior lamps and interior lamps turn
on when the key is removed from the
ignition.
The exterior and interior lamps remain on
for a set amount of time, then automatically
turn off. If equipped with Keyless Access,
the exterior lamps automatically turn on
when the driver door is opened after the
ignition is turned off.
The interior lights turn on when the ignition
is turned off.
95
The exterior lamps turn off immediately by
turning the exterior lamp control off.
This feature can be changed. See Vehicle
Personalization 0 88.
Battery Power Protection
This feature helps prevent the battery from
being drained, if the interior courtesy lamps
or reading lamps are accidentally left on.
If any of these lamps are left on, they
automatically turn off after 10 minutes,
if the ignition is off. The lamps will not
come back on again until one of the
following occurs:
. The ignition is turned on.
. The doors are closed and then re-opened.
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver
The exterior lamps turn off about 10 minutes
after the ignition is turned off, if the parking
lamps or headlamps have been manually
left on. This protects against draining the
battery. To restart the 10-minute timer, turn
the exterior lamp control to the O position
and then back to the ; or 2 position.
To keep the lamps on for more than
10 minutes, the ignition must be on or in
ACC/ACCESSORY.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
96
Infotainment System
Infotainment System
Introduction
Introduction
Read the following pages to become familiar
with the features.
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Using the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Radio
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Multi-Band Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Audio Players
Avoiding Untrusted Media Devices . . . . 102
USB Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Auxiliary Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Bluetooth Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Phone
Bluetooth (Overview) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a
Phone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Apple CarPlay and Android Auto . . . . . . . 110
Settings
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Trademarks and License Agreements
Trademarks and License Agreements . . . 115
{ Warning
Taking your eyes off the road for too
long or too often while using any
infotainment feature can cause a crash.
You or others could be injured or killed.
Do not give extended attention to
infotainment tasks while driving. Limit
your glances at the vehicle displays and
focus your attention on driving. Use voice
commands whenever possible.
The infotainment system has built-in
features intended to help avoid distraction
by disabling some functions when driving.
These functions may gray out when they
are unavailable. Many infotainment features
are also available through the instrument
cluster and steering wheel controls.
Before driving:
. Become familiar with the operation,
center stack controls, and infotainment
display controls.
. Set up the audio by presetting favorite
stations, setting the tone, and adjusting
the speakers.
. Set up phone numbers in advance so they
can be called easily by pressing a single
control or by using a single voice
command if equipped with Bluetooth
phone capability.
See Defensive Driving 0 123.
To play the infotainment system with the
ignition off, see Retained Accessory Power
(RAP) 0 138.
Overview
Customer Assistance
Assistance is available to help with
Bluetooth pairing, other mobile device
interface, and operation support of the
infotainment system. See Customer
Assistance Offices 0 242.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
Infotainment System
1.
The infotainment system is controlled by using the infotainment display, the controls on the
center stack, and the steering wheel controls.
97
{
. Press to go to the Home Page. See
“Home Page” following.
2.
g
. Radio: Press and release to go to the
previous station or channel. Press and
hold to fast seek the previous
strongest station.
. USB/Music/Pictures: Press to go to
the previous content. Press and hold
to fast rewind.
3.
O
O to turn the
system on. Press and hold to turn off.
. When on, press O to mute the
system and display a status pane.
Press O again to unmute the system.
. Turn to decrease or increase the
volume.
. When off, press
4.
d
. Radio: Press and release to go to the
next strongest station or channel.
Press and hold to fast seek the next
strongest station.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
98
Infotainment System
. USB/Music/Pictures: Press to go to
the next content. Press and hold to
fast forward.
5.
5
. Press and release to access the phone
screen, answer an incoming call,
or access the device home screen.
Home Page
The Home Page is where application icons
are accessed. Some features are disabled
when the vehicle is moving.
Slide a finger left/right across the screen to
access the pages of icons.
Managing Home Page Icons
1. Touch and hold any of the Home Page
icons to edit that icon.
2. Drag the icon to a new location on the
Home Page.
Using the System
Infotainment Display Icons
Infotainment display icons show when
available. When a function is unavailable,
the icon may gray out. When a function is
selected, the icon may highlight.
Audio
OnStar Services
Touch the Audio icon to display the active
audio source page. Examples of available
sources are AM, FM, SXM, MyMedia, USB,
AUX, and Bluetooth.
If equipped, touch the OnStar icon to display
the OnStar Services and Account pages. See
OnStar Overview 0 252.
Phone
Touch the Phone icon to display the Phone
main page. See Bluetooth (Overview) 0 106
or
Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) 0 107.
Camera
If equipped, touch the Camera icon to access
the camera application. See Rear Vision
Camera (RVC) 0 150.
Shortcut Tray
Settings
The shortcut tray is at the bottom of the
display. It shows up to four applications.
Touch the Settings icon to display the
Settings menu. See Settings 0 111.
Infotainment Gestures
Apple CarPlay
Use the following finger gestures to control
the infotainment system.
Touch the Apple CarPlay icon to activate
Apple CarPlay (if equipped) after a
supported device is connected. See Apple
CarPlay and Android Auto 0 110.
Android Auto
Touch the Android Auto icon to activate
Android Auto (if equipped) after a supported
device is connected. See Apple CarPlay and
Android Auto 0 110.
Touch/Tap
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
Touch/Tap is used to select an icon or
option, or activate an application.
Touch and Hold
Drag is used to move applications on the
Home Page. To drag the item, it must be
held and moved along the screen to the
new location. This can be done up, down,
right, or left.
99
Fling or Swipe
Nudge
Fling or swipe is used to scroll through a
list, or change page views. Do this by
placing a finger on the screen then moving
it rapidly up and down or right and left.
Touch and hold can be used to start another
gesture, or to move or delete an application.
Drag
Nudge is used to move items a short
distance on a list. To nudge, hold and move
the selected item up or down to a new
location.
Cleaning High Gloss Surfaces and Vehicle
Information and Radio Displays
For vehicles with high gloss surfaces or
vehicle displays, use a microfiber cloth to
wipe surfaces. Before wiping the surface
with the microfiber cloth, use a soft bristle
brush to remove dirt that could scratch the
surface. Then use the microfiber cloth by
gently rubbing to clean. Never use window
cleaners or solvents. Periodically hand wash
the microfiber cloth separately, using mild
soap. Do not use bleach or fabric softener.
Rinse thoroughly and air dry before
next use.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
100
Infotainment System
Radio
AM-FM Radio
Finding a Station
Direct Tune
Seeking a Station
Playing the Radio
From the Home Page, touch the Audio icon
to display the active audio source page.
Choose from a list of the three most
recently used sources listed at the left side
of the screen. Choose More to display a list
of available resources. Examples of available
sources are AM, FM, SXM, MyMedia, USB,
AUX, and Bluetooth.
Infotainment System Sound Menu
From any of the audio source main pages,
touch Sound to display the following:
Equalizer : Touch to adjust Bass, Midrange,
and Treble using the controls on the
infotainment display.
Fade/Balance : Touch to adjust using the
controls on the infotainment display or by
tapping/dragging the crosshair.
From the AM, FM, or SXM screen, touch
© or ¨ to search for the previous or next
strong station.
Browsing Stations
From the AM, FM, or SXM screen, touch
Browse to list all available stations. Navigate
up and down through all stations by
scrolling the list. Touch the station you want
to listen to. Touch H to save the station
or channel as a favorite.
If equipped, touch Update Station List to
update the active stations in your area.
Access Direct Tune by touching the Tune
icon on the AM, FM, or SXM screen to bring
up the keypad. Navigate up and down
through all frequencies using 7 or 6.
Directly enter a station or channel using the
keypad. When a new station or channel is
entered, the information about that station
or channel displays on the right side. This
information will update with each new valid
frequency tuned to.
The keypad will gray out entries that do not
contribute to a valid frequency and will
automatically place a decimal point within
the frequency number.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
Touch (X) to delete one character at a time.
Touch and hold (X) to delete all numbers.
A valid AM or FM station will automatically
tune to the new frequency but will not
close the direct tune display. When listening
to SXM, touch Go after entering the
channel. Touch S or z to exit out of
Direct Tune.
The tune arrows on the right side of the
Direct Tune display tune through the
complete station list one station step at a
time per touch. A touch and hold advances
through stations quickly.
FM and SXM Categories
display a list of stations or channels for that
category. Selecting a station from the list
tunes the radio to that channel.
Storing Radio Station Favorites
Favorites are displayed in the area at the
top of the display.
AM, FM, and SXM Radio Stations : Touch
and hold a preset to store the current
station or channel as a favorite. Touch a
saved favorite to recall a favorite station or
channel.
Favorites can also be stored by touching H
in a station or channel list. This will
highlight indicating that it is now stored as
a favorite.
The number of favorites displayed is
automatically adjusted by default, but can
be manually adjusted in Settings in the
System tab under Favorites and then Set
Number of Audio Favorites. It can also be
adjusted in Settings in the Apps tab under
Audio and then Set Number of Audio
Favorites.
From the FM or SXM display, touch
Categories at the top of the Browse menu
to access the categories list. The list contains
names associated with the FM stations or
SXM channels. Touch a category name to
101
Satellite Radio
If equipped, vehicles with a valid SiriusXM
satellite radio subscription can receive SXM
programming.
SiriusXM satellite radio has a wide variety of
programming and commercial-free music,
coast to coast, and in digital-quality sound.
In the U.S., see www.siriusxm.com or call
1-888-601-6296. In Canada, see
www.siriusxm.ca or call 1-877-438-9677.
When SXM is active, the channel name,
number, song title, and artist display on the
screen.
Radio Reception
Unplug electronic devices from the accessory
power outlets if there is interference or
static in the radio.
FM
FM signals only reach about 16 to 65 km
(10 to 40 mi). Although the radio has a
built-in electronic circuit that automatically
works to reduce interference, some static
can occur, especially around tall buildings or
hills, causing the sound to fade in and out.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
102
Infotainment System
AM
Multi-Band Antenna
The range for most AM stations is greater
than for FM, especially at night. The longer
range can cause station frequencies to
interfere with each other. Static can also
occur when things like storms and power
lines interfere with radio reception. When
this happens, try reducing the treble on the
radio.
The roof antenna is for SXM, AM, FM,
OnStar and GPS (Global Positioning System).
Keep clear of obstructions for clear
reception. If the vehicle has a sunroof, and it
is open, reception can also be affected.
SiriusXM Satellite Radio Service
Avoiding Untrusted Media Devices
If equipped, SiriusXM Satellite Radio Service
provides digital radio reception. Tall
buildings or hills can interfere with satellite
radio signals, causing the sound to fade in
and out. In addition, traveling or standing
under heavy foliage, bridges, garages,
or tunnels may cause loss of the SiriusXM
signal for a period of time.
When using media devices such as CDs,
DVDs, Blu-ray Discs, SD cards, USB devices,
and mobile devices, consider the source.
Untrusted media devices could contain files
that affect system operation or performance.
Avoid use if the content or origin cannot be
trusted.
Cell Phone Usage
Cell phone usage, such as making or
receiving phone calls, charging, or just
having the phone on may cause static
interference in the radio. Unplug the phone
or turn it off if this happens.
Audio Players
USB Port
Audio stored on a USB device may be
listened to.
This vehicle has two USB ports in the center
stack. These ports are for data and charging.
Caution
To avoid vehicle damage, unplug all
accessories and disconnect all accessory
cables from the vehicle when not in use.
Accessory cables left plugged into the
vehicle, unconnected to a device, could be
damaged or cause an electrical short if
the unconnected end comes in contact
with liquids or another power source such
as the accessory power outlet.
Playing from a USB
A USB mass storage device can be connected
to the USB port.
Audio extensions supported by the USB:
. MP3
. MP4
. M4A
. M4B
. AAC
. 3GP
. WAV
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
My Media Library
6:
My Media is only available when more than
one indexed device is connected. It allows
access to content from all indexed media
sources. My Media will show as an available
source in the Source page.
. Touch to seek to the next track.
. Touch and hold to advance quickly
USB MP3 Player and USB Drives
The USB MP3 players and USB drives
connected must comply with the USB Mass
Storage Class specification (USB MSC).
To
1.
2.
3.
play a USB device:
Connect the USB.
Touch Audio from the Home Page.
Touch More and select the USB device.
Use the following when playing an active
USB source:
p : Touch to play the current media source.
j : Touch to pause playback of the current
media source.
7:
. Touch to seek to the beginning of the
current or previous track.
. Touch and hold to reverse quickly
through playback. Release to return to
playing speed. Elapsed time displays.
through playback. Release to return to
playing speed. Elapsed time displays.
103
3. Select a song from the list to begin
playback.
Supported Playlist extensions are: m3u
and pls.
USB Browse Menu
Artists:
1. Touch to view the list of artists stored
on the USB.
2. Select an artist name to view a list of all
albums by the artist.
3. To select a song, touch All Songs or
touch an album and then select a song
from the list.
When a list of songs, albums, artists,
or other types of media displays, the up and
down arrows and A-Z appear on the left
side. Select A-Z to view a screen that will
show all letters of the alphabet and select
the letter to go to.
Songs:
1. Touch to display a list of all songs on
the USB.
2. To begin playback, select a song from
the list.
Touch the up and down arrows to move the
list up and down.
Albums:
1. Touch to view the albums on the USB.
2. Select the album to view a list of all
songs on the album.
3. Select a song from the list to begin
playback.
Shuffle : Touch the shuffle icon to play
music in random order.
USB Sound Menu
See “Infotainment System Sound Menu”
under AM-FM Radio 0 100.
Touch Browse and the following may
display:
Playlists:
1. Touch to view the playlists stored on
the USB.
2. Select a playlist to view the list of all
songs in that playlist.
Genres:
1. Touch to view the genres on the USB.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
104
Infotainment System
2. Select a genre to view a list of artists.
3. Select an artist to view albums by that
artist.
4. Select an album to view songs on the
album.
5. Select a song to start playback.
iTunes Radio: Touch to view iTunes Radio on
the iPhone to get a list of stations.
Compilations: Touch to view the
Compilations on the USB.
Podcasts: Touch to view the podcasts on the
USB and get a list of podcast episodes.
Select from one of the following Browse
options to save a favorite:
Audiobooks:
1. Touch to view the audiobooks stored on
the device.
2. Select an audiobook to get a list of
chapters.
3. Select the chapter from the list to begin
playback.
Playlists : Touch H next to any playlist to
store the playlist as a favorite. Touch a
saved favorite to recall a favorite playlist.
The first song in the playlist begins to play.
File System and Naming
Composers:
1. Touch to view the composers on
the USB.
2. Select a Composer to view a list of
albums by that composer.
3. Select an album or all songs to view a
list of songs.
4. Select a song from the list to begin
playback.
File systems supported by the USB:
. FAT32
. HFS+
Folders:
1. Touch to view the directories on
the USB.
2. Select a folder to view a list of all files.
3. Select a file from the list to begin
playback.
To view supported devices, see
my.chevrolet.com/learn.
The songs, artists, albums, and genres are
taken from the file’s song information and
are only displayed if present. The radio
displays the file name as the track name if
the song information is not available.
Supported Apple Devices
Storing and Recalling Media Favorites
To store media favorites, touch Browse to
display a list of media types.
Artists : Touch H next to any artist to
store the artist as a favorite. Touch a saved
favorite to recall a favorite artist. The first
song in the artist list begins to play.
Songs : Touch H next to any song to store
the song as a favorite. Touch a saved
favorite to recall a favorite song.
Albums : Touch H next to any album to
store the album as a favorite. Touch a saved
favorite to recall a favorite album. The first
song in the album list begins to play.
Genres : Touch H next to any genre to
store the genre as a favorite. Touch a saved
favorite to recall a favorite genre. The first
song of the genre begins to play.
Podcasts : Touch H next to any podcast to
store the podcast as a favorite. Touch a
saved favorite to recall a favorite podcast.
The podcast begins to play.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
Audiobooks : Touch H next to any
audiobook to store the audiobook as a
favorite. Touch a saved favorite to recall a
favorite audiobook. The first chapter in the
audiobook begins to play.
Media Playback and Mute
USB playback will be paused if the system is
muted. If the steering wheel mute control is
pressed again, playback will resume.
If the source is changed while in mute,
playback resumes and audio will unmute.
Auxiliary Jack
This vehicle has an auxiliary input jack in
the center stack. Possible auxiliary audio
sources include:
. Laptop computer
. Audio music player
This jack is not an audio output. Do not
plug headphones into the auxiliary input
jack. Set up an auxiliary device while the
vehicle is parked.
Connect a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) cable from the
auxiliary device to the auxiliary input jack.
When a device is connected, the system can
play audio from the device over the vehicle
speakers.
105
If an auxiliary device has already been
connected, but a different source is currently
active, touch More and select AUX to make
the source active.
2. Once paired, touch Audio from the Home
Page, then touch Bluetooth from the
recent sources list on the left of the
display.
Shuffle and Browse are not available in the
AUX source menu.
Bluetooth Sound Menu
Bluetooth Audio
Music may be played from a paired
Bluetooth device. See Bluetooth (Overview)
0 106 or
Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) 0 107.
Volume and song selection may be
controlled by using the infotainment
controls or the phone/device. If Bluetooth is
selected and no volume is present, check the
volume setting on both your phone/device
and the infotainment system.
Music can be launched by touching
Bluetooth from the recent sources list on
the left of the screen or by touching More
and then selecting the Bluetooth device.
To play music via Bluetooth:
1. Power on the device, and pair to connect
the device.
See “Infotainment System Sound Menu”
under AM-FM Radio 0 100.
Manage Bluetooth Devices
From the Home Page:
1. Touch Audio.
2. Touch More.
3. Touch Bluetooth.
4. Touch Devices to add or delete devices.
When selecting Bluetooth, the radio may
not be able to launch the audio player on
the connected device to start playing. When
the vehicle is not moving, use the phone to
begin playback.
All devices launch audio differently. When
selecting Bluetooth as a source, the radio
may show as paused on the screen. Press
play on the device or touch p on the
display to begin playback.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
106
Infotainment System
Browse functionality will be provided where
supported by the Bluetooth device. This
media content will not be part of the
MyMedia source mode.
Some phones support sending Bluetooth
music information to display on the radio.
When the radio receives this information, it
will check to see if any is available and
display it. For more information about
supported Bluetooth features, see
my.chevrolet.com/learn.
Phone
Bluetooth (Overview)
The Bluetooth-capable system can interact
with many cell phones, allowing:
. Placement and receipt of calls in a
hands-free mode.
. Sharing of the cell phone’s address book
or contact list with the vehicle.
To minimize driver distraction, before
driving, and with the vehicle parked:
. Become familiar with the features of the
cell phone. Organize the phone book and
contact lists clearly and delete duplicate
or rarely used entries. If possible,
program speed dial or other shortcuts.
. Review the controls and operation of the
infotainment system.
. Pair cell phone(s) to the vehicle. The
system may not work with all cell
phones. See “Pairing” later in this section.
Vehicles with a Bluetooth system can use a
Bluetooth-capable cell phone with a
Hands-Free Profile to make and receive
phone calls. The infotainment system and
voice recognition are used to control the
system. The system can be used when the
ignition is on or in ACC/ACCESSORY. The
range of the Bluetooth system can be up to
9.1 m (30 ft). Not all phones support all
functions and not all phones work with the
Bluetooth system. See my.chevrolet.com for
more information about compatible phones.
Controls
Use the controls on the center stack and the
steering wheel to operate the Bluetooth
system.
Steering Wheel Controls
b / g : Press to answer incoming calls.
Hold to start voice recognition on your
connected Bluetooth phone, for example Siri
and Google.
$ / i : Press to end a call, decline a call,
or cancel an operation. Press to mute or
unmute the infotainment system when not
on a call.
Infotainment System Controls
For information about how to navigate the
menu system using the infotainment
controls, see Introduction 0 96.
Phone
Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page to
enter the phone main menu.
Audio System
When using the Bluetooth phone system,
sound comes through the vehicle's front
audio system speakers and overrides the
audio system. The volume level while on a
phone call can be adjusted by pressing the
steering wheel controls or by touching the
volume control on the center stack. The
adjusted volume level remains in memory
for later calls. The volume cannot be
lowered beyond a certain level.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a
Phone)
Pairing
A Bluetooth-enabled cell phone must be
paired to the Bluetooth system and then
connected to the vehicle before it can be
used. See the cell phone manufacturer's user
guide for Bluetooth functions before pairing
the cell phone.
Pairing Information
. If no mobile device has been connected,
the Phone main page on the infotainment
display will show the Connect Phone
option. Touch this option to connect.
Another way to connect is to touch the
Phones tab at the top right of the display
and then touch Add Phone.
. A Bluetooth phone with music capability
can be paired to the vehicle as a phone
and a music player at the same time.
. Up to 10 devices can be paired to the
Bluetooth system.
. The pairing process is disabled when the
vehicle is moving.
. Pairing only needs to be completed once,
unless the pairing information on the cell
phone changes or the cell phone is
deleted from the system.
. If multiple paired cell phones are within
range of the system, the system connects
to the paired cell phone that is set to
First to Connect. If there is no phone set
to First to Connect, it will link to the
device which was used last. To link to a
different paired phone, see “Linking to a
Different Phone” later in this section.
Pairing a Phone
1. Make sure Bluetooth has been enabled
on the cell phone before pairing is
started.
2. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page
or the phone shortcut on the
applications tray at the bottom of the
display.
3. Touch Phone at the top of the
infotainment display. There is also an
Add option in the middle of the Phone
screen. Touching this Add Phone option
will shortcut to the Phone List menu.
4. Touch Add Phone.
107
5. Select the vehicle name shown on the
infotainment display from your phone’s
Bluetooth Settings list.
6. Follow the instructions on the cell phone
to confirm the six-digit code shown on
the infotainment display and touch Pair.
The code on the cell phone and
infotainment display will need to be
acknowledged for a successful pair.
7. Start the pairing process on the cell
phone to be paired to the vehicle. See
the cell phone manufacturer's user guide
for information on this process. Once the
cell phone is paired, it will show under
Connected.
8. If the vehicle does not appear on your
phone, there are a few ways to start the
pairing process over.
. Turn the phone off and then back on.
. Go back to the beginning of the
Phone menus on the infotainment
display and restart the pairing
process.
. Reset the phone, but this step should
be done as a last-effort.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
108
Infotainment System
9. If the phone prompts to accept
connection or allow phone book
download, select Always Accept and
Allow. The phone book may not be
available if not accepted.
10. Repeat Steps 1−8 to pair additional
phones.
First to Connect Paired Phones
If multiple paired cell phones are within the
range of the system, the system connects to
the paired cell phone that is set as First to
Connect. To enable a paired phone as the
First to Connect phone:
1. Make sure the cell phone is turned on.
2. Touch Settings, then touch System.
3. Touch Phones to access all paired and all
connected cell phones and mobile
devices.
4. Touch the information icon to the right
of the cell phone to open the cell
phone’s settings menu.
5. Touch the First to Connect option, to
enable the setting for that device.
Cell phones and mobile devices can be
added, removed, connected, and
disconnected. A sub-menu will display
whenever a request is made to add or
manage cell phones and mobile devices.
Secondary Phone
A phone can be enabled as a Secondary
Phone by touching the information icon to
the right of the paired phone name to open
the phone’s settings menu. If a phone is
enabled as a Secondary Phone, it can
connect simultaneously alongside another
Bluetooth device. In doing so, the Secondary
Phone will be labeled as Incoming Calls. This
means the device can only receive calls. The
Address Book of a Secondary Phone will not
be available and hands-free outgoing calls
cannot be placed using this phone.
If needed, touch the Secondary Phone while
in the Devices list, to swap it into the
Outgoing and Incoming role, making it
possible to place outgoing calls from the
Contacts and Recents list. This action of
swapping roles will disconnect what was
labeled as only receiving calls until another
Secondary Phone is enabled.
Listing All Paired and Connected Phones
1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page
or the phone shortcut on the
applications tray at the bottom of the
display.
2. Select Phones.
Disconnecting a Connected Phone
1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page.
2. Select Phones.
3. Touch the information icon next to the
connected cell phone or mobile device to
show the cell phone’s or mobile device’s
information display.
4. Touch Disconnect.
Deleting a Paired Phone
1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page
or the phone shortcut on the
applications tray at the bottom of the
display.
2. Select Phones.
3. Touch the information icon next to the
connected cell phone to display the cell
phone’s or mobile device’s information
display.
4. Touch Forget Device.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
Linking to a Different Phone
To link to a different phone, the new phone
must be in the vehicle and paired to the
Bluetooth system.
1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page
or the phone shortcut on the
applications tray at the bottom of the
display.
2. Select Phones.
3. Select the new phone to link to from the
not connected phone list.
Switching to Handset or
Handsfree Mode
To switch between handset or
handsfree mode:
. While the active call is hands-free, touch
the Handset option to switch to the
handset mode.
The mute icon will not be available nor
functional while Handset mode is active.
. While the active call is on the handset,
touch the Handset option to switch to the
hands-free mode.
Making a Call Using Contacts and Recent
Calls
Calls can be made through the Bluetooth
system using personal cell phone contact
information for all phones that support the
Phone Book feature. Become familiar with
the phone settings and operation. Verify the
cell phone supports this feature.
The Contacts menu accesses the phone book
stored in the cell phone.
The Recents menu accesses the recent call
list(s) from your cell phone.
To
1.
2.
3.
make a call using the Contacts menu:
Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page.
Touch Contacts.
The Contacts list can be searched by
using the first character. Touch A-Z on
the infotainment display to scroll
through the list of names.
Select the name to call.
4. Select the desired contact number to call.
To
1.
2.
3.
make a call using the Recent Calls menu:
Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page.
Touch Recents.
Select the name or number to call.
109
Making a Call Using the Keypad
To make a call by dialing the numbers:
1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page.
2. Touch Keypad and enter a phone
number.
3. Touch # on the infotainment display to
start dialing the number.
Searching Contacts Using the Keypad
To search for contacts using the keypad:
1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page.
2. Touch Keypad and enter partial phone
numbers or contact names using the
digits on the keypad to search.
Results will show on the right side of the
display. Select one to place a call.
Accepting or Declining a Call
When an incoming call is received, the
infotainment system mutes and a ring tone
is heard in the vehicle.
Accepting a Call
There are three ways to accept a call:
. Press b / g on the steering wheel
controls.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
110
Infotainment System
. Touch Answer on the infotainment
display.
. Select Answer on the instrument cluster
using the select control.
Declining a Call
There are three ways to decline a call:
. Press $ / i on the steering wheel
controls.
. Touch Ignore on the infotainment display.
. Select Ignore on the instrument cluster
using the select control.
Call Waiting
Call waiting must be supported on the
Bluetooth phone and enabled by the
wireless service carrier to work.
Accepting a Call
There are three ways to accept a
call-waiting call:
. Press b / g on the steering wheel
controls.
. Touch Switch on the infotainment display.
. Select Switch on the instrument cluster
using the select control.
Declining a Call
There are three ways to decline a
call-waiting call:
. Press $ / i on the steering wheel
controls.
. Touch Ignore on the infotainment display.
. Select Ignore on the instrument cluster
using the select control.
Switching Between Calls (Call Waiting
Calls Only)
To switch between calls, press the Phone
icon on the Home Page to display Call View.
While in Call View, touch the call
information of the call on hold to change
calls.
Three-Way Calling
Three-way calling must be supported on the
Bluetooth phone and enabled by the
wireless service carrier to work.
To start a three-way call while in a
current call:
1. In the Call View, touch Add Call to add
another call.
2. Initiate the second call by selecting from
Recents, Contacts, or Keypad.
3. When the second call is active, touch the
merge icon to conference the three-way
call together.
Ending a Call
$ / i on the steering wheel
controls.
. Touch # on the infotainment display,
next to a call to end only that call.
. Select End on the instrument cluster using
the select control.
. Press
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency (DTMF) Tones
The in-vehicle Bluetooth system can send
numbers during a call. This is used when
calling a menu-driven phone system. Use the
Keypad to enter the number.
Apple CarPlay and Android Auto
If equipped, Android Auto and/or Apple
CarPlay capability may be available through
a compatible smartphone. If available, the
Android Auto and Apple CarPlay icons will
appear on the Home Page of the
infotainment display.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
To use Android Auto and/or Apple CarPlay:
1. Download the Android Auto app to your
smartphone from the Google Play store.
There is no app required for Apple
CarPlay.
2. Connect your Android smartphone or
Apple iPhone by using the compatible
phone USB cable and plugging into a
USB data port. For best performance, it is
highly recommended to use the device’s
factory-provided USB cable, which should
be replaced after significant wear to
maintain connection quality. Aftermarket
or third-party cables may not work.
3. When the phone is first connected to
activate Apple CarPlay or Android Auto,
the message “Device Projection Privacy
Consent” will appear.
. Touch Continue to launch Apple
CarPlay or Android Auto.
. Touch Disable to remove Apple
CarPlay and Android Auto capability
from the vehicle Settings menu.
Other functions may still work.
upon USB connection. If not, touch the
Android Auto or Apple CarPlay icon on the
Home Page to launch.
The Android Auto and Apple CarPlay icons
on the Home Page will illuminate depending
on the smartphone. Android Auto and/or
Apple CarPlay may automatically launch
Press { on the center stack to exit Android
Auto or Apple CarPlay. To enter back into
Android Auto or Apple CarPlay, press and
hold {on the center stack.
Press { on the center stack to return to the
Home Page.
For further information on how to set up
Android Auto and Apple CarPlay in the
vehicle, see my.chevrolet.com or see
Customer Assistance Offices 0 242.
Android Auto is provided by Google and is
subject to Google’s terms and privacy policy.
Apple CarPlay is provided by Apple and is
subject to Apple’s terms and privacy policy.
Data plan rates apply. For Android Auto
support and to see if your phone is
compatible, see https://support.google.com/
androidauto. For Apple CarPlay support and
to see if your phone is compatible, see
www.apple.com/ios/carplay/. Apple or
Google may change or suspend availability
at any time. Android Auto, Android, Google,
Google Play, and other marks are
trademarks of Google Inc.; Apple CarPlay is a
trademark of Apple Inc.
111
Apple CarPlay and Android Auto can be
disabled from the Infotainment system. To
do this, touch Home, Settings, and then
touch the Apps tab along the top of the
display. Use the On/Off toggled to turn off
Apple CarPlay or Android Auto.
Settings
The Settings menu may be organized into
three categories. Select the desired category
by touching System, Apps, or Vehicle.
To access the menus:
1. Touch the Settings icon on the Home
Page on the infotainment display.
2. Touch the desired category to display a
list of available options.
3. Touch to select the desired feature
setting.
9 or R to turn off or on a feature.
5. Touch z to go to the top level of the
4. Touch
Settings menu.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
112
Infotainment System
The menu may contain the following:
Phones
System
Touch to connect to a different cell phone or
mobile device source, disconnect a cell
phone or media device, or delete a cell
phone or media device.
The menu may contain the following:
Time / Date
Use the following features to set the clock:
. Automatic Time and Date: Touch On to
have the time and date automatically set.
When this feature is off, the time and
date can be manually set.
. Set Time: Touch to manually set the time
using the controls on the infotainment
display.
. Set Date: Touch to manually set the date
using the controls on the infotainment
display.
. Use 24-hour Format: Touch to specify the
clock format shown.
Touch Off or On.
Language
This will set the display language used on
the infotainment display. Touch Language
and select the appropriate language.
. Share Hotspot Data: Touch Enable to
allow devices to use the vehicle hotspot
and its data, or touch Disable to allow
devices to only use the vehicle hotspot.
Privacy
Wi-Fi Networks
Touch and the following may display:
This will show connected and available Wi-Fi
networks.
. Location Services: The Off setting disables
If a 4G LTE data package is not active on the
vehicle, the infotainment system can be
connected to an external protected Wi-Fi
network, such as a mobile device or home
hotspot, to utilize connected services.
Wi-Fi Hotspot
Touch and the following may display:
. Wi-Fi Services: This allows devices to use
the vehicle hotspot.
Touch the controls on the infotainment
display to disable or enable.
. Wi-Fi Name: Touch to change the vehicle
Wi-Fi name.
. Wi-Fi Password: Touch to change the
vehicle Wi-Fi password.
. Connected Devices: Touch to show
connected devices.
sharing of the vehicle location. Emergency
services will not be affected when Off is
selected.
Display
Touch and the following may display:
. Calibrate Touchscreen: Touch to calibrate
the infotainment display and follow the
prompts.
. Turn Display Off: Touch to turn the
display off. Touch anywhere on the
infotainment display or press any
infotainment control on the center stack
again to turn the display on.
Sounds
Touch and the following may display:
. Maximum Startup Volume: This feature
adjusts the maximum volume of the
infotainment system when you start the
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
vehicle. Use the controls on the
infotainment display to set the desired
startup volume.
. Audible Touch Feedback: This setting
determines if a sound plays when you
touch the infotainment display or press
any infotainment control on the center
stack. This feature can be turned off
or on.
Favorites
Touch and the following may display:
. Manage Favorites: Touch to display a list
of Audio or Mobile Devices favorites.
Favorites can be moved, renamed,
or deleted.
To move, touch and hold the favorite, and
then drag up or down to rearrange the
position.
. Set Number of Audio Favorites: Touch to
select how many favorites pages can be
viewed from the audio application. Select
Auto for the system to automatically
adjust this number based on the number
of favorites saved. Touch Auto, 5, 10, 15,
20, 25, 30, 35, or 40.
Updates
If equipped, the infotainment system can
download and install select software updates
over a wireless connection. The system will
prompt for certain updates to be
downloaded and installed. There is also an
option to check for updates manually.
To manually check for updates, touch
Settings on the Home Page, followed by
Software Information, and then System
Update. Follow the on-screen prompts. The
steps to check for, download and install
updates may vary by vehicle.
113
appropriate Wi-Fi network, and follow the
on-screen prompts. Download speeds
may vary.
On most compatible mobile devices,
activation of the Wi-Fi hotspot is in the
Settings menu under Mobile Network
Sharing, Personal Hotspot, Mobile Hotspot
or similar.
Availability of Over-the-Air software updates
varies by vehicle and country. For more
information on this feature, see
my.chevrolet.com/learn.
Preferences
Downloading Over-the-Air vehicle software
updates requires internet connectivity, which
can be accessed through the vehicle’s
built-in 4G LTE connection, if equipped and
active. If required, data plans are provided
by a third party. Optionally, a secure Wi-Fi
hotspot such as a compatible mobile device
hotspot, home hotspot or public hotspot can
be used. Applicable data rates may apply.
Touch the controls on the infotainment
display to disable or enable the download of
new updates in the background.
To connect the infotainment system to a
secured mobile device hotspot, home
hotspot, or a public hotspot, touch Settings
on the Home Page, select the System tab,
followed by Wi-Fi Networks. Select the
Touch and the following may display:
. Reset Vehicle Settings: Resets all vehicle
settings for the current user.
Touch Cancel or Reset.
About
Touch to view the infotainment system
software information.
Return to Factory Settings
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
114
Infotainment System
. Erase Settings and Personal Data: Erases
app data settings, user profiles, and
personal data including mobile
device data.
Touch Cancel or Erase.
Apps
The menu may contain the following:
Android Auto
This feature allows you to interact directly
with your phone on the infotainment
display. See Apple CarPlay and Android Auto
0 110.
Touch Off or On.
Apple CarPlay
This feature allows you to interact directly
with your phone on the infotainment
display. See Apple CarPlay and Android Auto
0 110.
Touch Off or On.
Audio
Depending on the current audio source,
different options will be available.
Touch and the following may display:
. Tone Settings: Touch to adjust Equalizer,
Fade/Balance, or Sound Mode. See
“Infotainment System Sound Menu” in
AM-FM Radio 0 100.
. Auto Volume: This feature adjusts the
volume based on the vehicle speed.
Touch Off, Low, Medium-Low, Medium,
Medium-High, or High.
. Manage Favorites: Touch to display a list
of Audio or Mobile Devices favorites.
Favorites can be moved, renamed,
or deleted.
To move, touch and hold the favorite, and
then drag up or down to rearrange the
position.
. Set Number of Audio Favorites: Touch to
select how many favorites pages can be
viewed from the audio application. The
Auto setting will automatically adjust this
number based on the number of favorites
saved. Touch Auto, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30,
35, or 40.
. RDS: This allows RDS to be turned off
or on.
Touch Off or On.
. Explicit Content Filter: This allows Explicit
Content Filter to be turned off or on.
Touch Off or On.
. Manage Phones: Select to connect to a
different phone source, disconnect a
phone, or delete a phone.
. Reset Music Index: This allows the music
index to be reset if you are having
difficulty accessing all of the media
content on your device.
Touch YES or NO.
Phone
Touch and the following may display:
. My Number: Displays the cell phone
number of the Bluetooth connected
device.
. Active Call View: Shows active call display
when answering a call.
Touch Off or On.
. Privacy: Only shows call alerts in the
instrument cluster.
Touch Off or On.
. Sort Contacts: Touch to sort by first or
last name.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Infotainment System
. Re-sync Device Contacts:
This allows the device contacts to re-sync
if you are having difficulty accessing all of
the contacts on your cell phone.
. Delete All Vehicle Contacts: Touch to
delete all vehicle stored contacts.
. OnStar Phone TTY Mode: This enables
OnStar cell phone TTY mode.
Touch Disable or Enable.
Vehicle
This menu allows adjustment of different
vehicle features. See Vehicle Personalization
0 88.
Trademarks and License
Agreements
FCC Information
See Radio Frequency Statement 0 248.
Bluetooth
The Bluetooth word mark and logos are
owned by the Bluetooth® SIG, Inc. and any
use of such marks by General Motors is
under license. Other trademarks and trade
names are those of their respective owners.
"Made for iPod," and "Made for iPhone,"
mean that an electronic accessory has been
designed to connect specifically to iPod or
iPhone, respectively, and has been certified
by the developer to meet Apple
performance standards. Apple is not
responsible for the operation of this device
or its compliance with safety and regulatory
standards. Please note that the use of this
accessory with iPod or iPhone may affect
wireless performance. iPhone, iPod, iPod
classic, iPod nano, iPod shuffle, and iPod
touch are trademarks of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
115
Fees and Taxes: Subscription fee, taxes, one
time activation fee, and other fees may
apply. Subscription fee is consumer only. All
fees and programming subject to change.
Subscriptions subject to Customer
Agreement available at www.siriusxm.com
or www.siriusxm.ca. SiriusXM service only
available in the 48 contiguous United States
and Canada.
In Canada: Some deterioration of service
may occur in extreme northern latitudes.
This is beyond the control of SiriusXM
Satellite Radio.
Explicit Language Notice: Channels with
frequent explicit language are indicated with
an “XL” preceding the channel name.
Channel blocking is available for SiriusXM
Satellite Radio receivers by notifying
SiriusXM:
. USA Customers — See www.siriusxm.com
or call 1-888-601–6296.
. Canada Customers — See
www.siriusxm.ca or call 1-877-438-9677.
It is prohibited to copy, decompile,
disassemble, reverse engineer, hack,
manipulate, or otherwise make available any
technology or software incorporated in
receivers compatible with the SiriusXM
Satellite Radio System or that support the
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
116
Infotainment System
SiriusXM website, the Online Service or any
of its content. Furthermore, the AMBER voice
compression software included in this
product is protected by intellectual property
rights including patent rights, copyrights,
and trade secrets of Digital Voice
Systems, Inc.
General Requirements:
1. A License Agreement from SiriusXM is
required for any product that
incorporates SiriusXM Technology and/or
for use of any of the SiriusXM marks to
be manufactured, distributed,
or marketed in the SiriusXM
Service Area.
2. For products to be distributed, marketed,
and/or sold in Canada, a separate
agreement is required with Canadian
Satellite Radio Inc. (operating as SiriusXM
Canada).
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Climate Controls
Climate Controls
Climate Control Systems
Climate Control Systems
These climate control systems control the
heating, cooling, and ventilation for the
vehicle.
Climate Control Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
117
Air Vents
Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Maintenance
Air Intake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . 120
Air Conditioning Regular Operation . . . . 120
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Climate Control System with Heater Only
Climate Control System with Heater and Air
Conditioning
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Temperature Control
Fan Control
Air Delivery Mode Control
Rear Window Defogger
Recirculation
Air Conditioning
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Temperature Control
Fan Control
Air Delivery Mode Control
Rear Window Defogger
Recirculation
Temperature Control : Turn clockwise or
counterclockwise to increase or decrease the
temperature.
A : Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to
increase or decrease the fan speed. Turning
the fan control to 0 turns the fan off. The
fan must be turned on to run the air
conditioning compressor.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
118
Climate Controls
Air Delivery Mode Control : Turn clockwise
or counterclockwise to change the current
airflow mode.
Select from the following air delivery
modes:
Y : Air is directed to the instrument panel
outlets.
\ : Air is divided between the instrument
panel and floor outlets.
[ : Air is directed to the floor outlets.
W : This mode clears the windows of fog
or moisture. Air is directed to the floor,
windshield, and side window outlets.
1 : This mode clears the windshield of fog
or frost more quickly. Air is directed to the
windshield and side window outlets.
Do not drive the vehicle until all windows
are clear.
In defrost or defog mode, excessive air
conditioning use can cause the windows to
fog. If this happens, change the air delivery
mode to Y and reduce the fan speed.
A/C : If equipped with air conditioning,
follow these steps to use the system. Turn
A to the desired speed. The air
conditioning does not operate when the fan
control knob is in the off position. Press A/C
to turn the air conditioning on and off.
When A/C is pressed, an indicator light
comes on to show that the air conditioning
is on.
For quick cool down on hot days:
1. Open the windows to let hot air escape.
2. Press M.
3. Press A/C.
4. Select the coolest temperature.
5. Select the highest
A speed.
Using these settings together for long
periods of time may cause the air inside the
vehicle to become too dry. To prevent this
from happening, after the air in the vehicle
has cooled, turn the recirculation mode off.
Using the recirculation mode for extended
periods may cause the windows to fog.
If this happens, select the defrost mode.
If the air delivery mode is set to W or 1,
A/C operation and outside air mode will be
fixed to defog or defrost as quickly as
possible regardless of indicator status.
Rear Window and Outside Mirror
Defogger
1 : Press to turn the rear window and
outside mirror defogger on or off. An
indicator light comes on to show that the
feature is on.
The rear window defogger can be turned off
by pressing 1 again or by turning the
ignition off or to ACC/ACCESSORY.
quickly cool the air inside the vehicle. It can
be used to reduce the entry of outside air
and odors.
If equipped with heated outside mirrors,
they turn on with the rear window defogger
and help to clear fog or frost from the
surface of the mirror. See Heated Mirrors
0 21.
Press M to turn the recirculation mode
on. An indicator light comes on to show
that the recirculation is on. Press M again
to return to outside air mode.
Using a razor blade or sharp object to
clear the inside rear window can damage
the rear window defogger. Repairs would
M : This mode recirculates and helps to
Caution
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Climate Controls
119
. Use of non-GM approved hood deflectors
Caution (Continued)
can adversely affect the performance of
the system. Check with your dealer
before adding equipment to the outside
of the vehicle.
not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Do not clear the inside rear window with
sharp objects.
Air Vents
Maintenance
Adjustable air vents are in the center and on
the side of the instrument panel.
Air Intake
Additional air vents are located beneath the
windshield and the driver and passenger
side door windows, and in the footwells.
These are fixed and cannot be adjusted.
Move the slats to change the direction of
the airflow. The center air vent does not
close completely.
Operation Tips
. Clear away any ice, snow, or leaves from
air inlets at the base of the windshield
that could block the flow of air into the
vehicle.
. Clear snow off the hood to improve
visibility and help decrease moisture
drawn into the vehicle.
. Keep the path under the front seats clear
of objects to help circulate the air inside
of the vehicle more effectively.
The air intake at the base of the windshield
under the hood must be kept clear to allow
the flow of air into the vehicle. Clear away
any ice, snow, or leaves.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
120
Climate Controls
Passenger Compartment Air Filter
Caution
The filter reduces the dust, pollen, and other
airborne irritants from outside air that is
pulled into the vehicle.
Damage caused by improper refrigerant
usage could lead to costly repairs and
may not be covered by the vehicle
warranty. Refrigerant systems should
only be serviced by qualified personnel.
Always use the correct refrigerant.
The filter should be replaced as part of
routine scheduled maintenance. See
Maintenance Schedule 0 226. To find out
what type of filter to use, see Maintenance
Replacement Parts 0 235.
{ Warning
3. Open the filter cover by releasing the
tabs on both sides and pulling up the
cover.
4. Replace the air filter.
5. Close the air filter cover and tabs.
6. Reinstall the glove box.
See your dealer if additional assistance is
needed.
1. Open the glove box completely and
loosen the bolts on the outboard side.
2. Push in both sides of the glove box and
pull to remove.
Air Conditioning Regular
Operation
To ensure continuous efficient performance,
operate the air conditioning for a few
minutes once a month. The air conditioning
will not operate if the outside temperature
is too low.
Performing service work to the climate
control system could cause personal
injury or damage to the vehicle. Climate
control systems are serviced by qualified
personnel only.
Service
All vehicles have a label underhood that
identifies the refrigerant used in the vehicle.
The refrigerant system should only be
serviced by trained and certified technicians.
The air conditioning evaporator should never
be repaired or replaced by one from a
salvage vehicle. It should only be replaced
by a new evaporator to ensure proper and
safe operation.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Climate Controls
During service, all refrigerants should be
reclaimed with proper equipment. Venting
refrigerants directly to the atmosphere is
harmful to the environment and may
also create unsafe conditions based on
inhalation, combustion, frostbite, or other
health-based concerns.
The air conditioning system requires periodic
maintenance. See Maintenance Schedule
0 226.
121
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
122
Driving and Operating
Driving and Operating
Driving Information
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . 123
Distracted Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Impaired Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Driving on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
If the Vehicle Is Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Starting and Operating
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Ignition Positions (Key Access) . . . . . . . . . 132
Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) . . . . . 134
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Engine Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . 138
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Shifting out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Parking (Manual Transmission) . . . . . . . . 139
Parking over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . 139
Extended Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Engine Exhaust
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . 140
Automatic Transmission
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Manual Transmission
Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Brakes
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Brake Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Ride Control Systems
Traction Control/Electronic Stability
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Cruise Control
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Driver Assistance Systems
Driver Assistance Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Rear Vision Camera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Automatic Emergency Braking (AEB) . . . 153
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) . . . . . . . . 154
Fuel
Top Tier Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Recommended Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Prohibited Fuels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Fuel Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . 158
Trailer Towing
General Towing Information . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Conversions and Add-Ons
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Driving Information
Distracted Driving
Driving for Better Fuel Economy
Distraction comes in many forms and can
take your focus from the task of driving.
Exercise good judgment and do not let other
activities divert your attention away from
the road. Many local governments have
enacted laws regarding driver distraction.
Become familiar with the local laws in
your area.
Driving habits can affect fuel mileage. Here
are some driving tips to get the best fuel
economy possible:
. Set the climate controls to the desired
temperature after the engine is started,
or turn them off when not required.
. Avoid fast starts and accelerate smoothly.
. Brake gradually and avoid abrupt stops.
. Avoid idling the engine for long periods
of time.
. When road and weather conditions are
appropriate, use cruise control.
. Always follow posted speed limits or
drive more slowly when conditions
require.
. Keep vehicle tires properly inflated.
. Combine several trips into a single trip.
. Replace the vehicle's tires with the same
TPC Spec number molded into the tire's
sidewall near the size.
. Follow recommended scheduled
maintenance.
To avoid distracted driving, keep your eyes
on the road, keep your hands on the
steering wheel, and focus your attention on
driving.
. Do not use a phone in demanding driving
situations. Use a hands-free method to
place or receive necessary phone calls.
. Watch the road. Do not read, take notes,
or look up information on phones or
other electronic devices.
. Designate a front seat passenger to
handle potential distractions.
. Become familiar with vehicle features
before driving, such as programming
favorite radio stations and adjusting
climate control and seat settings. Program
all trip information into any navigation
device prior to driving.
123
. Wait until the vehicle is parked to
retrieve items that have fallen to the
floor.
. Stop or park the vehicle to tend to
children.
. Keep pets in an appropriate carrier or
restraint.
. Avoid stressful conversations while
driving, whether with a passenger or on a
cell phone.
{ Warning
Taking your eyes off the road too long or
too often could cause a crash resulting in
injury or death. Focus your attention on
driving.
Refer to the infotainment section for more
information on using that system and the
navigation system, if equipped, including
pairing and using a cell phone.
Defensive Driving
Defensive driving means “always expect the
unexpected.” The first step in driving
defensively is to wear the seat belt. See
Seat Belts 0 31.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
124
Driving and Operating
. Assume that other road users
(pedestrians, bicyclists, and other drivers)
are going to be careless and make
mistakes. Anticipate what they may do
and be ready.
. Allow enough following distance between
you and the driver in front of you.
. Focus on the task of driving.
Impaired Driving
Death and injury associated with impaired
driving is a global tragedy.
{ Warning
Drinking alcohol or taking drugs and then
driving is very dangerous. Your reflexes,
perceptions, attentiveness, and judgment
can be affected by even a small amount
of alcohol or drugs. You can have a
serious — or even fatal — collision if you
drive after drinking or taking drugs.
Do not drive while under the influence of
alcohol or drugs, or ride with a driver
who has been drinking or is impaired by
drugs. Find alternate transportation
home; or if you are with a group,
designate a driver who will remain sober.
Control of a Vehicle
Braking, steering, and accelerating are
important factors in helping to control a
vehicle while driving.
Braking
Braking action involves perception time and
reaction time. Deciding to push the brake
pedal is perception time. Actually doing it is
reaction time.
Average driver reaction time is about
three-quarters of a second. In that time, a
vehicle moving at 100 km/h (60 mph) travels
20 m (66 ft), which could be a lot of
distance in an emergency.
Helpful braking tips to keep in mind include:
. Keep enough distance between you and
the vehicle in front of you.
. Avoid needless heavy braking.
. Keep pace with traffic.
If the engine ever stops while the vehicle is
being driven, brake normally but do not
pump the brakes. Doing so could make the
pedal harder to push down. If the engine
stops, there will be some power brake assist
but it will be used when the brake is
applied. Once the power assist is used up, it
can take longer to stop and the brake pedal
will be harder to push.
Steering
Caution
To avoid damage to the steering system,
do not drive over curbs, parking barriers,
or similar objects at speeds greater than
3 km/h (1 mph). Use care when driving
over other objects such as lane dividers
and speed bumps. Damage caused by
misuse of the vehicle is not covered by
the vehicle warranty.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Electric Power Steering
. Wait until the vehicle is out of the curve
The vehicle has electric power steering.
It does not have power steering fluid.
Regular maintenance is not required.
Steering in Emergencies
If power steering assist is lost due to a
system malfunction, the vehicle can be
steered, but may require increased effort.
See your dealer if there is a problem.
If the steering wheel is turned until it
reaches the end of its travel and is held
against that position for an extended period
of time, power steering assist may be
reduced.
If the steering assist is used for an extended
period of time while the vehicle is not
moving, power assist may be reduced.
Normal use of the power steering assist
should return when the system cools down.
See your dealer if there is a problem.
Curve Tips
. Take curves at a reasonable speed.
. Reduce speed before entering a curve.
. Maintain a reasonable steady speed
through the curve.
125
around a problem may be more effective
than braking.
. Holding both sides of the steering wheel
allows you to turn 180 degrees without
removing a hand.
. The Antilock Brake System (ABS) allows
steering while braking.
The vehicle's right wheels can drop off the
edge of a road onto the shoulder while
driving. Follow these tips:
1. Ease off the accelerator and then,
if there is nothing in the way, steer the
vehicle so that it straddles the edge of
the pavement.
2. Turn the steering wheel about
one-eighth of a turn, until the right front
tire contacts the pavement edge.
3. Turn the steering wheel to go straight
down the roadway.
Off-Road Recovery
Loss of Control
before accelerating gently into the
straightaway.
. There are some situations when steering
Skidding
There are three types of skids that
correspond to the vehicle's three control
systems:
. Braking Skid — wheels are not rolling.
. Steering or Cornering Skid — too much
speed or steering in a curve causes tires
to slip and lose cornering force.
. Acceleration Skid — too much throttle
causes the driving wheels to spin.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
126
Driving and Operating
Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking
reasonable care suited to existing conditions,
and by not overdriving those conditions. But
skids are always possible.
If the vehicle starts to slide, follow these
suggestions:
. Ease your foot off the accelerator pedal
and steer the way you want the vehicle
to go. The vehicle may straighten out. Be
ready for a second skid if it occurs.
. Slow down and adjust your driving
according to weather conditions. Stopping
distance can be longer and vehicle control
can be affected when traction is reduced
by water, snow, ice, gravel, or other
material on the road. Learn to recognize
warning clues — such as enough water,
ice, or packed snow on the road to make
a mirrored surface — and slow down
when you have any doubt.
. Try to avoid sudden steering, acceleration,
or braking, including reducing vehicle
speed by shifting to a lower gear. Any
sudden changes could cause the tires to
slide.
Remember: Antilock brakes help avoid only
the braking skid.
Driving on Wet Roads
Hydroplaning
Rain and wet roads can reduce vehicle
traction and affect your ability to stop and
accelerate. Always drive slower in these
types of driving conditions and avoid driving
through large puddles and deep-standing or
flowing water.
Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water can build
up under the vehicle's tires so they actually
ride on the water. This can happen if the
road is wet enough and you are going fast
enough. When the vehicle is hydroplaning, it
has little or no contact with the road.
{ Warning
Wet brakes can cause crashes. They
might not work as well in a quick stop
and could cause pulling to one side. You
could lose control of the vehicle.
After driving through a large puddle of
water or a car/vehicle wash, lightly apply
the brake pedal until the brakes work
normally.
Flowing or rushing water creates strong
forces. Driving through flowing water
could cause the vehicle to be carried
away. If this happens, you and other
vehicle occupants could drown. Do not
ignore police warnings and be very
cautious about trying to drive through
flowing water.
There is no hard and fast rule about
hydroplaning. The best advice is to slow
down when the road is wet.
Other Rainy Weather Tips
Besides slowing down, other wet weather
driving tips include:
. Allow extra following distance.
. Pass with caution.
. Keep windshield wiping equipment in
good shape.
. Keep the windshield washer fluid reservoir
filled.
. Have good tires with proper tread depth.
See Tires 0 189.
. Turn off cruise control.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Hill and Mountain Roads
. Drive at speeds that keep the vehicle in
Driving on steep hills or through mountains
is different than driving on flat or rolling
terrain. Tips include:
. Keep the vehicle serviced and in good
shape.
. Check all fluid levels and brakes, tires,
cooling system, and transmission.
. Shift to a lower gear when going down
steep or long hills.
Winter Driving
{ Warning
Using the brakes to slow the vehicle on a
long downhill slope can cause brake
overheating, can reduce brake
performance, and could result in a loss of
braking. Shift the transmission to a lower
gear to let the engine assist the brakes
on a steep downhill slope.
{ Warning
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral) or with
the ignition off is dangerous. This can
cause overheating of the brakes and loss
of steering assist. Always have the engine
running and the vehicle in gear.
its own lane. Do not swing wide or cross
the center line.
. Be alert on top of hills; something could
be in your lane (e.g., stalled car, crash).
. Pay attention to special road signs
(e.g., falling rocks area, winding roads,
long grades, passing or no-passing zones)
and take appropriate action.
Driving on Snow or Ice
Caution
To avoid damage to the wheels and
brake components, always clear snow and
ice from inside the wheels and
underneath the vehicle before driving.
Snow or ice between the tires and the road
creates less traction or grip, so drive
carefully. Wet ice can occur at about 0 °C
(32 °F) when freezing rain begins to fall.
Avoid driving on wet ice or in freezing rain
until roads can be treated.
127
For Slippery Road Driving:
. Accelerate gently. Accelerating too quickly
causes the wheels to spin and makes the
surface under the tires slick.
. Turn on Traction Control. See Traction
Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 145.
. The Antilock Brake System (ABS) improves
vehicle stability during hard stops, but
the brakes should be applied sooner than
when on dry pavement. See Antilock
Brake System (ABS) 0 144.
. Allow greater following distance and
watch for slippery spots. Icy patches can
occur on otherwise clear roads in shaded
areas. The surface of a curve or an
overpass can remain icy when the
surrounding roads are clear. Avoid sudden
steering maneuvers and braking while
on ice.
. Turn off cruise control.
Blizzard Conditions
Stop the vehicle in a safe place and signal
for help. Stay with the vehicle unless there
is help nearby. If possible, use Roadside
Assistance. See Roadside Assistance Program
0 244. To get help and keep everyone in the
vehicle safe:
. Turn on the hazard warning flashers.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
128
Driving and Operating
. Tie a red cloth to an outside mirror.
{ Warning
Snow can trap engine exhaust under the
vehicle. This may cause exhaust gases to
get inside. Engine exhaust contains
carbon monoxide (CO), which cannot be
seen or smelled. It can cause
unconsciousness and even death.
If the vehicle is stuck in snow:
. Clear snow from the base of the
vehicle, especially any blocking the
exhaust pipe.
. Open a window about 5 cm (2 in) on
the vehicle side that is away from the
wind, to bring in fresh air.
. Fully open the air outlets on or under
the instrument panel.
. Adjust the climate control system to
circulate the air inside the vehicle and
set the fan speed to the highest
setting. See “Climate Control Systems.”
For more information about CO, see
Engine Exhaust 0 140.
To save fuel, run the engine for short
periods to warm the vehicle and then shut
the engine off and partially close the
window. Moving about to keep warm also
helps.
If it takes time for help to arrive, when
running the engine, push the accelerator
pedal slightly so the engine runs faster than
the idle speed. This keeps the battery
charged to restart the vehicle and to signal
for help with the headlamps. Do this as
little as possible, to save fuel.
If the Vehicle Is Stuck
Slowly and cautiously spin the wheels to
free the vehicle when stuck in sand, mud,
ice, or snow.
If stuck too severely for the traction system
to free the vehicle, turn the traction system
off and use the rocking method. See
Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control
0 145.
{ Warning
If the vehicle's tires spin at high speed,
they can explode, and you or others
could be injured. The vehicle can
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
overheat, causing an engine compartment
fire or other damage. Spin the wheels as
little as possible and avoid going above
56 km/h (35 mph).
Rocking the Vehicle to Get it Out
Turn the steering wheel left and right to
clear the area around the front wheels. Turn
off any traction system. Shift back and forth
between R (Reverse) and a low forward gear,
spinning the wheels as little as possible. To
prevent transmission wear, wait until the
wheels stop spinning before shifting gears.
Release the accelerator pedal while shifting,
and press lightly on the accelerator pedal
when the transmission is in gear. Slowly
spinning the wheels in the forward and
reverse directions causes a rocking motion
that could free the vehicle. If that does not
get the vehicle out after a few tries, it
might need to be towed out. If the vehicle
does need to be towed out, see Towing the
Vehicle 0 212.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Vehicle Load Limits
Tire and Loading Information Label
It is very important to know how much
weight the vehicle can carry. This
weight is called the vehicle capacity
weight and includes the weight of all
occupants, cargo, and all
nonfactory-installed options. Two labels
on the vehicle may show how much
weight it may properly carry: the Tire
and Loading Information label and the
Certification label.
{ Warning
Do not load the vehicle any heavier
than the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR), or either the maximum
front or rear Gross Axle Weight
Rating (GAWR). This can cause
systems to break and change the
way the vehicle handles. This could
cause loss of control and a crash.
Overloading can also reduce stopping
performance, damage the tires, and
shorten the life of the vehicle.
129
pressures (4). For more information on
tires and inflation see Tires 0 189 and
Tire Pressure 0 194.
There is also important loading
information on the Certification label.
It may show the Gross Vehicle Weight
Rating (GVWR) and the Gross Axle
Weight Rating (GAWR) for the front and
rear axle. See “Certification Label” later
in this section.
Label Example
A vehicle-specific Tire and Loading
Information label is attached to the
vehicle's center pillar (B-pillar). The Tire
and Loading Information label shows
the number of occupant seating
positions (1), and the maximum vehicle
capacity weight (2) in kilograms and
pounds.
The Tire and Loading Information label
also shows the tire size of the original
equipment tires (3) and the
recommended cold tire inflation
“Steps for Determining Correct Load
Limit–
1. Locate the statement "The combined
weight of occupants and cargo
should never exceed XXX kg or
XXX lbs." on your vehicle’s placard.
2. Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will
be riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of the
driver and passengers from XXX kg
or XXX lbs.
4. The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example,
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
130
Driving and Operating
if the "XXX" amount equals 1400 lbs.
and there will be five 150 lb
passengers in your vehicle, the
amount of available cargo and
luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.
(1400-750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
5. Determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo being loaded on
the vehicle. That weight may not
safely exceed the available cargo and
luggage load capacity calculated in
Step 4.
6. If your vehicle will be towing a
trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult
this manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and
luggage load capacity of your
vehicle.”
This vehicle is neither designed nor
intended to tow a trailer.
Example 1
1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for
Example 1 = 453 kg (1,000 lbs).
2. Subtract Occupant Weight @
68 kg (150 lbs) × 2 = 136 kg
(300 lbs).
3. Available Occupant and Cargo
Weight = 317 kg (700 lbs).
Example 2
1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for
Example 2 = 453 kg (1,000 lbs).
2. Subtract Occupant Weight @
68 kg (150 lbs) × 5 = 340 kg
(750 lbs).
3. Available Cargo Weight = 113 kg
(250 lbs).
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Certification Label
Example 3
1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for
Example 3 = 453 kg (1,000 lbs).
2. Subtract Occupant Weight @ 91 kg
(200 lbs) × 5 = 453 kg (1,000 lbs).
3. Available Cargo Weight =
0 kg (0 lbs).
Refer to the vehicle's Tire and Loading
Information label for specific
information about the vehicle's capacity
weight and seating positions. The
combined weight of the driver,
passengers, and cargo should never
exceed the vehicle's capacity weight.
Label Example
A vehicle-specific Certification label is
attached to the vehicle's center pillar
(B-pillar). The label may show the gross
weight capacity of the vehicle, called
the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR). The GVWR includes the weight
of the vehicle, all occupants, fuel, and
cargo.
131
{ Warning
Things inside the vehicle can strike
and injure people in a sudden stop or
turn, or in a crash.
. Put things in the cargo area of the
vehicle. In the cargo area, put
them as far forward as possible.
Try to spread the weight evenly.
. Never stack heavier things, like
suitcases, inside the vehicle so
that some of them are above the
tops of the seats.
. Do not leave an unsecured child
restraint in the vehicle.
. Secure loose items in the vehicle.
. Do not leave a seat folded down
unless needed.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
132
Driving and Operating
Starting and Operating
New Vehicle Break-In
Caution
The vehicle does not need an elaborate
break-in. But it will perform better in the
long run if you follow these guidelines:
. Do not drive at any one constant
speed, fast or slow, for the first
800 km (500 mi). Do not make
full-throttle starts. Avoid downshifting
to brake or slow the vehicle.
. Avoid making hard stops for the first
300 km (200 mi) or so. During this
time the new brake linings are not yet
broken in. Hard stops with new linings
can mean premature wear and earlier
replacement. Follow this breaking-in
guideline every time you get new
brake linings.
vehicle is driven, the mechanical systems
adjust to provide optimal fuel economy and
transmission shift performance.
Electrical systems will adapt and calibrate
during the break-in period. A one-time
occurrence of clicks and similar vehicle
noises is normal during this process.
Normal driving charges the vehicle’s battery
to achieve the best operation of the vehicle,
including fuel economy.
Ignition Positions (Key Access)
3. START
The ignition switch has four positions.
To shift out of P (Park) with an automatic
transmission, the ignition must be in ON/
RUN and the brake pedal must be applied.
0 (Stopping the Engine/LOCK/OFF) : This
position turns off the vehicle. It also locks
the ignition, the transmission on an
automatic transmission vehicle, and the
steering column, if equipped with a locking
steering column.
Following break-in, engine speed and load
can be gradually increased.
On new vehicles, the various mechanical and
electrical systems experience a “break-in”
period during the first 6,400 km
(4,000 miles) of routine driving. As the
0. Stopping the Engine/LOCK/OFF
1. ACC/ACCESSORY
2. ON/RUN
To turn off the vehicle:
1. Make sure that the vehicle is stopped.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
2. Shift to P (Park) with an automatic
transmission, or Neutral with a manual
transmission.
3. Continue to hold the brake pedal, then
set the parking brake. See Parking Brake
0 144.
4. Push the key all the way in toward the
steering column (1), then turn the key to
LOCK/OFF (2).
5. Remove the key.
6. Release the brake pedal.
See your dealer if the key can be removed
in any other position.
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) will remain
active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP)
0 138.
A warning chime will sound when the driver
door is opened and the key is in the
ignition.
If equipped with a locking steering column,
the steering can bind with the front wheels
turned off center, which may prevent key
rotation out of LOCK/OFF. If this happens,
move the steering wheel from right to left
while turning the key to ACC/ACCESSORY.
If this does not work, then the vehicle needs
service.
{ Warning
Turning off the vehicle while moving may
cause loss of power assist in the brake
and steering systems and disable the
airbags. While driving, turn off the
vehicle only in an emergency.
In an emergency, if the vehicle cannot be
pulled over and must be turned off while
driving:
1. Push the key all the way in toward the
steering column, then turn the key to
ACC/ACCESSORY.
2. Brake using firm and steady pressure. Do
not pump the brakes repeatedly. This
may deplete power assist, requiring
increased brake pedal force.
3. Shift the vehicle to N (Neutral). This can
be done while the vehicle is moving.
Continue braking and steer the vehicle to
a safe location.
4. Come to a complete stop.
5. Shift to P (Park) with an automatic
transmission, or Neutral with a manual
transmission.
133
6. Continue to hold the brake pedal, then
set the parking brake. See Parking Brake
0 144.
7. Push the key all the way in toward the
steering column, then turn the ignition
to LOCK/OFF.
8. Remove the key.
9. Release the brake pedal.
Caution
Use the correct key, make sure it is all
the way in — or pushed all the way in
toward the steering column when turning
off the vehicle — and turn it only with
your hand.
1 (ACC/ACCESSORY) : This position allows
features such as the infotainment system to
operate while the vehicle is off. It also
unlocks the steering column, if equipped
with a locking steering column. Use this
position if the vehicle must be pushed or
towed. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP)
0 138.
From ON/RUN, push the key all the way in
toward the steering column, then turn the
key to ACC/ACCESSORY.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
134
Driving and Operating
If the key is left in ACC/ACCESSORY with the
engine off, the battery could drain and the
vehicle may not start.
Ignition Positions (Keyless Access)
Stopping the Engine/OFF (No Indicator
Lights) : When the vehicle is stopped, press
ENGINE START/STOP once to turn the
engine off.
A warning chime will sound when the driver
door is opened and the key is in the
ignition.
2 (ON/RUN) : This position can be used to
operate the electrical accessories and to
display some instrument cluster warning
and indicator lights. This position can also
be used for service and diagnostics, and to
verify the proper operation of the
malfunction indicator lamp as may be
required for emission inspection purposes.
The switch stays in this position when the
engine is running. The transmission is also
unlocked in this position on automatic
transmission vehicles.
If the key is left in ON/RUN with the engine
off, the battery could drain and the vehicle
may not start.
3 (START) : This is the position that starts
the engine. When the engine starts, release
the key. The ignition returns to ON/RUN for
driving.
To shift out of P (Park), the vehicle must be
in ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN and the
brake pedal must be applied.
If the vehicle is in P (Park), the ignition will
turn off, and Retained Accessory Power (RAP)
will remain active. See Retained Accessory
Power (RAP) 0 138.
The vehicle may be equipped with an
electronic keyless ignition with pushbutton
start.
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
must be in the vehicle for the system to
operate. If the pushbutton start is not
working, the vehicle may be near a strong
radio antenna signal causing interference to
the Keyless Access system. See Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key
Access) 0 9 or
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) 0 11.
If the vehicle is not in P (Park), the ignition
will return to ACC/ACCESSORY and the Driver
Information Center (DIC) will display the
message SHIFT TO PARK. When the vehicle is
shifted into P (Park), the ignition system will
switch to OFF.
Do not turn the engine off when the vehicle
is moving. This will cause a loss of power
assist in the brake and steering systems and
disable the airbags.
If the vehicle must be shut off in an
emergency:
1. Brake using a firm and steady pressure.
Do not pump the brakes repeatedly. This
may deplete power assist, requiring
increased brake pedal force.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
2. Shift the vehicle to N (Neutral). This can
be done while the vehicle is moving.
After shifting to N (Neutral), firmly apply
the brakes and steer the vehicle to a
safe location.
3. Come to a complete stop. Shift to
P (Park) with an automatic transmission,
or Neutral with a manual transmission.
Turn the ignition to OFF.
4. Set the parking brake. See Parking Brake
0 144.
{ Warning
Turning off the vehicle while moving may
cause loss of power assist in the brake
and steering systems and disable the
airbags. While driving, only shut the
vehicle off in an emergency.
If the vehicle cannot be pulled over, and
must be shut off while driving, press and
hold ENGINE START/STOP for longer than
two seconds, or press twice in five seconds.
ACC/ACCESSORY (Amber Indicator Light) :
This mode allows you to use some electrical
accessories when the engine is off.
With the ignition off, pressing the button
one time without the brake pedal applied
will place the ignition system in ACC/
ACCESSORY.
The ignition will switch from ACC/
ACCESSORY to OFF after five minutes to
prevent battery rundown.
ON/RUN/START (Green Indicator Light) : This
mode is for driving and starting. With the
ignition off, and the brake pedal applied,
pressing the button once will place the
ignition system in ON/RUN/START. Once
engine cranking begins, release the button.
Engine cranking will continue until the
engine starts. See Starting the Engine 0 135.
The ignition will then remain in ON/RUN.
Service Mode
This power mode is available for service and
diagnostics, and to verify the proper
operation of the malfunction indicator lamp
as may be required for emission inspection
purposes. With the vehicle off, and the
brake pedal not applied, pressing and
holding the button for more than
five seconds will place the vehicle in Service
Mode. The instruments and audio systems
will operate as they do in ON/RUN, but the
135
vehicle will not be able to be driven. The
engine will not start in Service Mode. Press
the button again to turn the vehicle off.
Starting the Engine
Place the transmission in the proper gear.
Caution
If you add electrical parts or accessories,
you could change the way the engine
operates. Any resulting damage would
not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
See Add-On Electrical Equipment 0 158.
Automatic Transmission
Move the shift lever to P (Park) or
N (Neutral). To restart the vehicle when it is
already moving, use N (Neutral) only.
Caution
Do not try to shift to P (Park) if the
vehicle is moving. If you do, you could
damage the transmission. Shift to P (Park)
only when the vehicle is stopped.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
136
Driving and Operating
Manual Transmission
The shift lever should be in Neutral and the
parking brake engaged. Hold the clutch
pedal down to the floor, press the brake
pedal and start the engine.
Key Access
1. With your foot off the accelerator pedal,
turn the ignition key to START. When
the engine starts, let go of the key. The
idle speed will go down as the engine
warms. Do not race the engine
immediately after starting it. Allow the
oil to warm up and lubricate all moving
parts.
Caution
Cranking the engine for long periods of
time, by trying to start the engine
immediately after cranking has ended,
can overheat and damage the cranking
motor, and drain the battery. Wait at
least 15 seconds between each try, to let
the cranking motor cool down.
2. If the engine does not start after five to
10 seconds, especially in very cold
weather (below −18 °C or 0 °F), it could
be flooded with too much gasoline. Push
the accelerator pedal all the way to the
floor and hold it there as you hold the
key in START for a maximum of
15 seconds. Wait at least 15 seconds
between each try, to allow the cranking
motor to cool. When the engine starts,
let go of the key and accelerator. If the
vehicle starts briefly but then stops
again, repeat the procedure. This clears
the extra gasoline from the engine. Do
not race the engine immediately after
starting it. Operate the engine and
transmission gently until the oil warms
up and lubricates all moving parts.
Keyless Access
1. With the Keyless Access system, the RKE
transmitter must be in the vehicle. For
vehicles with an automatic transmission,
press the brake pedal, then press ENGINE
START/STOP on the instrument panel.
For vehicles with a manual transmission,
press the clutch pedal and the brake
pedal first, then press ENGINE
START/STOP.
The idle speed will go down as the
engine gets warm. Do not race the
engine immediately after starting it.
If the RKE transmitter is not in the
vehicle, if there is interference, or if the
RKE battery is low, a Driver Information
Center (DIC) message will display. See
Driver Information Center (DIC) 0 82 and
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Key Access) 0 9 or
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) 0 11.
Caution
Cranking the engine for long periods of
time, by trying to start the engine
immediately after cranking has ended,
can overheat and damage the cranking
motor, and drain the battery. Wait at
least 15 seconds between each try, to let
the cranking motor cool down.
2. If the engine does not start after five to
10 seconds, especially in very cold
weather (below −18 °C or 0 °F), it could
be flooded with too much gasoline. Try
pushing the accelerator pedal all the way
to the floor and holding it there as you
press ENGINE START/STOP, for up to a
maximum of 15 seconds. Wait at least
15 seconds between each try, to allow
the cranking motor to cool down. When
the engine starts, let go of the button
and the accelerator. If the vehicle starts
briefly but then stops again, do the
same thing. This clears the extra gasoline
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
from the engine. Do not race the engine
immediately after starting it. Operate
the engine and transmission gently until
the oil warms up and lubricates all
moving parts.
{ Warning
Improper use of the heater cord or an
extension cord can damage the cord and
may result in overheating and fire.
Engine Heater
The engine heater can provide easier
starting and better fuel economy during
engine warm-up in cold weather conditions
at or below −18 °C or 0 °F. Vehicles with an
engine heater should be plugged in at least
four hours before starting.
{ Warning
Do not plug in the engine block heater
while the vehicle is parked in a garage or
under a carport. Property damage or
personal injury may result. Always park
the vehicle in a clear open area away
from buildings or structures.
1. Turn off the engine.
137
. Plug the cord into a three-prong
2. Open the hood and unwrap the electrical
cord. The cord is in the driver side of the
engine compartment, near the engine
coolant surge tank. It is shipped from the
factory with a tie holding it in place. Use
care in removing the tie so that the cord
is not damaged.
Check the heater cord for damage. If it is
damaged, do not use it. See your dealer
for a replacement. Inspect the cord for
damage yearly.
3. Plug it into a normal, grounded 110-volt
AC outlet.
electrical utility receptacle that is
protected by a ground fault detection
function. An ungrounded outlet could
cause an electric shock.
. Use a weatherproof, heavy-duty,
15 amp-rated extension cord if needed.
Failure to use the recommended
extension cord in good operating
condition, or using a damaged heater
or extension cord, could make it
overheat and cause a fire, property
damage, electric shock, and injury.
. Do not operate the vehicle with the
heater cord permanently attached to
the vehicle. Possible heater cord and
thermostat damage could occur.
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
138
Driving and Operating
Warning (Continued)
. While in use, do not let the heater
cord touch vehicle parts or sharp
edges. Never close the hood on the
heater cord.
. Before starting the vehicle, unplug the
cord, reattach the cover to the plug,
and securely fasten the cord. Keep the
cord away from any moving parts.
4. Before starting the engine, be sure to
unplug and store the cord as it was
before to keep it away from moving
engine parts.
The length of time the heater should remain
plugged in depends on several factors. Ask a
dealer in the area where you will be parking
the vehicle for the best advice on this.
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)
When the ignition is turned from on to off,
the following features (if equipped) will
continue to function for up to 10 minutes,
or until the driver door is opened. These
features will also work when the ignition is
in RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY:
. Infotainment System
. Power Windows (during RAP this
functionality will be lost when any door
is opened)
. Sunroof (during RAP this functionality will
be lost when any door is opened)
. Auxiliary Power Outlet
. Audio System
. OnStar System
Shifting Into Park
1. Hold the brake pedal down and set the
parking brake. See Parking Brake 0 144.
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park) by
pressing the button on the shift lever
and pushing the lever all the way
toward the front of the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition off. For key access
vehicles, push the ignition key in, toward
the steering column and then turn the
ignition off.
4. Remove the key and take it with you.
If you can leave the vehicle with the
ignition key in your hand, the vehicle is
in P (Park).
Leaving the Vehicle with the Engine
Running (Automatic Transmission)
{ Warning
It can be dangerous to leave the vehicle
with the engine running. It could
overheat and catch fire.
It is dangerous to get out of the vehicle
if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park)
with the parking brake firmly set. The
vehicle can roll.
Do not leave the vehicle when the engine
is running. If you have left the engine
running, the vehicle can move suddenly.
You or others could be injured. To be
sure the vehicle will not move, even
when you are on fairly level ground,
always set the parking brake and move
the shift lever to P (Park). See Shifting
Into Park 0 138.
If you have to leave the vehicle with the
engine running, be sure the vehicle is in
P (Park) and the parking brake is firmly set
before you leave it. After you have moved
the shift lever into P (Park), hold the brake
pedal down. Then see if you can move the
shift lever away from P (Park) without first
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
pressing the button on the shift lever. If you
can, it means that the shift lever was not
fully locked into P (Park).
Torque Lock (Automatic Transmission)
If you are parking on a hill and you do not
shift the transmission into P (Park) properly,
the weight of the vehicle may put too much
force on the parking pawl in the
transmission. You may find it difficult to pull
the shift lever out of P (Park). This is called
“torque lock.” To prevent torque lock, set the
parking brake and then shift into P (Park)
properly before you leave the driver seat. To
find out how, see “Shifting Into Park”
previously in this section.
When you are ready to drive, move the
shift lever out of P (Park) before you release
the parking brake.
If torque lock does occur, you may need to
have another vehicle push yours a little
uphill to take some of the pressure from the
parking pawl in the transmission, so you can
pull the shift lever out of P (Park).
Shifting out of Park
This vehicle is equipped with a shift lock
release system. The shift lock release is
designed to:
. Prevent ignition key removal unless the
shift lever is in P (Park) with the shift
lever button fully released.
. Prevent movement of the shift lever out
of P (Park) unless the ignition is on and
the brake pedal is applied.
The shift lock release is always functional
except in the case of an uncharged or low
voltage (less than 9-volt) battery.
If the vehicle has an uncharged battery or a
battery with low voltage, try charging or
jump starting the battery. See Jump Starting
- North America 0 210.
To
1.
2.
3.
4.
shift out of P (Park):
Apply the brake pedal.
Start the vehicle.
Press the shift lever button.
Move the shift lever to the desired
position.
If still unable to shift out of P (Park):
1. Fully release the shift lever button.
139
2. Hold the brake pedal down and press the
shift lever button again.
3. Move the shift lever to the desired
position.
If the shift lever still cannot be moved from
P (Park), have the vehicle serviced soon.
The doors may lock when shifting from
P (Park). See Automatic Door Locks 0 16.
Parking (Manual Transmission)
{ Warning
If the vehicle has a manual transmission,
never get out of the vehicle without first
moving the shift lever into 1st or
R (Reverse), setting the parking brake and
turning the ignition off. The vehicle can
roll, which could cause serious injury or
death.
Parking over Things That Burn
{ Warning
Things that can burn could touch hot
exhaust parts under the vehicle and
ignite. Do not park over papers, leaves,
dry grass, or other things that can burn.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
140
Driving and Operating
Extended Parking
It is best not to park with the vehicle
running. If the vehicle is left running, be
sure it will not move and there is adequate
ventilation. See Shifting Into Park 0 138 and
Engine Exhaust 0 140.
If the vehicle is left parked and running with
the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
outside the vehicle, it will continue to run
for up to half an hour.
If the vehicle is left parked and running with
the RKE transmitter inside the vehicle, it will
continue to run for up to an hour.
The vehicle could turn off sooner if it is
parked on a hill, due to lack of
available fuel.
Automatic Transmission
The timer will reset if the vehicle is taken
out of P (Park) while it is running.
Manual Transmission
The timer will reset if vehicle speed exceeds
4 km/h (2.5 mph).
Engine Exhaust
{ Warning
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide
(CO), which cannot be seen or smelled.
Exposure to CO can cause
unconsciousness and even death.
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:
. The vehicle idles in areas with poor
.
.
.
.
ventilation (parking garages, tunnels,
deep snow that may block underbody
airflow or tail pipes).
The exhaust smells or sounds strange
or different.
The exhaust system leaks due to
corrosion or damage.
The vehicle exhaust system has been
modified, damaged, or improperly
repaired.
There are holes or openings in the
vehicle body from damage or
aftermarket modifications that are not
completely sealed.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
If unusual fumes are detected or if it is
suspected that exhaust is coming into the
vehicle:
. Drive it only with the windows
completely down.
. Have the vehicle repaired immediately.
Never park the vehicle with the engine
running in an enclosed area such as a
garage or a building that has no fresh air
ventilation.
Running the Vehicle While Parked
It is better not to park with the engine
running.
If the vehicle is left with the engine running,
follow the proper steps to be sure the
vehicle will not move. See Shifting Into Park
0 138 and
Engine Exhaust 0 140. If the vehicle has a
manual transmission, see Parking (Manual
Transmission) 0 139.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Automatic Transmission
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)
The CVT is electronically controlled to
produce maximum power and smooth
operation. A display in the instrument
cluster indicates the selected range.
P : This position locks the drive wheels. Use
P (Park) when starting the engine because
the vehicle cannot move easily.
{ Warning
It is dangerous to get out of the vehicle
if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park)
with the parking brake firmly set. The
vehicle can roll.
Do not leave the vehicle when the engine
is running. If you have left the engine
running, the vehicle can move suddenly.
You or others could be injured. To be
sure the vehicle will not move, even
when you are on fairly level ground,
always set the parking brake and move
the shift lever to P (Park). See Shifting
Into Park 0 138.
Make sure the shift lever is fully in P (Park)
before starting the engine. The vehicle has a
shift lock release control. The brake pedal
must be fully applied, and the shift lever
button must be pressed before shifting from
P (Park) while the ignition is on. If the
transmission will not shift out of P (Park),
ease pressure on the shift lever and push
the shift lever all the way into P (Park) while
maintaining brake application. Then move
the shift lever into another gear. See
Shifting out of Park 0 139.
R : Use this gear to back up.
141
Caution
Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is
moving forward could damage the
transmission. The repairs would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty. Shift to
R (Reverse) only after the vehicle is
stopped.
To rock the vehicle back and forth to get
out of snow, ice, or sand without damaging
the transmission, see If the Vehicle Is Stuck
0 128.
N : In this position, the engine does not
connect with the wheels. To restart the
engine when the vehicle is already moving,
use N (Neutral) only.
{ Warning
Shifting into a drive gear while the
engine is running at high speed is
dangerous. Unless your foot is firmly on
the brake pedal, the vehicle could move
very rapidly. You could lose control and
hit people or objects. Do not shift into a
drive gear while the engine is running at
high speed.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
142
Driving and Operating
Caution
Shifting out of P (Park) or N (Neutral) with
the engine running at high speed may
damage the transmission. The repairs
would not be covered by the vehicle
warranty. Be sure the engine is not
running at high speed when shifting the
vehicle.
mountain roads, along with using the brakes
off and on. This may prolong the life of the
brake linings.
In the event of a fault, the malfunction
indicator lamp illuminates. See your dealer
for repairs.
The message MANUAL TRANSMISSION —
RELEASE CLUTCH PEDAL displays and a
chime sounds if the manual transmission
clutch pedal is partially applied for an
extended period of time while the vehicle
is being driven. Driving with the clutch
pedal applied can reduce the life of the
clutch and/or damage it. Fully release the
clutch pedal after each gear change.
A transmission hot message may display
if the automatic transmission fluid is too
hot. Driving under this condition can
damage the vehicle. Stop and idle the
engine to cool the automatic
transmission fluid. This message clears
when the transmission fluid has cooled
sufficiently.
L : This position reduces vehicle speed
without using the brakes by using the
braking effect of engine compression. It can
help control vehicle speed going down steep
hills, on long downhill grades, or on
time the gear shifting with the
accelerator to avoid revving the engine
and damaging the clutch.
Caution
Manual Transmission
Caution
D : This position is for normal driving.
If more power is needed for passing, press
the accelerator pedal down.
Caution (Continued)
Caution
Caution
Shifting the vehicle initially into any gear
other than 1 (First) or R (Reverse) can
damage the clutch. Shift the manual
transmission in the proper sequence, and
(Continued)
The message REDUCED PERFORMANCE —
REDUCE CLUTCH USE displays and engine
torque is momentarily limited if excessive
manual transmission clutch slip is
detected while the clutch pedal is fully
released. This could be caused by a hot
clutch. Apply less pressure on the
accelerator pedal when accelerating from
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Caution (Continued)
a stop. Also, fully release the accelerator
pedal during gear changes. This will allow
the clutch to cool and should prevent
further clutch slip while the clutch pedal
is fully released. If this message displays
repeatedly, see your dealer. Repeated
clutch slip could cause permanent
damage.
1 : Press the clutch pedal and shift into
1 (First). Then, slowly let up on the clutch
pedal as you press the accelerator pedal.
If you have come to a complete stop and it
is hard to shift into 1 (First), put the shift
lever in Neutral and let up on the clutch.
Press the clutch pedal back down. Then shift
into 1 (First).
2 : Press the clutch pedal as you let up on
the accelerator pedal and shift into
2 (Second). Then, slowly let up on the clutch
pedal as you press the accelerator pedal.
3, 4, and 5 : Shift into 3 (Third), 4 (Fourth),
and 5 (Fifth) the same way as for 2 (Second).
Slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you
press the accelerator pedal.
To stop, let up on the accelerator pedal and
press the brake pedal. Just before the
vehicle stops, press the clutch pedal and the
brake pedal, and shift to Neutral.
Neutral : Use this position when you start
or idle the engine.
R : To back up, press down the clutch pedal
and shift into R (Reverse). Let up on the
clutch pedal slowly while pressing the
accelerator pedal.
143
Shift Speeds
{ Warning
If you skip a gear when downshifting,
you could lose control of the vehicle. You
could injure yourself or others. Do not
shift down more than one gear at a time
when downshifting.
Up-Shift Light
Caution
Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is
moving forward could damage the
transmission. The repairs would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty. Shift to
R (Reverse) only after the vehicle is
stopped.
Caution
Do not rest your hand on the shift lever
while driving. The pressure could cause
premature wear in the transmission. The
repairs would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty.
Vehicles equipped with a manual
transmission may have an up-shift light. This
light indicates when to shift to the next
higher gear for better fuel economy.
For the best fuel economy, accelerate slowly
and shift when the light comes on, and if
the weather, road, and traffic conditions
allow.
It is normal for the light to go on and off if
the accelerator position changes quickly.
Ignore the light during downshifts.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
144
Driving and Operating
Brakes
Using ABS
Antilock Brake System (ABS)
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold the brake
pedal down firmly. Hearing or feeling ABS
operate is normal.
The Antilock Brake System (ABS) helps
prevent a braking skid and maintain steering
while braking hard.
ABS performs a system check when the
vehicle is first driven. A momentary motor
or clicking noise may be heard while this
test is going on, and the brake pedal may
move slightly. This is normal.
Braking in Emergencies
ABS allows steering and braking at the same
time. In many emergencies, steering can
help even more than braking.
Parking Brake
3. The brake system warning light will
come on, if the ignition is on. See Brake
System Warning Light 0 76.
To release the parking brake:
1. Hold the regular brake pedal down.
2. Pull the parking brake handle up until
the release button can be pressed easily.
3. Hold the release button while lowering
the brake handle all the way down.
4. The brake system warning light will turn
off, if the ignition is on.
Caution
Driving with the parking brake on can
overheat the brake system and cause
premature wear or damage to brake
system parts. Make sure that the parking
brake is fully released and the brake
warning light is off before driving.
If there is a problem with ABS, this warning
light stays on. See Antilock Brake System
(ABS) Warning Light 0 77.
ABS does not change the time needed to
get a foot on the brake pedal and does not
always decrease stopping distance. If you
get too close to the vehicle ahead, there will
not be enough time to apply the brakes if
that vehicle suddenly slows or stops. Always
leave enough room ahead to stop, even
with ABS.
To set the parking brake:
1. Hold the regular brake pedal down.
2. Pull up firmly on the parking brake
handle without pressing the release
button.
Driving with the parking brake applied will
cause a warning chime to sound and a
Driver Information Center (DIC) message
may display. Release the parking brake or
stop the vehicle.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Brake Assist
Brake Assist detects rapid brake pedal
applications due to emergency braking
situations and provides additional braking to
activate the Antilock Brake System (ABS) if
the brake pedal is not pushed hard enough
to activate ABS normally. Minor noise, brake
pedal pulsation, and/or pedal movement
during this time may occur. Continue to
apply the brake pedal as the driving
situation dictates. Brake Assist disengages
when the brake pedal is released.
Hill Start Assist (HSA)
{ Warning
Do not rely on the HSA feature. HSA does
not replace the need to pay attention
and drive safely. You may not hear or
feel alerts or warnings provided by this
system. Failure to use proper care when
driving may result in injury, death,
or vehicle damage. See Defensive Driving
0 123.
When the vehicle is stopped on a grade, Hill
Start Assist (HSA) temporarily prevents the
vehicle from rolling in an unintended
direction during the transition from brake
pedal release to accelerator pedal apply. The
brakes release when the accelerator pedal is
applied or automatically release after a few
seconds. The brakes may also release under
other conditions. Do not rely on HSA to hold
the vehicle.
HSA is available when the vehicle is facing
uphill in a forward gear, or when facing
downhill in R (Reverse). The vehicle must
come to a complete stop on a grade for HSA
to activate.
Ride Control Systems
Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control
System Operation
The vehicle has a Traction Control System
(TCS) and StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability
Control (ESC), an electronic stability control
system. These systems help limit wheel slip
and assist the driver in maintaining control,
especially on slippery road conditions.
TCS activates if it senses that any of the
drive wheels are spinning or beginning to
lose traction. When this happens, TCS
145
applies the brakes to the spinning wheels
and reduces engine power to limit
wheel spin.
StabiliTrak/ESC activates when the vehicle
senses a difference between the intended
path and the direction the vehicle is actually
traveling. StabiliTrak/ESC selectively applies
braking pressure to any one of the vehicle
wheel brakes to assist the driver in keeping
the vehicle on the intended path.
If cruise control is being used and traction
control or StabiliTrak/ESC begins to limit
wheel spin, cruise control will disengage.
Cruise control may be turned back on when
road conditions allow.
Both systems come on automatically when
the vehicle is started and begins to move.
The systems may be heard or felt while
they are operating or while performing
diagnostic checks. This is normal and does
not mean there is a problem with the
vehicle.
It is recommended to leave both systems on
for normal driving conditions, but it may be
necessary to turn TCS off if the vehicle gets
stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow. See If the
Vehicle Is Stuck 0 128 and “Turning the
Systems Off and On” later in this section.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
146
Driving and Operating
Drive the vehicle. If d comes on and stays
on, the vehicle may need more time to
diagnose the problem. If the condition
persists, see your dealer.
To turn off only TCS, press and release g.
The Traction Off light i displays in the
instrument cluster. The appropriate DIC
message displays.
Turning the Systems Off and On
To turn TCS on again, press and release g.
The Traction Off light i displayed in the
instrument cluster will turn off. The
appropriate DIC message displays.
The indicator light for both systems is in the
instrument cluster. This light will:
. Flash when TCS is limiting wheel spin.
. Flash when StabiliTrak/ESC is activated.
. Turn on and stay on when either system
is not working.
If either system fails to turn on or to
activate, a message displays in the Driver
Information Center (DIC), and d comes on
and stays on to indicate that the system is
inactive and is not assisting the driver in
maintaining control. The vehicle is safe to
drive, but driving should be adjusted
accordingly.
If d comes on and stays on:
1. Stop the vehicle.
2. Turn the engine off and wait 15 seconds.
3. Start the engine.
If TCS is limiting wheel spin when g is
pressed, the system will not turn off until
the wheels stop spinning.
To turn off both TCS and StabiliTrak/ESC,
press and hold g until the Traction Off light
i and StabiliTrak/ESC Off light g come on
and stay on in the instrument cluster. The
appropriate DIC message displays.
The button for TCS and StabiliTrak/ESC is on
the lower instrument panel to the left of
the steering wheel.
Caution
Do not repeatedly brake or accelerate
heavily when TCS is off. The vehicle
driveline could be damaged.
To turn TCS and StabiliTrak/ESC on again,
press and release g. The Traction Off light
i and StabiliTrak/ESC Off light g in the
instrument cluster turn off. The appropriate
DIC message displays.
Adding accessories can affect the vehicle
performance. See Accessories and
Modifications 0 160.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Cruise Control
If the vehicle is equipped with cruise control,
a speed of about 40 km/h (25 mph) or more
can be maintained without keeping your
foot on the accelerator. Cruise control does
not work at speeds below 40 km/h (25 mph).
When road conditions allow you to safely
use it again, the cruise control can be
turned back on. Cruise control will disengage
if either TCS or StabiliTrak/ESC is turned off.
SET/− : Move the thumbwheel down briefly
to set the speed and activate cruise control.
If cruise control is already active, use to
decrease speed.
If the brakes are applied, cruise control
disengages.
* : Press to disengage cruise control
If J is on when not in use, SET/- or RES/+
could get bumped and go into cruise when
not desired. Keep J off when cruise
control is not being used.
Cruise control can be dangerous where
you cannot drive safely at a steady
speed. Do not use cruise control on
winding roads or in heavy traffic.
If the vehicle's Traction Control System (TCS)
or StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system begins to limit wheel spin
while using cruise control, the cruise control
will automatically disengage. See Traction
Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 145. If a
collision alert occurs when cruise control is
activated, cruise control is disengaged. See
Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System 0 152.
without erasing the set speed from memory.
Setting Cruise Control
{ Warning
Cruise control can be dangerous on
slippery roads. On such roads, fast
changes in tire traction can cause
excessive wheel slip, and you could lose
control. Do not use cruise control on
slippery roads.
147
To set cruise control:
J : Press to turn the cruise control system
on and off. A white indicator comes on in
the instrument cluster when cruise is
turned on.
RES/+ : If there is a set speed in memory,
move the thumbwheel up briefly to resume
to that speed or hold upward to accelerate.
If cruise control is already active, use to
increase vehicle speed.
1. Press J to turn the cruise system on.
2. Get to the speed desired.
3. Move the thumbwheel down to SET/and release it.
4. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.
The cruise control indicator on the
instrument cluster turns green after cruise
control has been set to the desired speed.
See Instrument Cluster 0 71.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
148
Driving and Operating
Resuming a Set Speed
Reducing Speed While Using Cruise Control
Using Cruise Control on Hills
If the cruise control is set at a desired speed
and then the brakes or clutch for manual
transmissions are applied or * is pressed,
the cruise control is disengaged without
erasing the set speed from memory.
If the cruise control system is already
activated:
. Move the thumbwheel toward SET/− and
hold until the desired lower speed is
reached, then release it.
. To decrease the vehicle speed in smaller
increments, move the thumbwheel
toward SET/− briefly. For each press, the
vehicle goes about 1 km/h (1 mph) slower.
How well cruise control works on hills
depends on the vehicle speed, load, and the
steepness of the hills. When going up steep
hills, you might have to step on the
accelerator pedal to maintain the vehicle
speed. When going downhill, you might
have to brake or shift to a lower gear to
keep your speed down. If the brake pedal is
applied, cruise control will disengage.
The speedometer reading can be displayed
in either English or metric units. See Driver
Information Center (DIC) 0 82. The
increment value used depends on the units
displayed.
Ending Cruise Control
Once the vehicle reaches about 40 km/h
(25 mph) or more, move the thumbwheel up
toward RES/+ briefly. The vehicle returns to
the previous set speed.
Increasing Speed While Using Cruise Control
If the cruise control system is already
activated:
. Move the thumbwheel up toward RES/+
and hold it until the desired speed is
reached, then release it.
. To increase the vehicle speed in small
increments, move the thumbwheel up
toward RES/+ briefly and then release it.
For each press, the vehicle goes about
1 km/h (1 mph) faster.
The speedometer reading can be displayed
in either English or metric units. See Driver
Information Center (DIC) 0 82. The
increment value used depends on the units
displayed.
Passing Another Vehicle While Using Cruise
Control
Use the accelerator pedal to increase the
vehicle speed. When you take your foot off
the pedal, the vehicle slows down to the
previous set cruise control speed. While
pressing the accelerator pedal or shortly
following the release to override cruise
control, briefly moving the thumbwheel
toward SET/- will result in cruise control set
to the current vehicle speed.
There are four ways to end cruise control:
. To disengage cruise control, step lightly
on the brake pedal or clutch for manual
transmission.
. Press * on the steering wheel.
. Shift the transmission to N (Neutral).
. To turn off cruise control, press J on
the steering wheel.
Erasing Speed Memory
The cruise control set speed is erased from
memory if the J button is pressed or if
the ignition is turned off.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Driver Assistance Systems
This vehicle may have features that work
together to help avoid crashes or reduce
crash damage while driving, backing, and
parking. Read this entire section before
using these systems.
{ Warning
Do not rely on the Driver Assistance
Systems. These systems do not replace
the need for paying attention and driving
safely. You may not hear or see alerts or
warnings provided by these systems.
Failure to use proper care when driving
may result in injury, death, or vehicle
damage. See Defensive Driving 0 123.
Under many conditions, these systems
will not:
. Detect children, pedestrians, bicyclists,
or animals.
. Detect vehicles or objects outside the
area monitored by the system.
. Work at all driving speeds.
. Warn you or provide you with enough
time to avoid a crash.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
. Work under poor visibility or bad
weather conditions.
. Work if the detection sensor is not
cleaned or is covered by ice, snow,
mud, or dirt.
. Work if the detection sensor is
covered up, such as with a sticker,
magnet, or metal plate.
. Work if the area surrounding the
detection sensor is damaged or not
properly repaired.
Complete attention is always required
while driving, and you should be ready to
take action and apply the brakes and/or
steer the vehicle to avoid crashes.
Audible Alert
Some driver assistance features alert the
driver of obstacles by beeping. To change
the volume of the warning chime, see
“Comfort and Convenience” under Vehicle
Personalization 0 88.
149
Cleaning
Depending on vehicle options, keep these
areas of the vehicle clean to ensure the best
driver assistance feature performance. Driver
Information Center (DIC) messages may
display when the systems are unavailable or
blocked.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
150
Driving and Operating
Rear Vision Camera (RVC)
When the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse),
the RVC displays an image of the area
behind the vehicle in the infotainment
display. The previous screen displays when
the vehicle is shifted out of R (Reverse) after
a short delay. To return to the previous
screen sooner, press Home or Back on the
infotainment system, shift into P (Park),
or reach a vehicle speed of approximately
12 km/h (8 mph) while in D (Drive).
. Front and rear bumpers and the area
.
.
.
.
.
.
1. View Displayed by the Camera
2. Corners of the Rear Bumper
below the bumpers
Front grille and headlamps
Front camera lens in the front grille or
near the front emblem
Front side and rear side panels
Outside of the windshield in front of the
rearview mirror
Rear side corner bumpers
Rear Vision Camera above the license
plate
Radio Frequency
This vehicle may be equipped with driver
assistance systems that operate using radio
frequency. See Radio Frequency Statement
0 248.
Displayed images may be farther or closer
than they appear. The area displayed is
limited and objects that are close to either
corner of the bumper or under the bumper
do not display.
1. View Displayed by the Camera
A warning triangle may appear on the
infotainment display to show that Rear Park
Assist (RPA) or Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA)
has detected an object. This triangle changes
from amber to red and increases in size the
closer the object.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
{ Warning
The camera(s) do not display children,
pedestrians, bicyclists, crossing traffic,
animals, or any other object outside of
the cameras’ field of view, below the
bumper, or under the vehicle. Shown
distances may be different from actual
distances. Do not drive or park the
vehicle using only these camera(s).
Always check behind and around the
vehicle before driving. Failure to use
proper care may result in injury, death,
or vehicle damage.
Park Assist
If equipped, the Rear Park Assist (RPA)
system assists the driver with parking and
avoiding objects while in R (Reverse). RPA
operates at speeds less than 8 km/h (5 mph).
The sensors on the rear bumper detect
objects up to 1.7 m (5.5 ft) behind the
vehicle, and at least 20 cm (8 in) off the
ground. The distance objects can be detected
may be less during warmer or humid
weather.
{ Warning
The Park Assist system does not detect
children, pedestrians, bicyclists, animals,
or objects below the bumper or that are
too close or too far from the vehicle. It is
not available at speeds greater than
8 km/h (5 mph). To prevent injury, death,
or vehicle damage, even with Park Assist,
always check the area around the vehicle
and check all mirrors before backing.
How the System Works
RPA comes on automatically when the shift
lever is moved into R (Reverse).
An obstacle is indicated by audible beeps.
The interval between the beeps becomes
shorter as the vehicle gets closer to the
obstacle. When the distance is less than
50 cm (20 in) the beeping is a
continuous tone.
Turning the System On and Off
The RPA system can be turned on and off
using the infotainment system controls. See
Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
151
When the System Does Not Seem to
Work Properly
This light may come on for the following
reasons:
. The sensors are not clean. Keep the
vehicle's rear bumper free of mud, dirt,
snow, ice, and slush. For cleaning
instructions, see Exterior Care 0 216.
. The sensors are covered by frost or ice.
Frost or ice can form around and behind
the sensors and may not always be seen;
this can occur after washing the vehicle in
cold weather. The light may not clear
until the frost or ice has melted.
. An object was hanging out of the liftgate
during the last drive cycle. Once the
object is removed, RPA will return to
normal operation.
. The bumper is damaged. Take the vehicle
to your dealer to repair the system.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
152
Driving and Operating
. Other conditions, such as vibrations from
a jackhammer or the compression of air
brakes on a very large truck, are affecting
system performance.
If the above conditions do not exist, take
the vehicle to your dealer to repair the
system.
Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
System
If equipped, the FCA system may help to
avoid or reduce the harm caused by
front-end crashes. When approaching a
vehicle ahead too quickly, FCA provides a
red flashing alert on the windshield and
rapidly beeps. FCA also lights an amber
visual alert if following another vehicle
much too closely.
Warning (Continued)
too closely, FCA may not provide a
warning with enough time to help avoid
a crash. It also may not provide any
warning at all. FCA does not warn of
pedestrians, animals, signs, guardrails,
bridges, construction barrels, or other
objects. Be ready to take action and
apply the brakes. See Defensive Driving
0 123.
FCA can be disabled through vehicle
personalization. See Vehicle Personalization
0 88.
Detecting the Vehicle Ahead
FCA detects vehicles within a distance of
approximately 60 m (197 ft) and operates at
speeds above 8 km/h (5 mph).
{ Warning
FCA is a warning system and does not
apply the brakes. When approaching a
slower-moving or stopped vehicle ahead
too rapidly, or when following a vehicle
(Continued)
vehicle ahead is partially blocked by
pedestrians or other objects. FCA will not
detect another vehicle ahead until it is
completely in the driving lane.
{ Warning
FCA does not provide a warning to help
avoid a crash, unless it detects a vehicle.
FCA may not detect a vehicle ahead if
the FCA sensor is blocked by dirt, snow,
or ice, or if the windshield is damaged.
It may also not detect a vehicle on
winding or hilly roads, or in conditions
that can limit visibility such as fog, rain,
or snow, or if the headlamps or
windshield are not cleaned or in proper
condition. Keep the windshield,
headlamps, and FCA sensors clean and in
good repair.
Collision Alert
FCA warnings will not occur unless the FCA
system detects a vehicle ahead. When a
vehicle is detected, the vehicle ahead
indicator will display green. Vehicles may
not be detected on curves, highway exit
ramps, or hills, due to poor visibility; or if a
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
When your vehicle approaches another
detected vehicle too rapidly, the red FCA
display will flash on the windshield. Also,
eight rapid high-pitched beeps will sound
from the front. When this Collision Alert
occurs, the brake system may prepare for
driver braking to occur more rapidly which
can cause a brief, mild deceleration.
Continue to apply the brake pedal as the
driving situation dictates. Cruise control may
be disengaged when the Collision Alert
occurs.
presses will change this setting. The chosen
setting will remain until it is changed and
will affect the timing of both the Collision
Alert and the Tailgating Alert features. The
timing of both alerts will vary based on
vehicle speed. The faster the vehicle speed,
the farther away the alert will occur.
Consider traffic and weather conditions
when selecting the alert timing. The range
of selectable alert timings may not be
appropriate for all drivers and driving
conditions.
Tailgating Alert
Unnecessary Alerts
FCA may provide unnecessary alerts to
turning vehicles, vehicles in other lanes,
objects that are not vehicles, or shadows.
These alerts are normal operation and the
vehicle does not need service.
The vehicle ahead indicator will display
amber when you are following a detected
vehicle ahead much too closely.
Selecting the Alert Timing
The Collision Alert control is on the steering
wheel. Press [ to set the FCA timing to
Far, Medium, or Near. The first button press
shows the current setting on the Driver
Information Center (DIC). Additional button
Cleaning the System
If the FCA system does not seem to operate
properly, this may correct the issue:
. Clean the outside of the windshield in
front of the rearview mirror.
. Clean the entire front of the vehicle.
. Clean the headlamps.
153
Automatic Emergency
Braking (AEB)
If the vehicle has Forward Collision Alert
(FCA), it also has AEB. When the system
detects a vehicle ahead in your path that is
traveling in the same direction that you
may be about to crash into, it can
automatically brake the vehicle. This can
help avoid or lessen the severity of crashes
when driving in a forward gear. Depending
on the situation, the vehicle may
automatically brake moderately or hard. This
automatic emergency braking can only occur
if a vehicle is detected. This is shown by the
FCA vehicle ahead indicator being lit. See
Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System 0 152.
The system works when driving in a forward
gear between 8 km/h (5 mph) and 60 km/h
(37 mph). It can detect vehicles up to
approximately 60 m (197 ft).
{ Warning
AEB is an emergency crash preparation
feature and is not designed to avoid
crashes. Do not rely on AEB to brake the
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
154
Driving and Operating
Warning (Continued)
vehicle. AEB will not brake outside of its
operating speed range and only responds
to detected vehicles.
AEB may not:
. Detect a vehicle ahead on winding or
hilly roads.
. Detect all vehicles, especially vehicles
with a trailer, tractors, muddy
vehicles, etc.
. Detect a vehicle when weather limits
visibility, such as in fog, rain, or snow.
. Detect a vehicle ahead if it is partially
blocked by pedestrians or other
objects.
Complete attention is always required
while driving, and you should be ready to
take action and apply the brakes and/or
steer the vehicle to avoid crashes.
AEB may slow the vehicle to a stop to try to
avoid a potential crash.
A system unavailable message may
display if:
. The front of the vehicle or windshield is
not clean.
. Heavy rain or snow is interfering with
object detection.
. There is a problem with the StabiliTrak/
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system.
The AEB system does not need service.
{ Warning
AEB may automatically brake the vehicle
suddenly in situations where it is
unexpected and undesired. It could
respond to a turning vehicle ahead,
guardrails, signs, and other non-moving
objects. To override AEB, firmly press the
accelerator pedal, if it is safe to do so.
AEB can be disabled through vehicle
personalization. See “Collision/Detection
Systems” under Vehicle Personalization 0 88.
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
If equipped, LDW may help avoid crashes
due to unintentional lane departures. LDW
uses a camera sensor to detect the lane
markings at speeds of 56 km/h (35 mph) or
greater. It may provide an alert if the
vehicle is crossing a lane without using a
turn signal in that direction. LDW light will
not alert if the turn signal is active in the
direction of lane departure, or if LDW
detects that you are accelerating, braking or
actively steering.
{ Warning
The LDW system does not steer the
vehicle. The LDW system may not:
. Provide enough time to avoid a crash.
. Detect lane markings under poor
weather or visibility conditions. This
can occur if the windshield or
headlamps are blocked by dirt, snow,
or ice; if they are not in proper
condition; or if the sun shines directly
into the camera.
. Detect road edges.
. Detect lanes on winding or hilly roads.
If LDW only detects lane markings on one
side of the road, it will only warn you
when departing the lane on the side
where it has detected a lane marking.
Always keep your attention on the road
and maintain proper vehicle position
within the lane, or vehicle damage,
injury, or death could occur. Always keep
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Warning (Continued)
the windshield, headlamps, and camera
sensors clean and in good repair. Do not
use LDW in bad weather conditions.
How the System Works
LDW utilizes camera sensor installed on the
windshield ahead of the rearview mirror to
detect lane markings. To turn LDW on and
off, press @ on the instrument panel to the
left of the steering wheel. The control
indicator will light when LDW is on. When
LDW is on, @ is green if LDW is available to
warn of a lane departure. If the vehicle
crosses a detected lane marking without
using the turn signal in that direction, @
changes to amber and flashes.
Additionally, there will be three beeps on
the right or left, depending on the lane
departure direction.
LDW will not alert if the turn signal is active
in the direction of lane departure, or if LDW
detects that you are accelerating, braking or
actively steering.
155
Recommended Fuel
Fuel
Top Tier Fuel
GM recommends the use of TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline to keep the engine clean,
reduce engine deposits, and maintain
optimal vehicle performance. Look for the
TOP TIER Logo or see www.toptiergas.com
for a list of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
marketers and applicable countries.
Regular unleaded gasoline meeting ASTM
specification D4814 with a posted octane
rating (R+M)/2 of 87 or greater is
recommended. Do not use gasoline with a
posted octane rating of less than 87, as this
will result in reduced performance and
driveability. If heavy knocking is heard when
using gasoline rated at 87 or greater, the
engine needs service.
Do not use any fuel labeled E85 or FlexFuel.
Do not use gasoline with ethanol levels
greater than 15% by volume.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
156
Driving and Operating
Prohibited Fuels
Caution
Do not use fuels with any of the
following conditions; doing so may
damage the vehicle and void its
warranty:
. For vehicles that are not FlexFuel, fuel
labeled greater than 15% ethanol by
volume, such as mid-level ethanol
blends (16–50% ethanol), E85,
or FlexFuel.
. Fuel with any amount of methanol,
methylal, ferrocene, and aniline. These
fuels can corrode metal fuel system
parts or damage plastic and rubber
parts.
. Fuel containing metals such as
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese
tricarbonyl (MMT), which can damage
the emissions control system and
spark plugs.
. Fuel with a posted octane rating of
less than the recommended fuel. Using
this fuel will lower fuel economy and
performance, and may decrease the
life of the emissions catalyst.
Fuels in Foreign Countries
The U.S., Canada, and Mexico post fuel
octane ratings in anti-knock index (AKI). For
fuel not to use in a foreign country, see
Prohibited Fuels 0 156.
Fuel Additives
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is highly
recommended for use with your vehicle.
If your country does not have TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline, add ACDelco Fuel
System Treatment Plus−Gasoline to the
vehicle’s gasoline fuel tank at every oil
change or 15 000 km (9,000 mi), whichever
occurs first. TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline and
ACDelco Fuel System Treatment Plus
−Gasoline will help keep your vehicle’s
engine fuel deposit free and performing
optimally.
Filling the Tank
An arrow on the fuel gauge indicates which
side of the vehicle the fuel door is on. See
Fuel Gauge 0 72.
{ Warning
Fuel vapors and fuel fires burn violently
and can cause injury or death.
Follow these guidelines to help avoid
injuries to you and others:
. Read and follow all the instructions on
the fuel pump island.
. Turn off the engine when refueling.
. Keep sparks, flames, and smoking
materials away from fuel.
. Do not leave the fuel pump
unattended.
. Avoid using electronic devices while
refueling.
. Do not re-enter the vehicle while
pumping fuel.
. Keep children away from the fuel
pump and never let children
pump fuel.
. Before touching the fill nozzle, touch a
metallic object to discharge static
electricity from your body.
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Driving and Operating
Warning (Continued)
. Fuel can spray out if the fuel cap is
To open the fuel door, lift the fuel door
release lever. The lever is on the floor, on
the left front side of the driver seat.
opened too quickly. This spray can
happen if the tank is nearly full, and is
more likely in hot weather. Open the
fuel cap slowly and wait for any hiss
noise to stop, then unscrew the cap all
the way.
The fuel door unlocks when the vehicle
doors are unlocked. See Remote Keyless
Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access)
0 9 or
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation (Keyless Access) 0 11.
157
Be careful not to spill fuel. Wait five seconds
after you have finished pumping before
removing the fill nozzle. Clean fuel from
painted surfaces as soon as possible. See
Exterior Care 0 216. Reinstall the cap by
turning it clockwise until it clicks. Push the
fuel door closed until it latches.
{ Warning
Turn the fuel cap counterclockwise to
remove. When refueling, hang the fuel cap
from the hook on the fuel door. Fully insert
and latch the fill nozzle, begin fueling.
{ Warning
Overfilling the fuel tank by more than
three clicks of a standard fill nozzle may
cause:
. Vehicle performance issues, including
engine stalling and damage to the fuel
system.
. Fuel spills.
. Under certain conditions, fuel fires.
If a fire starts while you are refueling, do
not remove the fill nozzle. Shut off the
flow of fuel by shutting off the pump or
by notifying the station attendant. Leave
the area immediately.
Caution
If a new fuel cap is needed, get the right
type of cap from your dealer. The wrong
type of fuel cap may not fit properly,
may turn on the malfunction indicator
lamp, and could damage the fuel system
and emissions system. See Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (Check Engine Light) 0 75.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
158
Driving and Operating
Filling a Portable Fuel Container
{ Warning
Never fill a portable fuel container while
it is in the vehicle. Static electricity
discharge from the container can ignite
the fuel vapor. You or others could be
badly burned and the vehicle could be
damaged. To help avoid injury to you
and others:
. Dispense fuel only into approved
.
.
.
.
containers.
Do not fill a container while it is
inside a vehicle, in a vehicle's trunk, in
a pickup bed, or on any surface other
than the ground.
Bring the fill nozzle in contact with
the inside of the fill opening before
operating the nozzle. Maintain contact
until filling is complete.
Keep sparks, flames, and smoking
materials away from fuel.
Avoid using electronic devices while
pumping fuel.
Trailer Towing
General Towing Information
{ Warning
Never tow a trailer with your vehicle.
It was not designed or intended to tow a
trailer.
Conversions and Add-Ons
Add-On Electrical Equipment
{ Warning
The Data Link Connector (DLC) is used for
vehicle service and Emission Inspection/
Maintenance testing. See Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (Check Engine Light) 0 75.
A device connected to the DLC — such as
an aftermarket fleet or driver-behavior
tracking device — may interfere with
vehicle systems. This could affect vehicle
operation and cause a crash. Such devices
may also access information stored in the
vehicle’s systems.
Caution
Some electrical equipment can damage
the vehicle or cause components to not
work and would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty. Always check with your
dealer before adding electrical equipment.
Add-on equipment can drain the vehicle's
12-volt battery, even if the vehicle is not
operating.
The vehicle has an airbag system. Before
attempting to add anything electrical to the
vehicle, see Servicing the Airbag-Equipped
Vehicle 0 45 and
Adding Equipment to the Airbag-Equipped
Vehicle 0 46.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Vehicle Care
General Information
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
California Perchlorate Materials
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . 160
Vehicle Checks
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . 160
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Engine Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . 163
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Automatic Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . 167
Manual Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Hydraulic Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Battery - North America . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock
Control Function Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Ignition Transmission Lock Check . . . . . . 176
Park Brake and P (Park) Mechanism
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Windshield Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Gas Strut(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Headlamp Aiming
Front Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Bulb Replacement
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
High Intensity Discharge (HID)
Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
LED Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal,
Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps . . . . . . 180
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps, and
Back-Up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Electrical System
Electrical System Overload . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . 185
Instrument Panel Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Wheels and Tires
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
All-Season Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Tire Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Tire Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . 192
159
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Tire Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . 195
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . 196
Tire Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Tire Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . 200
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Different Size Tires and Wheels . . . . . . . 202
Wheel Covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . 202
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . 203
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Tire Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Jump Starting
Jump Starting - North America . . . . . . . . 210
Towing the Vehicle
Towing the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Appearance Care
Exterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
160
Vehicle Care
General Information
For service and parts needs, visit your
dealer. You will receive genuine GM parts
and GM-trained and supported service
people.
Genuine GM parts have one of these marks:
special handling may apply. See
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/
perchlorate.
Accessories and Modifications
Adding non-dealer accessories or making
modifications to the vehicle can affect
vehicle performance and safety, including
such things as airbags, braking, stability,
ride and handling, emissions systems,
aerodynamics, durability, and electronic
systems like antilock brakes, traction control,
and stability control. These accessories or
modifications could even cause malfunction
or damage not covered by the vehicle
warranty.
Damage to suspension components caused
by modifying vehicle height outside of
factory settings will not be covered by the
vehicle warranty.
California Perchlorate Materials
Requirements
Certain types of automotive applications,
such as airbag initiators, seat belt
pretensioners, and lithium batteries
contained in electronic keys, may contain
perchlorate materials. Perchlorate Material –
Damage to vehicle components resulting
from modifications or the installation or use
of non-GM certified parts, including control
module or software modifications, is not
covered under the terms of the vehicle
warranty and may affect remaining
warranty coverage for affected parts.
GM Accessories are designed to complement
and function with other systems on the
vehicle. See your dealer to accessorize the
vehicle using genuine GM Accessories
installed by a dealer technician.
Also, see Adding Equipment to the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle 0 46.
Vehicle Checks
Doing Your Own Service Work
{ Warning
It can be dangerous to work on your
vehicle if you do not have the proper
knowledge, service manual, tools,
or parts. Always follow owner’s manual
procedures and consult the service
manual for your vehicle before doing any
service work.
If doing some of your own service work, use
the proper service manual. It tells you much
more about how to service the vehicle than
this manual can. To order the proper service
manual, see Publication Ordering
Information 0 248.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
This vehicle has an airbag system. Before
attempting to do your own service work,
see Servicing the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle
0 45.
Keep a record with all parts receipts and list
the mileage and the date of any service
work performed. See Maintenance Records
0 236.
Caution
Even small amounts of contamination can
cause damage to vehicle systems. Do not
allow contaminants to contact the fluids,
reservoir caps, or dipsticks.
Hood
{ Warning
Turn the vehicle off before opening the
hood. If the engine is running with the
hood open, you or others could be
injured.
{ Warning
Components under the hood can get hot
from running the engine. To help avoid
the risk of burning unprotected skin,
never touch these components until they
have cooled, and always use a glove or
towel to avoid direct skin contact.
161
2. Go to the front of the vehicle and locate
the secondary release lever under the
front center of the hood. Push the
secondary hood release lever to the right
to release.
Clear any snow from the hood before
opening.
To open the hood:
1. Pull the hood release lever with the
i symbol. It is on the lower left side
of the instrument panel.
3. Lift the hood and release the hood prop
rod from its retainer, in the front of the
engine compartment. Securely insert the
rod end into the slot marked with an
arrow, on the underside of the hood.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
162
Vehicle Care
To close the hood:
1. Before closing the hood, be sure all filler
caps are on properly, and all tools are
removed.
2. Lift the hood and remove the hood prop
rod from the underside of the hood.
Return the prop rod to its retainer. The
prop rod must click into place when
returning ti to the retainer to prevent
hood damage.
3. Lower the hood 20 cm (8 in) above the
vehicle and release it. Check to make
sure the hood is latched completely.
Repeat this process with additional force
if necessary.
{ Warning
Do not drive the vehicle if the hood is
not latched completely. The hood could
open fully, block your vision, and cause a
crash. You or others could be injured.
Always close the hood completely before
driving.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Engine Compartment Overview
163
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
164
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Vehicle Care
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter 0 167.
Engine Oil Fill Cap. See Engine Oil 0 164.
Engine Oil Dipstick. See Engine Oil 0 164.
Engine Cooling Fan (Out of View). See
Cooling System 0 168.
Brake/Clutch Fluid Reservoir. See Brake
Fluid 0 174 and
Hydraulic Clutch 0 167.
Engine Coolant Surge Tank and Pressure
Cap. See Cooling System 0 168.
Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See
Washer Fluid 0 172.
Battery - North America 0 175.
Engine Compartment Fuse Block 0 185.
Engine Oil
To ensure proper engine performance and
long life, careful attention must be paid to
engine oil. Following these simple, but
important steps will help protect your
investment:
. Use engine oil approved to the proper
specification and of the proper viscosity
grade. See “Selecting the Right Engine
Oil” in this section.
. Check the engine oil level regularly and
maintain the proper oil level. See
“Checking Engine Oil” and “When to Add
Engine Oil” in this section.
. Change the engine oil at the appropriate
time. See Engine Oil Life System 0 166.
. Always dispose of engine oil properly. See
“What to Do with Used Oil” in this
section.
Checking Engine Oil
Check the engine oil level regularly, every
650 km (400 mi), especially prior to a long
trip. The engine oil dipstick handle is a loop.
See Engine Compartment Overview 0 163 for
the location.
oil level on steep grades or too soon after
engine shutoff can result in incorrect
readings. Accuracy improves when
checking a cold engine prior to starting.
Remove the dipstick and check the level.
. If unable to wait two hours, the engine
must be off for at least 15 minutes if the
engine is warm, or at least 30 minutes if
the engine is not warm. Pull out the
dipstick, wipe it with a clean paper towel
or cloth, then push it back in all the way.
Remove it again, keeping the tip down,
and check the level.
When to Add Engine Oil
{ Warning
The engine oil dipstick handle may be
hot; it could burn you. Use a towel or
glove to touch the dipstick handle.
If a low oil Driver Information Center (DIC)
message displays, check the oil level.
Follow these guidelines:
. To get an accurate reading, park the
vehicle on level ground. Check the engine
oil level after the engine has been off for
at least two hours. Checking the engine
If the oil is below the cross-hatched area at
the tip of the dipstick and the engine has
been off for at least 15 minutes, add 1 L
(1 qt) of the recommended oil and then
recheck the level. See “Selecting the Right
Engine Oil” later in this section for an
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
explanation of what kind of oil to use. For
engine oil crankcase capacity, see Capacities
and Specifications 0 238.
Caution
Do not add too much oil. Oil levels above
or below the acceptable operating range
shown on the dipstick are harmful to the
engine. If the oil level is above the
operating range (i.e., the engine has so
much oil that the oil level gets above the
cross-hatched area that shows the proper
operating range), the engine could be
damaged. Drain the excess oil or limit
driving of the vehicle, and seek a service
professional to remove the excess oil.
See Engine Compartment Overview 0 163 for
the location of the engine oil fill cap.
Add enough oil to put the level somewhere
in the proper operating range, between the
cross-hatched areas. Push the dipstick all the
way back in when through.
Selecting the Right Engine Oil
Selecting the right engine oil depends on
both the proper oil specification and
viscosity grade. See Recommended Fluids
and Lubricants 0 234.
165
Specification
Engine Oil Additives/Engine Oil Flushes
Use full synthetic engine oils that meet the
dexos1 specification.
Do not add anything to the oil. The
recommended oils meeting the dexos1
specification are all that is needed for good
performance and engine protection.
Engine oils that have been approved by GM
as meeting the dexos1 specification are
marked with the dexos1 approved logo. See
www.gmdexos.com.
Engine oil system flushes are not
recommended and could cause engine
damage not covered by the vehicle
warranty.
What to Do with Used Oil
Caution
Failure to use the recommended engine
oil or equivalent can result in engine
damage not covered by the vehicle
warranty.
Viscosity Grade
Use SAE 0W-20 viscosity grade engine oil.
When selecting an oil of the appropriate
viscosity grade, it is recommended to select
an oil of the correct specification. See
“Specification” earlier in this section.
Used engine oil contains certain elements
that can be unhealthy for your skin and
could even cause cancer. Do not let used oil
stay on your skin for very long. Clean your
skin and nails with soap and water, or a
good hand cleaner. Wash or properly
dispose of clothing or rags containing used
engine oil. See the manufacturer's warnings
about the use and disposal of oil products.
Used oil can be a threat to the environment.
If you change your own oil, be sure to drain
all the oil from the filter before disposal.
Never dispose of oil by putting it in the
trash or pouring it on the ground, into
sewers, or into streams or bodies of water.
Recycle it by taking it to a place that
collects used oil.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
166
Vehicle Care
Engine Oil Life System
When to Change Engine Oil
This vehicle has a computer system that
indicates when to change the engine oil and
filter. This is based on a combination of
factors which include engine revolutions,
engine temperature, and miles driven. Based
on driving conditions, the mileage at which
an oil change is indicated can vary
considerably. For the oil life system to work
properly, the system must be reset every
time the oil is changed.
When the system has calculated that oil life
has been diminished, it indicates that an oil
change is necessary. A : % CHANGE DIC
message comes on. Change the oil as soon
as possible within the next 1 000 km
(600 mi). It is possible that, if driving under
the best conditions, the oil life system may
indicate that an oil change is not necessary
for up to a year. The engine oil and filter
must be changed at least once a year and,
at this time, the system must be reset. Your
dealer has trained service people who will
perform this work and reset the system.
It is also important to check the oil regularly
over the course of an oil drain interval and
keep it at the proper level.
If the system is ever reset accidentally, the
oil must be changed at 5 000 km (3,000 mi)
since the last oil change. Remember to reset
the oil life system whenever the oil is
changed.
How to Reset the Engine Oil Life System
Reset the system whenever the engine oil is
changed so that the system can calculate
the next engine oil change. Always reset the
engine oil life to 100% after every oil
change. It will not reset itself. To reset the
system:
Base Level Cluster
1. Press MENU on the turn signal lever to
show Remaining Oil Life on the display.
This display shows an estimate of the
oil’s remaining useful life. If 99% is
displayed, that means that 99% of the
current oil life remains.
2. To reset the engine oil life system, press
SET/CLR while the oil life display is
active. After a few seconds, the oil life
will be reset to 100%. Be careful not to
reset the oil life display accidentally at
any time other than after the oil is
changed. It cannot be reset accurately.
If the : % CHANGE message in the DIC
comes back on when the vehicle is started,
the engine oil life system has not reset.
Repeat the procedure.
Uplevel Cluster
1. Turn the ignition on with the engine off.
2. Press MENU on the turn signal lever to
enter the Vehicle Information Menu. Use
the thumbwheel to scroll through the
menu items until you reach REMAINING
OIL LIFE.
3. Press SET/CLR to reset the oil life
at 100%.
4. Turn the ignition off.
The oil life system can also be reset as
follows:
1. Turn the ignition on with the engine off.
2. Fully press and release the accelerator
pedal three times within five seconds.
The system is reset when the CHANGE
ENGINE OIL SOON message is off and the
REMAINING OIL LIFE 100% message is
displayed. If the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON
message comes back on when the vehicle is
started, the engine oil life system has not
been reset. Repeat the procedure.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Automatic Transmission Fluid
How to Check Automatic Transmission
Fluid
It is not necessary to check the transmission
fluid level. A transmission fluid leak is the
only reason for fluid loss. If a leak occurs,
take the vehicle to the dealer and have it
repaired as soon as possible.
The vehicle is not equipped with a
transmission fluid level dipstick. There is a
special procedure for checking and changing
the transmission fluid. Because this
procedure is difficult, this should be done at
the dealer. Contact the dealer for additional
information or the procedure can be found
in the service manual. To purchase a service
manual, see Publication Ordering
Information 0 248.
Caution
Use of the incorrect automatic
transmission fluid may damage the
vehicle, and the damage may not be
covered by the vehicle warranty. Always
use the correct automatic transmission
fluid. See Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants 0 234.
167
Manual Transmission Fluid
The brake/hydraulic clutch fluid reservoir cap
has this symbol on it. The common brake/
clutch fluid reservoir is filled with DOT 4
brake fluid as indicated on the reservoir cap.
See Engine Compartment Overview 0 163 for
reservoir location.
How to Check Manual Transmission Fluid
How to Check and Add Fluid
It is not necessary to check the manual
transmission fluid level. A transmission fluid
leak is the only reason for fluid loss. If a
leak occurs, take the vehicle to your dealer
and have it repaired as soon as possible.
Visually check the brake/clutch fluid
reservoir to make sure the fluid level is at
the MIN (minimum) line on the side of the
reservoir. The brake/hydraulic clutch fluid
system should be closed and sealed.
Hydraulic Clutch
Do not remove the cap to check the fluid
level or to top off the fluid level. Remove
the cap only when necessary to add the
proper fluid until the level reaches the
MIN line.
Change the fluid and filter at the proper
intervals. See Maintenance Schedule 0 226.
Be sure to use the correct fluid. See
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 234.
For vehicles with a manual transmission, it
is not necessary to regularly check brake/
clutch fluid unless there is a leak suspected.
Adding fluid will not correct a leak. A fluid
loss in this system could indicate a problem.
Have the system inspected and repaired.
When to Check and What to Use
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter
The engine air cleaner/filter is in the engine
compartment on the passenger side of the
vehicle. See Engine Compartment Overview
0 163.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
168
Vehicle Care
When to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner/
Filter
To inspect or replace the air cleaner/filter:
See Maintenance Schedule 0 226 for
replacement intervals.
For intervals on changing and inspecting the
engine air filter, see Maintenance Schedule
0 226.
{ Warning
How to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner/
Filter
Do not start the engine or have the engine
running with the engine air cleaner/filter
housing open. Before removing the engine
cleaner/filter, make sure that the engine air
cleaner/filter housing and nearby
components are free of dirt and debris.
Remove the engine air cleaner/filter. Lightly
tap and shake the engine air cleaner/filter
(away from the vehicle), to release loose
dust and dirt. Inspect the engine air cleaner/
filter for damage, and replace if damaged.
Do not clean the engine air cleaner/filter or
components with water or compressed air.
3. Lower the cover and secure with the two
screws.
1. Remove the two screws and lift the
cover out of the assembly.
{ Warning
If part replacement is necessary, the part
must be replaced with one of the same
part number or with an equivalent part.
Use of a replacement part without the
same fit, form, and function may result
in personal injury or damage to the
vehicle.
2. Inspect or replace the engine air cleaner/
filter.
Operating the engine with the air
cleaner/filter off can cause you or others
to be burned. Use caution when working
on the engine. Do not start the engine or
drive the vehicle with the air cleaner/
filter off, as flames may be present if the
engine backfires.
Caution
If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt can
easily get into the engine, which could
damage it. Always have the air cleaner/
filter in place when driving.
Cooling System
The cooling system allows the engine to
maintain the correct working temperature.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
{ Warning
Warning (Continued)
Do not touch heater or radiator hoses,
or other engine parts. They can be very
hot and can burn you. Do not run the
engine if there is a leak; all coolant could
leak out. That could cause an engine fire
and can burn you. Fix any leak before
driving the vehicle.
the wrong mixture, the engine could get
too hot but there would not be an
overheat warning. The engine could catch
fire and you or others could be burned.
Engine Coolant
1. Engine Cooling Fan (Out of View)
2. Engine Coolant Surge Tank and
Pressure Cap
{ Warning
An underhood electric fan can start up
even when the engine is not running and
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing,
and tools away from any underhood
electric fan.
169
The cooling system in the vehicle is filled
with DEX-COOL engine coolant. This coolant
is designed to remain in the vehicle for
5 years or 240 000 km (150,000 mi),
whichever occurs first.
The following explains the cooling system
and how to check and add coolant when it
is low. If there is a problem with engine
overheating, see Engine Overheating 0 171.
What to Use
{ Warning
Plain water, or other liquids such as
alcohol, can boil before the proper
coolant mixture will. With plain water or
(Continued)
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean drinkable
water and DEX-COOL coolant. This mixture:
. Gives freezing protection down to −37 °C
(−34 °F), outside temperature
. Gives boiling protection up to 129 °C
(265 °F), engine temperature
. Protects against rust and corrosion
. Will not damage aluminum parts
. Helps keep the proper engine
temperature
Caution
Do not use anything other than a mix of
DEX-COOL coolant that meets GM
Standard GMW3420 and clean, drinkable
water. Anything else can cause damage
to the engine cooling system and the
vehicle, which would not be covered by
the vehicle warranty.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
170
Vehicle Care
Never dispose of engine coolant by putting
it in the trash, pouring it on the ground,
or into sewers, streams, or bodies of water.
Have the coolant changed by an authorized
service center, familiar with legal
requirements regarding used coolant
disposal. This will help protect the
environment and your health.
Check to see if coolant is visible in the
coolant surge tank. If the coolant inside the
coolant surge tank is boiling, do not do
anything else until it cools down. See Engine
Overheating 0 171.
Checking Coolant
The coolant surge tank is in the engine
compartment on the driver side of the
vehicle. See Engine Compartment Overview
0 163.
The vehicle must be on a level surface when
checking the coolant level.
How to Add Coolant to the Coolant
Surge Tank
It is normal to see coolant moving in the
upper coolant hose return line when the
engine is running.
If no problem is found, check to see if
coolant is visible in the coolant surge tank.
If coolant is visible but the coolant level is
not at the indicated level mark, add a
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and
DEX-COOL coolant. Be sure the cooling
system, including the coolant surge tank
pressure cap, is cool before you do it.
{ Warning
Spilling coolant on hot engine parts can
burn you. Coolant contains ethylene
glycol and it will burn if the engine parts
are hot enough.
{ Warning
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot
cooling system are under pressure.
Turning the pressure cap, even a little,
can cause them to come out at high
speed and you could be burned. Never
turn the cap when the cooling system,
including the pressure cap, is hot. Wait
for the cooling system and pressure cap
to cool.
{ Warning
Plain water, or other liquids such as
alcohol, can boil before the proper
coolant mixture will. With plain water or
the wrong mixture, the engine could get
too hot but there would not be an
overheat warning. The engine could catch
fire and you or others could be burned.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Caution
Failure to follow the specific coolant fill
procedure could cause the engine to
overheat and could cause system
damage. If coolant is not visible in the
surge tank, contact your dealer.
1. Remove the coolant surge tank pressure
cap when the cooling system, including
the coolant surge tank pressure cap and
upper radiator hose, is no longer hot.
Turn the pressure cap slowly
counterclockwise about one-quarter of a
turn. If you hear a hiss, wait for that to
stop. This will allow any pressure still
left to be vented out the discharge hose.
2. Keep turning the pressure cap slowly and
remove it.
3. Fill the coolant surge tank with the
proper mixture to the indicated
level mark.
4. With the coolant surge tank pressure cap
off, start the engine and let it run until
you can feel the upper radiator hose
getting hot. Watch out for the engine
cooling fan.
By this time, the coolant level inside the
coolant surge tank may be lower. If the
level is lower, add more of the proper
mixture to the coolant surge tank until
the level reaches the indicated
level mark.
5. Reinstall the pressure cap tightly.
6. Verify coolant level after the engine is
shut off and the coolant is cold.
If necessary, repeat coolant fill procedure
Steps 1–6.
If the coolant still is not at the proper
level when the system cools down again,
see your dealer.
Caution
If the pressure cap is not tightly installed,
coolant loss and engine damage may
occur. Be sure the cap is properly and
tightly secured.
171
Engine Overheating
The vehicle has an indicator to warn of the
engine overheating. See Engine Coolant
Temperature Warning Light 0 79.
If the decision is made not to lift the hood
when this warning appears, get service help
right away. See Roadside Assistance Program
0 244.
If the decision is made to lift the hood,
make sure the vehicle is parked on a level
surface.
Then check to see if the engine cooling fan
is running. If the engine is overheating, the
fan should be running. If it is not, do not
continue to run the engine. Have the vehicle
serviced.
Caution
Do not run the engine if there is a leak
in the engine cooling system. This can
cause a loss of all coolant and can
damage the system and vehicle. Have
any leaks fixed right away.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
172
Vehicle Care
If Steam Is Coming from the Engine
Compartment
{ Warning
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot
cooling system are under pressure.
Turning the pressure cap, even a little,
can cause them to come out at high
speed and you could be burned. Never
turn the cap when the cooling system,
including the pressure cap, is hot. Wait
for the cooling system and pressure cap
to cool.
If No Steam Is Coming from the Engine
Compartment
If an engine overheat warning is displayed
but no steam can be seen or heard, the
problem may not be too serious. Sometimes
the engine can get a little too hot when the
vehicle:
. Climbs a long hill on a hot day
. Stops after high-speed driving
. Idles for long periods in traffic
If the overheat warning is displayed with no
sign of steam:
1. Turn the air conditioning off.
2. Turn the heater on to the highest
temperature and to the highest fan
speed. Open the windows as necessary.
3. When it is safe to do so, pull off the
road, shift to P (Park) or N (Neutral) for
an automatic transmission or Neutral for
a manual transmission, and let the
engine idle.
If the overheat warning no longer displays,
the vehicle can be driven. Continue to drive
the vehicle slowly for about 10 minutes.
Keep a safe vehicle distance from the vehicle
in front. If the warning does not come back
on, continue to drive normally and have the
cooling system checked for proper fill and
function.
If the warning continues, pull over, stop, and
park the vehicle right away.
If there is no sign of steam, idle the engine
for three minutes while parked. If the
warning is still displayed, turn off the
engine until it cools down.
Washer Fluid
What to Use
When windshield washer fluid is needed, be
sure to read the manufacturer's instructions
before use. If operating the vehicle in an
area where the temperature may fall below
freezing, use a fluid that has sufficient
protection against freezing.
Adding Washer Fluid
Open the cap with the washer symbol on it.
Add washer fluid until the tank is full. See
Engine Compartment Overview 0 163 for
reservoir location.
Caution
. Do not use washer fluid that contains
any type of water repellent coating.
This can cause the wiper blades to
chatter or skip.
. Do not use engine coolant (antifreeze)
in the windshield washer. It can
damage the windshield washer system
and paint.
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Caution (Continued)
. Do not mix water with ready-to-use
washer fluid. Water can cause the
solution to freeze and damage the
washer fluid tank and other parts of
the washer system.
. When using concentrated washer fluid,
follow the manufacturer instructions
for adding water.
. Fill the washer fluid tank only
three-quarters full when it is very cold.
This allows for fluid expansion if
freezing occurs, which could damage
the tank if it is completely full.
Brakes
Disc brake linings have built-in wear
indicators that make a high-pitched warning
sound when the brake linings are worn and
new linings are needed. The sound can come
and go or can be heard all the time when
the vehicle is moving, except when applying
the brake pedal firmly.
{ Warning
The brake wear warning sound means
that soon the brakes will not work well.
That could lead to a crash. When the
brake wear warning sound is heard, have
the vehicle serviced.
Caution
Continuing to drive with worn-out brake
linings could result in costly brake
repairs.
Some driving conditions or climates can
cause a brake squeal when the brakes are
first applied, clearing up following several
applies. This does not mean something is
wrong with the brakes.
Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary
to help prevent brake pulsation. When tires
are rotated, inspect brake linings for wear
and evenly tighten wheel nuts in the proper
sequence to torque specifications. See
Capacities and Specifications 0 238.
173
Rear drum brakes do not have wear
indicators. Drum brakes have an inspection
hole to inspect lining wear during scheduled
maintenance. When the front brake linings
are replaced, have the rear brakes inspected.
If a rear brake rubbing noise is heard, have
the rear brake linings inspected
immediately. Rear brake drums should be
removed and inspected each time the tires
are removed for rotation or changing.
Brake pads should be replaced as complete
axle sets.
Brake Pedal Travel
See your dealer if the brake pedal does not
return to normal height, or if there is a
rapid increase in pedal travel. This could be
a sign that brake service may be required.
Replacing Brake System Parts
Always replace brake system parts with
new, approved replacement parts. If this is
not done, the brakes may not work
properly. The braking performance can
change in many ways if the wrong brake
parts are installed or if parts are improperly
installed.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
174
Vehicle Care
Brake Fluid
. A fluid leak in the brake/clutch hydraulic
system. Have the brake/clutch hydraulic
system fixed. With a leak, the brakes will
not work well.
Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap
and the area around the cap before
removing it.
The brake/clutch master cylinder reservoir is
filled with GM approved DOT 4 brake fluid
as indicated on the reservoir cap. See Engine
Compartment Overview 0 163 for the
location of the reservoir.
Checking Brake Fluid
Place the vehicle in P (Park) or Neutral with
the parking brake applied if equipped with a
manual transmission. On a level surface, the
brake fluid level should be between the
minimum and maximum marks on the brake
fluid reservoir.
There are only two reasons why the brake
fluid level in the reservoir may go down:
. Normal brake lining wear. When new
linings are installed, the fluid level goes
back up.
Do not top off the brake/clutch fluid. Adding
fluid does not correct a leak. If fluid is added
when the linings are worn, there will be too
much fluid when new brake linings are
installed. Add or remove fluid, as necessary,
only when work is done on the brake/clutch
hydraulic system.
{ Warning
If too much brake fluid is added, it can
spill on the engine and burn, if the
engine is hot enough. You or others could
be burned, and the vehicle could be
damaged. Add brake fluid only when
work is done on the brake/clutch
hydraulic system.
When the brake/clutch fluid falls to a low
level, the brake warning light comes on. See
Brake System Warning Light 0 76.
Brake fluid absorbs water over time which
degrades the effectiveness of the brake fluid.
Replace brake fluid at the specified intervals
to prevent increased stopping distance. See
Maintenance Schedule 0 226.
What to Add
Use only GM approved DOT 4 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed container. See
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 234.
{ Warning
The wrong or contaminated brake fluid
could result in damage to the brake
system. This could result in the loss of
braking leading to a possible injury.
Always use the proper GM approved
brake fluid.
Caution
If brake fluid is spilled on the vehicle's
painted surfaces, the paint finish can be
damaged. Immediately wash off any
painted surface.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Battery - North America
The original equipment battery is
maintenance free. Do not remove the cap
and do not add fluid.
Refer to the replacement number shown on
the original battery label when a new
battery is needed. See Engine Compartment
Overview 0 163 for battery location.
{ Warning
WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and
related accessories can expose you to
chemicals including lead and lead
compounds, which are known to the
State of California to cause cancer and
birth defects or other reproductive harm.
Wash hands after handling. For more
information go to
www.P65Warnings.ca.gov.
See the warning on the back cover.
Vehicle Storage
{ Warning
Batteries have acid that can burn you and
gas that can explode. You can be badly
hurt if you are not careful. See Jump
Starting - North America 0 210 for tips on
working around a battery without
getting hurt.
Infrequent Usage: Remove the black,
negative (−) cable from the battery to keep
the battery from running down.
175
Caution
If the battery is disconnected with the
ignition on or the vehicle in Retained
Accessory Power (RAP), the OnStar
back-up battery will be permanently
discharged and will need to be replaced.
1. Make sure the lamps, features, and
accessories are turned off.
2. Turn the ignition off and remove the
key, if equipped.
Extended Storage: Remove the black,
negative (−) cable from the battery or use a
battery trickle charger.
Negative Battery Cable Disconnection
{ Warning
Before disconnecting the negative battery
cable, turn off all features, turn the
ignition off, and remove the key,
if equipped, from the vehicle. If this is
not done, you or others could be injured,
and the vehicle could be damaged.
3. Loosen the negative battery cable nut (1).
4. Remove the negative battery cable (2)
from the battery.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
176
Vehicle Care
Negative Battery Cable Reconnection
Caution
When reconnecting the battery:
. Use the original nut from the vehicle
to secure the negative battery cable.
Do not use a different nut. If you
need a replacement nut, see your
dealer.
. Tighten the nut with a hand tool. Do
not use an impact wrench or power
tools to tighten the nut.
The vehicle could be damaged if these
guidelines are not followed.
Caution
Do not use paints, lubricants, or corrosion
inhibitors on the nut that secures the
negative battery cable to the vehicle. This
could damage the vehicle.
1. Install the negative battery cable (2) to
the battery.
2. Install the negative battery cable nut (1)
and tighten.
3. Turn the ignition on.
Starter Switch Check
{ Warning
When you are doing this inspection, the
vehicle could move suddenly. If the
vehicle moves, you or others could be
injured.
1. Before starting this check, be sure there
is enough room around the vehicle.
2. Apply both the parking brake and the
regular brake.
Do not use the accelerator pedal, and be
ready to turn off the engine immediately
if it starts.
3. Try to start the engine in each gear. The
vehicle should start only in P (Park) or
N (Neutral). If the vehicle starts in any
other position, contact your dealer for
service.
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock
Control Function Check
{ Warning
When you are doing this inspection, the
vehicle could move suddenly. If the
vehicle moves, you or others could be
injured.
1. Before starting this check, be sure there
is enough room around the vehicle.
It should be parked on a level surface.
2. Apply the parking brake. Be ready to
apply the regular brake immediately if
the vehicle begins to move.
3. With the engine off, turn the ignition on,
but do not start the engine. Without
applying the regular brake, try to move
the shift lever out of P (Park) with
normal effort. If the shift lever moves
out of P (Park), contact your dealer for
service.
Ignition Transmission Lock Check
If equipped with Key Access, while parked,
and with the parking brake set, try to turn
the ignition off in each shift lever position.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
. For automatic transmission vehicles, the
. To check the parking brake's holding
ignition should turn off only when the
shift lever is in P (Park).
. For manual transmission vehicles, the
ignition should turn off only when the
shift lever is in Neutral.
ability: With the engine running and the
transmission in N (Neutral), slowly remove
foot pressure from the regular brake
pedal. Do this until the vehicle is held by
the parking brake only.
. To check the P (Park) mechanism's holding
ability: With the engine running, shift to
P (Park). Then release the parking brake
followed by the regular brake.
On all Key Access vehicles, the ignition key
should come out only when the ignition
is off.
Contact your dealer if service is required.
Park Brake and P (Park)
Mechanism Check
{ Warning
When you are doing this check, the
vehicle could begin to move. You or
others could be injured and property
could be damaged. Make sure there is
room in front of the vehicle in case it
begins to roll. Be ready to apply the
regular brake at once should the vehicle
begin to move.
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the vehicle
facing downhill. Keeping your foot on the
regular brake, set the parking brake.
177
Caution (Continued)
covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not
allow the wiper arm to touch the
windshield.
To replace the windshield wiper blade:
1. Pull the windshield wiper assembly away
from the windshield.
Contact your dealer if service is required.
Wiper Blade Replacement
Windshield Wiper Blades
Windshield wiper blades should be inspected
for wear and cracking.
Replacement blades come in different types
and are removed in different ways. For
proper type and length, see Maintenance
Replacement Parts 0 235.
Caution
Allowing the wiper arm to touch the
windshield when no wiper blade is
installed could damage the windshield.
Any damage that occurs would not be
(Continued)
2. Press the release lever in the middle of
the wiper blade where the wiper blade
attaches.
3. Remove the wiper blade.
4. Reverse Steps 1–3 for wiper blade
replacement.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
178
Vehicle Care
Rear Wiper Blade
Windshield Replacement
Driver Assistance Systems
1. Lift the wiper arm away from the rear
windshield.
2. Push the wiper blade away from the
wiper arm.
3. Once the blade pin disengages from the
wiper arm, remove the wiper blade by
sliding the blade off the arm.
4. Reverse Steps 1–3 to install a new wiper
blade.
If the windshield needs to be replaced and
the vehicle is equipped with a front camera
sensor for the Driver Assistance Systems, a
GM replacement windshield is
recommended. The replacement windshield
must be installed according to GM
specifications for proper alignment. If it is
not, these systems may not work properly,
they may display messages, or they may
not work at all. See your dealer for proper
windshield replacement.
Gas Strut(s)
Warning (Continued)
damage periodically. Check to make sure
the hood/trunk/liftgate is held open with
enough force. If struts are failing to hold
the hood/trunk/liftgate, do not operate.
Have the vehicle serviced.
Caution
Do not apply tape or hang any objects
from gas struts. Also do not push down
or pull on gas struts. This may cause
damage to the vehicle.
See Maintenance Schedule 0 226.
This vehicle is equipped with gas strut(s) to
provide assistance in lifting and holding
open the hood/trunk/liftgate system in full
open position.
{ Warning
If the gas struts that hold open the hood,
trunk, and/or liftgate fail, you or others
could be seriously injured. Take the
vehicle to your dealer for service
immediately. Visually inspect the gas
struts for signs of wear, cracks, or other
(Continued)
Hood
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Headlamp Aiming
Front Headlamp Aiming
Headlamp aim has been preset and should
need no further adjustment.
If the vehicle is damaged in a crash, the
headlamp aim may be affected.
If adjustment to the headlamps is necessary,
see your dealer.
Trunk
Bulb Replacement
For the proper type of replacement bulbs,
or any bulb changing procedure not listed in
this section, contact your dealer.
Caution
Do not replace incandescent bulbs with
aftermarket LED replacement bulbs. This
can cause damage to the vehicle electrical
system.
Liftgate
179
Halogen Bulbs
{ Warning
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside
and can burst if you drop or scratch the
bulb. You or others could be injured. Be
sure to read and follow the instructions
on the bulb package.
High Intensity Discharge (HID)
Lighting
{ Warning
The High Intensity Discharge (HID)
lighting system operates at a very high
voltage. If you try to service any of the
system components, you could be
seriously injured. Have your dealer or a
qualified technician service them.
After an HID headlamp bulb has been
replaced, the beam might be a slightly
different shade than it was originally. This is
normal.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
180
Vehicle Care
LED Lighting
4. Turn the bulb counterclockwise and pull
straight back.
5. Disconnect the wiring harness connector
from the bulb.
6. Install the new bulb in the headlamp
assembly by turning clockwise.
7. Reconnect the wiring harness connector.
8. Install the bulb socket into the headlamp
assembly by turning clockwise.
This vehicle has several LED lamps. For
replacement of any LED lighting assembly,
contact your dealer.
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal,
Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps
Standard Headlamp
Sidemarker Lamps
2. Remove the washer funnel by turning it
counterclockwise and pulling it
straight out.
To replace a sidemarker bulb:
1. Open the hood. See Hood 0 161.
1. Sidemarker Lamp
2. Low/High-Beam Headlamp
3. Turn Signal Lamps
High/Low-Beam Headlamp
To replace a headlamp bulb:
1. Open the hood. See Hood 0 161.
3. Remove the headlamp bulb socket.
2. Remove the sidemarker lamp bulb socket
from the headlamp assembly by turning
counterclockwise.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
3. Remove the bulb from the bulb socket
by pulling it straight out.
4. Install the new bulb in the bulb socket.
5. Install the bulb socket into the headlamp
assembly by turning clockwise.
4. Install the new bulb into the socket by
pressing it in.
5. Install the bulb socket into the headlamp
assembly by turning clockwise.
Projection Headlamp
Front Turn Signal/Parking Lamps
To replace a front turn signal bulb:
1. Open the hood. See Hood 0 161.
2. For the driver side bulb, remove the
washer funnel by turning it
counterclockwise and pulling it
straight out.
1. Low-Beam Headlamp
2. High-Beam Headlamp
High/Low-Beam Headlamp
2. Remove the turn signal lamp bulb socket
from the headlamp assembly by turning
counterclockwise.
3. Remove the bulb from the bulb socket
by pulling it straight out.
To replace a headlamp bulb:
1. Open the hood. See Hood 0 161.
181
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
182
Vehicle Care
3. Remove the cover from the back of the
headlamp assembly by turning it
counterclockwise.
4. Disconnect the electrical connector.
5. Remove the bulb from the lamp
assembly by turning counterclockwise.
6. Replace the bulb and reverse Steps 1–5
to reinstall.
To replace a taillamp, turn signal lamp,
stoplamp, or back-up bulb:
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate 0 17.
7. Reinstall the lamp assembly and two
screws.
License Plate Lamp
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps,
and Back-Up Lamps
1. Stoplamp/Taillamp
2. Turn Signal Lamp/Taillamp
3. Back-up Lamp
2. Remove the two screws and the lamp
assembly.
3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise
and remove the socket.
4. Press the bulb in and turn
counterclockwise to remove it from the
socket.
5. Press the new bulb in and turn clockwise
to install the bulb into the socket.
6. Turn the bulb socket clockwise to
reinstall.
1. Attachment Screws
2. License Plate Bulb
3. Bulb Socket
To replace a license plate lamp bulb:
1. Remove the two screws (1) from the
license plate lamp assembly.
2. Turn and pull the license plate lamp
assembly down.
3. Turn the bulb socket (3) counterclockwise
and pull it out of the lamp assembly.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
4. Pull the bulb (2) straight out of the
socket.
5. Push the new bulb into the socket.
6. Install the bulb socket (3) by turning
clockwise into the license plate lamp
assembly.
7. Replace the license plate lamp assembly
by using the two screws to secure.
Electrical System
Electrical System Overload
The vehicle has fuses and circuit breakers to
protect against an electrical system
overload.
When the current electrical load is too
heavy, the circuit breaker opens and closes,
protecting the circuit until the current load
returns to normal or the problem is fixed.
This greatly reduces the chance of circuit
overload and fire caused by electrical
problems.
Fuses and circuit breakers protect power
devices in the vehicle.
If there is a problem on the road and a fuse
needs to be replaced, the same amperage
fuse can be borrowed. Choose some feature
of the vehicle that is not needed to use and
replace it as soon as possible.
To check a fuse, look at the band inside the
fuse. If the band is broken or melted,
replace the fuse. Be sure to replace a bad
fuse with a fuse of the identical size and
rating.
Replacing a Blown Fuse
1. Turn off the vehicle.
2. Locate the fuse puller in the engine
compartment fuse block.
183
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
184
Vehicle Care
3. Use the fuse puller to remove the fuse
from the top or side, as shown above.
4. If the fuse must be replaced
immediately, borrow a replacement fuse
with the same amperage from the fuse
block. Choose a vehicle feature that is
not needed to safely operate the vehicle.
Repeat Steps 2-3.
5. Insert the replacement fuse into the
empty slot of the blown fuse.
At the next opportunity, see your dealer to
replace the blown fuse.
Headlamp Wiring
An electrical overload may cause the lamps
to go on and off, or in some cases to
remain off. Have the headlamp wiring
checked right away if the lamps go on and
off or remain off.
Windshield Wipers
If the wiper motor overheats due to heavy
snow or ice, the windshield wipers will stop
until the motor cools and will then restart.
Although the circuit is protected from
electrical overload, overload due to heavy
snow or ice may cause wiper linkage
damage. Always clear ice and heavy snow
from the windshield before using the
windshield wipers.
If the overload is caused by an electrical
problem and not snow or ice, be sure to get
it fixed.
Fuses and Circuit Breakers
The wiring circuits in the vehicle are
protected from short circuits by a
combination of fuses and circuit breakers.
This greatly reduces the chance of damage
caused by electrical problems.
{ Danger
Fuses and circuit breakers are marked
with their ampere rating. Do not exceed
the specified amperage rating when
replacing fuses and circuit breakers. Use
of an oversized fuse or circuit breaker can
result in a vehicle fire. You and others
could be seriously injured or killed.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
185
Engine Compartment Fuse Block
{ Warning
Installation or use of fuses that do not
meet GM’s original fuse specifications is
dangerous. The fuses could fail, and result
in a fire. You or others could be injured
or killed, and the vehicle could be
damaged.
See Accessories and Modifications 0 160 and
General Information 0 160.
To check or replace a blown fuse, see
Electrical System Overload 0 183.
The engine compartment fuse block is on
the driver side of the vehicle, near the
battery.
Caution
Spilling liquid on any electrical
component on the vehicle may damage
it. Always keep the covers on any
electrical component.
To access the fuses, press the tab at the
front of the cover, and lift the cover.
The vehicle may not be equipped with all of
the fuses, relays, and features shown.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
186
Vehicle Care
Fuses
Usage
Fuses
Usage
Fuses
Usage
30
Headlamp Leveling
Motor
Engine Control Module 2
31
Horn
Injector/Ignition
32
Front Fog Lamps
Left High-Beam
Headlamp
1
Liftgate Latch
16
Fuel Pump Motor
2
Transmission Output
Speed Sensor
17
Engine Control Module 1
18
19
3
Rear Defogger
4
Outside Mirror Heater
20
A/C System
33
5
Sunroof
21
6
Continuously Variable
Transmission Control
Module
Intelligent Battery
Sensor
34
22
Electric Steering
Column Lock
Right High-Beam
Headlamp
35
Air Quality Ionizer
Mass Airflow Sensor
23
Cooling Fan – Low
36
Rear Wiper
Virtual Key Pass System
Sensor
37
Left Cornering Lamp
38
Washer Motor
Outside Mirror Motor
Control
39
Right Cornering Lamp
40
–
41
Virtual Key Pass System
Sensor
42
Starter 2
43
In-panel Bussed
Electrical Center
44
Automated Manual
Transmission
45
Starter 1
7
8
–
9
ABS Valve
10
Regulated Voltage
Control
25
11
Rear Vision Camera
26
12
–
Engine Control Module/
Transmission Control
Module Battery
27
Canister Vent Solenoid
28
–
29
Automatic Occupant
Sensing
13
–
14
Engine Control Module/
Transmission Control
Module
15
Fuel Injection Control
Module/Starter Motor
24
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Fuses
Usage
46
ABS Pump
47
Cooling Fan – High
48
Front Wiper Motor
49
Accessory/Retained
Accessory Power
Relays
187
Instrument Panel Fuse Block
Usage
RLY1
Rear Defogger
RLY2
Transmission Control
Module
RLY3
Fuel Pump Motor
RLY4
Starter 2
RLY5
A/C System
RLY6
–
RLY7
Cooling Fan – Low
RLY8
Run/Crank
RLY9
Powertrain
RLY10
Starter 1
RLY11
Cooling Fan – High
RLY12
Front Fog Lamps
The instrument panel fuse block is on the
underside of the driver side instrument
panel.
The vehicle may not be equipped with all of
the fuses, relays, and features shown.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
188
Vehicle Care
Fuses
ONSTAR
Usage
OnStar
HVAC CNTR/ECC HVAC Control Module/
Electronic Climate
Control
Fuses
Usage
PEPS
Passive Entry/Passive
Start
DLIS (Non
AT S&S)
Discrete Logic Ignition
Switch (Non-CVT Stop
and Start)
IPC
Instrument Cluster
TCM
Transmission Control
Module
FCA
Forward Collision Alert
IPC
Instrument Cluster
Radio
RLAD
Reflected LED Alert
Display
HLLD SW
Headlamp Leveling
Switch
RDO
BCM1 (AT S&S)
Body Control Module 1
(CVT Stop and Start)
SBSA/RPA
Side Blind Spot Alert/
Rear Park Assist
DLC
Data Link Connector
ESCL
Electric Steering
Column Lock
SDM
TRANSD
Sensing and Diagnostic
Module
DC-DC Converter
FRT PWR WNDW Front Power Window
REAR
PWR WNDW
–
MTA
APO
AQI
Virtual Key Pass System
Module
S/ROOF
ETCS
Electronic Toll Collection
System
–
LPM
Linear Power Module
CGM
BCM8
Fuses
Usage
BCM7
Body Control Module 7
BCM6
Body Control Module 6
BCM5
Body Control Module 5
BCM4
Body Control Module 4
BCM3
Body Control Module 3
BCM2 (Non
AT S&S)
Body Control Module 2
(Non-CVT Stop and
Start)
BCM1 (Non
AT S&S)
Body Control Module 1
(Non-CVT Stop and
Start)
DLIS (AT S&S)
Discrete Logic Ignition
Switch (CVT Stop and
Start)
Rear Power Window
–
Automated Manual
Transmission Module
Auxiliary Power Outlet
Sunroof
Central Gate Module
–
Body Control Module 8
SWC BKLT
–
TRANS (200/
400W)/
LOGISTICS
Steering Wheel Controls
Backlighting
–
DC DC Converter/
Logistics
EXP PWR WNDW Driver Express Power
Window
BLWR
Blower Motor
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Fuses
HTD/SEAT
HVAC CNTR
Usage
Front Heated Seats
.
HVAC Module
HTD/STR
Heated Steering Wheel
BCM2 (AT S&S)
Body Control Module 2
(CVT Stop and Start)
Relays
Usage
RLY1
Logistics
RLY2
Accessory/Retained
Accessory Power
RLY3
Interruptible Retained
Accessory Power
RLY4
Run
Wheels and Tires
.
.
.
Tires
Every new GM vehicle has high-quality
tires made by a leading tire
manufacturer. See the warranty manual
for information regarding the tire
warranty and where to get service. For
additional information refer to the tire
manufacturer.
.
{ Warning
Poorly maintained and improperly
used tires are dangerous.
Overloading the tires can cause
overheating as a result of too
much flexing. There could be a
blowout and a serious crash. See
Vehicle Load Limits 0 129.
Underinflated tires pose the same
danger as overloaded tires. The
resulting crash could cause serious
injury. Check all tires frequently to
maintain the recommended
pressure. Tire pressure should be
checked when the tires are cold.
Overinflated tires are more likely
to be cut, punctured, or broken by
a sudden impact — such as when
hitting a pothole. Keep tires at the
recommended pressure.
Worn or old tires can cause a
crash. If the tread is badly worn,
replace them.
(Continued)
189
Warning (Continued)
Replace any tires that have been
damaged by impacts with
potholes, curbs, etc.
. Improperly repaired tires can cause
a crash. Only your dealer or an
authorized tire service center
should repair, replace, dismount,
and mount the tires.
. Do not spin the tires in excess of
56 km/h (35 mph) on slippery
surfaces such as snow, mud, ice,
etc. Excessive spinning may cause
the tires to explode.
.
All-Season Tires
This vehicle may come with all-season tires.
These tires are designed to provide good
overall performance on most road surfaces
and weather conditions. Original equipment
tires designed to GM's specific tire
performance criteria have a TPC specification
code molded onto the sidewall. Original
equipment all-season tires can be identified
by the last two characters of this TPC code,
which will be “MS.”
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
190
Vehicle Care
Consider installing winter tires on the
vehicle if frequent driving on snow or
ice-covered roads is expected. All-season tires
provide adequate performance for most
winter driving conditions, but they may not
offer the same level of traction or
performance as winter tires on snow or
ice-covered roads. See Winter Tires 0 190.
Winter Tires
This vehicle was not originally equipped
with winter tires. Winter tires are designed
for increased traction on snow and
ice-covered roads. Consider installing winter
tires on the vehicle if frequent driving on ice
or snow covered roads is expected. See your
dealer for details regarding winter tire
availability and proper tire selection. Also,
see Buying New Tires 0 201.
. Use only radial ply tires of the same size,
load range, and speed rating as the
original equipment tires.
Winter tires with the same speed rating as
the original equipment tires may not be
available for H, V, W, Y, and ZR speed rated
tires. If winter tires with a lower speed
rating are chosen, never exceed the tire's
maximum speed capability.
Tire Sidewall Labeling
Useful information about a tire is
molded into its sidewall. The examples
show a typical passenger vehicle tire
and a compact spare tire sidewall.
With winter tires, there may be decreased
dry road traction, increased road noise, and
shorter tread life. After changing to winter
tires, be alert for changes in vehicle
handling and braking.
(1) Tire Size : The tire size is a
combination of letters and numbers
used to define a particular tire's width,
height, aspect ratio, construction type,
and service description. See the “Tire
Size” illustration in this section.
(2) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria
Specification) : Original equipment tires
designed to GM's specific tire
performance criteria have a TPC
specification code molded onto the
sidewall. GM's TPC specifications meet
or exceed all federal safety guidelines.
(3) DOT (Department of
Transportation) : The Department of
Transportation (DOT) code indicates that
the tire is in compliance with the U.S.
Department of Transportation Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards.
DOT Tire Date of Manufacture : The last
four digits of the TIN indicate the tire
manufactured date. The first two digits
represent the week and the last two
digits, the year. For example, the third
week of the year 2020 would have a
If using winter tires:
. Use tires of the same brand and tread
type on all four wheel positions.
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire Example
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
4-digit DOT date of 0320. Week 01 is
the first full week (Sunday through
Saturday) of each year.
(4) Tire Identification Number (TIN) :
The letters and numbers following the
DOT (Department of Transportation)
code are the Tire Identification Number
(TIN). The TIN shows the manufacturer
and plant code, tire size, and date the
tire was manufactured. The TIN is
molded onto both sides of the tire,
although only one side may have the
date of manufacture.
(5) Tire Ply Material : The type of cord
and number of plies in the sidewall and
under the tread.
(6) Uniform Tire Quality Grading
(UTQG) : Tire manufacturers are
required to grade tires based on three
performance factors: tread wear,
traction, and temperature resistance.
For more information see Uniform Tire
Quality Grading 0 202.
(7) Maximum Cold Inflation Load
Limit : Maximum load that can be
carried and the maximum pressure
needed to support that load.
191
emergency use when a regular road tire
has lost air and gone flat. If the vehicle
has a compact spare tire, see Compact
Spare Tire 0 209 and
If a Tire Goes Flat 0 204.
(3) Tire Identification Number (TIN) :
The letters and numbers following the
DOT (Department of Transportation)
code are the Tire Identification Number
(TIN). The TIN shows the manufacturer
and plant code, tire size, and date the
tire was manufactured. The TIN is
molded onto both sides of the tire,
although only one side may have the
date of manufacture.
Compact Spare Tire Example
(1) Tire Ply Material : The type of cord
and number of plies in the sidewall and
under the tread.
(2) Temporary Use Only : The compact
spare tire or temporary use tire should
not be driven at speeds over 80 km/h
(50 mph). The compact spare tire is for
(4) Maximum Cold Inflation Load
Limit : Maximum load that can be
carried and the maximum pressure
needed to support that load.
(5) Tire Inflation : The temporary use
tire or compact spare tire should be
inflated to 420 kPa (60 psi). For more
information on tire pressure and
inflation see Tire Pressure 0 194.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
192
Vehicle Care
(6) Tire Size : A combination of letters
and numbers define a tire's width,
height, aspect ratio, construction type,
and service description. The letter “T” as
the first character in the tire size means
the tire is for temporary use only.
(7) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria
Specification) : Original equipment tires
designed to GM's specific tire
performance criteria have a TPC
specification code molded onto the
sidewall. GM's TPC specifications meet
or exceed all federal safety guidelines.
Tire Designations
Tire Size
The example shows a typical passenger
vehicle tire size.
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire
(1) Passenger (P-Metric) Tire : The
United States version of a metric tire
sizing system. The letter "P" as the first
character in the tire size means a
passenger vehicle tire engineered to
standards set by the U.S. Tire and Rim
Association.
(6) Service Description : These
characters represent the load index and
speed rating of the tire. The load index
represents the load carrying capacity a
tire is certified to carry. The speed
rating is the maximum speed a tire is
certified to carry a load.
(2) Tire Width : The 3-digit number
indicates the tire section width in
millimeters from sidewall to sidewall.
Tire Terminology and Definitions
(3) Aspect Ratio : A 2-digit number that
indicates the tire height-to-width
measurements. For example, if the tire
size aspect ratio is 75, as shown in
item (3) of the illustration, it would
mean that the tire's sidewall is
75 percent as high as it is wide.
(4) Construction Code : A letter code is
used to indicate the type of ply
construction in the tire. The letter "R"
means radial ply construction; the letter
"D" means diagonal or bias ply
construction.
(5) Rim Diameter : Diameter of the
wheel in inches.
Air Pressure : The amount of air inside
the tire pressing outward on each
square inch of the tire. Air pressure is
expressed in kPa (kilopascal) or psi
(pounds per square inch).
Accessory Weight : The combined
weight of optional accessories. Some
examples of optional accessories are
automatic transmission, power
windows, power seats, and air
conditioning.
Aspect Ratio : The relationship of a
tire's height to its width.
Belt : A rubber coated layer of cords
between the plies and the tread. Cords
may be made from steel or other
reinforcing materials.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Bead : The tire bead contains steel
wires wrapped by steel cords that hold
the tire onto the rim.
designator which can also identify the
tire manufacturer, production plant,
brand, and date of production.
Bias Ply Tire : A pneumatic tire in which
the plies are laid at alternate angles
less than 90 degrees to the centerline
of the tread.
GVWR : Gross Vehicle Weight Rating.
See Vehicle Load Limits 0 129.
Cold Tire Pressure : The amount of air
pressure in a tire, measured in kPa
(kilopascal) or psi (pounds per square
inch) before a tire has built up heat
from driving. See Tire Pressure 0 194.
Curb Weight : The weight of a motor
vehicle with standard and optional
equipment including the maximum
capacity of fuel, oil, and coolant, but
without passengers and cargo.
DOT Markings : A code molded into the
sidewall of a tire signifying that the tire
is in compliance with the U.S.
Department of Transportation (DOT)
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. The
DOT code includes the Tire Identification
Number (TIN), an alphanumeric
GAWR FRT : Gross Axle Weight Rating
for the front axle. See Vehicle Load
Limits 0 129.
193
Maximum Inflation Pressure : The
maximum air pressure to which a cold
tire can be inflated. The maximum air
pressure is molded onto the sidewall.
Maximum Load Rating : The load rating
for a tire at the maximum permissible
inflation pressure for that tire.
GAWR RR : Gross Axle Weight Rating
for the rear axle. See Vehicle Load
Limits 0 129.
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight : The
sum of curb weight, accessory weight,
vehicle capacity weight, and production
options weight.
Intended Outboard Sidewall : The side
of an asymmetrical tire that must
always face outward when mounted on
a vehicle.
Normal Occupant Weight : The number
of occupants a vehicle is designed to
seat multiplied by 68 kg (150 lb). See
Vehicle Load Limits 0 129.
Kilopascal (kPa) : The metric unit for air
pressure.
Occupant Distribution : Designated
seating positions.
Light Truck (LT-Metric) Tire : A tire used
on light duty trucks and some
multipurpose passenger vehicles.
Outward Facing Sidewall : The side of
an asymmetrical tire that has a
particular side that faces outward when
mounted on a vehicle. The side of the
tire that contains a whitewall, bears
white lettering, or bears manufacturer,
brand, and/or model name molding
Load Index : An assigned number
ranging from 1 to 279 that corresponds
to the load carrying capacity of a tire.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
194
Vehicle Care
that is higher or deeper than the same
moldings on the other sidewall of
the tire.
Traction : The friction between the tire
and the road surface. The amount of
grip provided.
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire : A tire used
on passenger cars and some light duty
trucks and multipurpose vehicles.
Tread : The portion of a tire that comes
into contact with the road.
Recommended Inflation Pressure :
Vehicle manufacturer's recommended
tire inflation pressure as shown on the
tire placard. See Tire Pressure 0 194 and
Vehicle Load Limits 0 129.
Radial Ply Tire : A pneumatic tire in
which the ply cords that extend to the
beads are laid at 90 degrees to the
centerline of the tread.
Rim : A metal support for a tire and
upon which the tire beads are seated.
Sidewall : The portion of a tire between
the tread and the bead.
Speed Rating : An alphanumeric code
assigned to a tire indicating the
maximum speed at which a tire can
operate.
Treadwear Indicators : Narrow bands,
sometimes called wear bars, that show
across the tread of a tire when only
1.6 mm (1/16 in) of tread remains. See
When It Is Time for New Tires 0 200.
UTQGS (Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards) : A tire information system
that provides consumers with ratings
for a tire's traction, temperature, and
treadwear. Ratings are determined by
tire manufacturers using government
testing procedures. The ratings are
molded into the sidewall of the tire.
See Uniform Tire Quality Grading 0 202.
Vehicle Capacity Weight : The number
of designated seating positions
multiplied by 68 kg (150 lb) plus the
rated cargo load. See Vehicle Load
Limits 0 129.
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire :
Load on an individual tire due to curb
weight, accessory weight, occupant
weight, and cargo weight.
Vehicle Placard : A label permanently
attached to a vehicle showing the
vehicle capacity weight and the original
equipment tire size and recommended
inflation pressure. See “Tire and Loading
Information Label” under Vehicle Load
Limits 0 129.
Tire Pressure
Tires need the correct amount of air
pressure to operate effectively.
{ Warning
Neither tire underinflation nor
overinflation is good. Underinflated
tires, or tires that do not have
enough air, can result in:
. Tire overloading and overheating,
which could lead to a blowout.
. Premature or irregular wear.
. Poor handling.
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Warning (Continued)
. Reduced fuel economy.
Overinflated tires, or tires that have
too much air, can result in:
. Unusual wear.
. Poor handling.
. Rough ride.
. Needless damage from road
hazards.
The Tire and Loading Information label
on the vehicle indicates the original
equipment tires and the correct cold
tire inflation pressures. The
recommended pressure is the minimum
air pressure needed to support the
vehicle's maximum load carrying
capacity. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 129.
How the vehicle is loaded affects
vehicle handling and ride comfort.
Never load the vehicle with more
weight than it was designed to carry.
When to Check
Check the pressure of the tires once a
month or more. Do not forget the
compact spare, if the vehicle has one.
The compact spare cold tire pressure
should be at 420 kPa (60 psi). See
Compact Spare Tire 0 209.
How to Check
Use a good quality pocket-type gauge
to check tire pressure. Proper tire
inflation cannot be determined by
looking at the tire. Check the tire
inflation pressure when the tires are
cold, meaning the vehicle has not been
driven for at least three hours or no
more than 1.6 km (1 mi).
Remove the valve cap from the tire
valve stem. Press the tire gauge firmly
onto the valve to get a pressure
measurement. If the cold tire inflation
pressure matches the recommended
pressure on the Tire and Loading
Information label, no further adjustment
is necessary. If the inflation pressure is
low, add air until the recommended
pressure is reached. If the inflation
195
pressure is high, press on the metal
stem in the center of the tire valve to
release air.
Recheck the tire pressure with the tire
gauge.
Put the valve caps back on the valve
stems to keep out dirt and moisture.
Use only valve caps designed for the
vehicle by GM. TPMS sensors could be
damaged and would not be covered by
the vehicle warranty.
Tire Pressure Monitor System
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)
uses radio and sensor technology to check
tire pressure levels. The TPMS sensors
monitor the air pressure in your tires and
transmit tire pressure readings to a receiver
located in the vehicle.
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
should be checked monthly when cold and
inflated to the inflation pressure
recommended by the vehicle manufacturer
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation
pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a
different size than the size indicated on the
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
196
Vehicle Care
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure
label, you should determine the proper tire
inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has
been equipped with a tire pressure
monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a
low tire pressure telltale when one or more
of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure
telltale illuminates, you should stop and
check your tires as soon as possible, and
inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving
on a significantly under-inflated tire causes
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire
failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel
efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect
the vehicle's handling and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance, and
it is the driver's responsibility to maintain
correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation
has not reached the level to trigger
illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure
telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when
the system is not operating properly. The
TPMS malfunction indicator is combined
with the low tire pressure telltale. When the
system detects a malfunction, the telltale
will flash for approximately one minute and
then remain continuously illuminated. This
sequence will continue upon subsequent
vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction
exists.
When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be able to
detect or signal low tire pressure as
intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for
a variety of reasons, including the
installation of replacement or alternate tires
or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the
TPMS from functioning properly. Always
check the TPMS malfunction telltale after
replacing one or more tires or wheels on
your vehicle to ensure that the replacement
or alternate tires and wheels allow the
TPMS to continue to function properly.
See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation 0 196.
See Radio Frequency Statement 0 248.
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure
Monitor System (TPMS). The TPMS is
designed to warn the driver when a low tire
pressure condition exists. TPMS sensors are
mounted onto each tire and wheel
assembly, excluding the spare tire and
wheel assembly. The TPMS sensors monitor
the air pressure in the tires and transmit the
tire pressure readings to a receiver located
in the vehicle.
When a low tire pressure condition is
detected, the TPMS illuminates the low tire
pressure warning light located on the
instrument cluster. If the warning light
comes on, stop as soon as possible and
inflate the tires to the recommended
pressure shown on the Tire and Loading
Information label. See Vehicle Load Limits
0 129.
A message to check the pressure in a
specific tire may display in the Driver
Information Center (DIC). The low tire
pressure warning light and the DIC warning
message, if equipped, come on at each
ignition cycle until the tires are inflated to
the correct inflation pressure. Using the DIC,
it may be possible to view the tire pressure
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
levels. For additional information and details
about the DIC operation and displays, see
Driver Information Center (DIC) 0 82.
The low tire pressure warning light may
come on in cool weather when the vehicle is
first started, and then turn off as the vehicle
is driven. This could be an early indicator
that the air pressure is getting low and
needs to be inflated to the proper pressure.
A Tire and Loading Information label shows
the size of the original equipment tires and
the correct inflation pressure for the tires
when they are cold. See Vehicle Load Limits
0 129, for an example of the Tire and
Loading Information label and its location.
Also see Tire Pressure 0 194.
The TPMS can warn about a low tire
pressure condition, but it does not replace
normal tire maintenance. See Tire Inspection
0 199, Tire Rotation 0 199, and Tires 0 189.
Caution
Tire sealant materials are not all the
same. A non-approved tire sealant could
damage the TPMS sensors. TPMS sensor
damage caused by using an incorrect tire
sealant is not covered by the vehicle
(Continued)
Caution (Continued)
warranty. Always use only the GM
approved tire sealant available through
your dealer or included in the vehicle.
TPMS Malfunction Light and Message
The TPMS will not function properly if one
or more of the TPMS sensors are missing or
inoperable. When the system detects a
malfunction, the low tire pressure warning
light, defined above, flashes for about
one minute and then stays on for the
remainder of the ignition cycle. A DIC
warning message may also display. The
malfunction light and DIC warning message,
if equipped, come on at each ignition cycle
until the problem is corrected. Some of the
conditions that can cause these to come
on are:
. One of the road tires has been replaced
with the spare tire. The spare tire does
not have a TPMS sensor. The malfunction
light and the DIC message, if equipped,
should go off after the road tire is
replaced and the sensor matching process
is performed successfully. See "TPMS
Sensor Matching Process" later in this
section.
197
. The TPMS sensor matching process was
not done or not completed successfully
after rotating the tires. The malfunction
light and the DIC message, if equipped,
should go off after successfully
completing the sensor matching process.
See "TPMS Sensor Matching Process" later
in this section.
. One or more TPMS sensors are missing or
damaged. The malfunction light and the
DIC message, if equipped, should go off
when the TPMS sensors are installed and
the sensor matching process is performed
successfully. See your dealer for service.
. Replacement tires or wheels do not match
the original equipment tires or wheels.
Tires and wheels other than those
recommended could prevent the TPMS
from functioning properly. See Buying
New Tires 0 201.
. Operating electronic devices or being near
facilities using radio wave frequencies
similar to the TPMS could cause the TPMS
sensors to malfunction.
If the TPMS is not functioning properly, it
cannot detect or signal a low tire pressure
condition. See your dealer for service if the
TPMS malfunction light and DIC message,
if equipped, come on and stay on.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
198
Vehicle Care
TPMS Sensor Matching Process
Each TPMS sensor has a unique
identification code. The identification code
needs to be matched to a new tire/wheel
position after rotating the vehicle’s tires or
replacing one or more of the TPMS sensors.
Also, the TPMS sensor matching process
should be performed after replacing a spare
tire with a road tire containing the TPMS
sensor. The malfunction light and the DIC
message, if equipped, should go off at the
next ignition cycle. The sensors are matched
to the tire/wheel positions, using a TPMS
relearn tool, in the following order: driver
side front tire, passenger side front tire,
passenger side rear tire, and driver side rear.
See your dealer for service or to purchase a
relearn tool. A TPMS relearn tool can also be
purchased. See Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor
Activation Tool at
www.gmtoolsandequipment.com or call
1-800-GM TOOLS (1-800-468-6657).
There are two minutes to match the first
tire/wheel position, and five minutes overall
to match all four tire/wheel positions. If it
takes longer, the matching process stops
and must be restarted.
The TPMS sensor matching process is:
1. Set the parking brake.
2. Turn the ignition on without starting the
vehicle or place the vehicle in Service
Mode. See Ignition Positions (Keyless
Access) 0 134 or
Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 132.
3. Use MENU to select the Vehicle
Information Menu (Menu 2) in the Driver
Information Center (DIC).
4. Use the thumbwheel (or up and down
arrows) to scroll to the Tire Pressure
Learn Menu Item (Base DIC) or the Tire
Pressure Menu Item screen (Uplevel DIC).
5. Press and hold SET/CLR to begin the
sensor matching process.
A message requesting acceptance of the
process may display.
6. If requested, press SET/CLR again to
confirm the selection.
The horn sounds twice to signal the
receiver is in relearn mode and the TIRE
LEARN or TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE message
displays on the DIC screen.
7. Start with the driver side front tire.
8. Place the relearn tool against the tire
sidewall, near the valve stem. Then press
the button to activate the TPMS sensor.
A horn chirp confirms that the sensor
identification code has been matched to
this tire and wheel position.
9. Proceed to the passenger side front tire,
and repeat the procedure in Step 8.
10. Proceed to the passenger side rear tire,
and repeat the procedure in Step 8.
11. Proceed to the driver side rear tire, and
repeat the procedure in Step 8. The horn
sounds two times to indicate the sensor
identification code has been matched to
the driver side rear tire, and the TPMS
sensor matching process is no longer
active. The TIRE LEARN or TIRE LEARNING
ACTIVE message on the DIC display
screen goes off.
12. Turn the vehicle off.
13. Set all four tires to the recommended air
pressure level as indicated on the Tire
and Loading Information label.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Tire Inspection
We recommend that the tires, including
the spare tire, if the vehicle has one, be
inspected for signs of wear or damage
at least once a month.
Replace the tire if:
. The indicators at three or more
places around the tire can be seen.
. There is cord or fabric showing
through the tire's rubber.
. The tread or sidewall is cracked, cut,
or snagged deep enough to show
cord or fabric.
. The tire has a bump, bulge, or split.
. The tire has a puncture, cut, or other
damage that cannot be repaired well
because of the size or location of the
damage.
Tires are rotated to achieve a more
uniform wear for all tires. The first
rotation is the most important.
Anytime unusual wear is noticed, rotate
the tires as soon as possible, check for
proper tire inflation pressure, and check
for damaged tires or wheels. If the
unusual wear continues after the
rotation, check the wheel alignment.
See When It Is Time for New Tires
0 200 and
Wheel Replacement 0 203.
Tire Rotation
Tires should be rotated every 12 000 km
(7,500 mi). See Maintenance Schedule
0 226.
Use this rotation pattern when rotating
the tires.
199
Do not include the compact spare tire
in the tire rotation.
Adjust the front and rear tires to the
recommended inflation pressure on the
Tire and Loading Information label after
the tires have been rotated. See Tire
Pressure 0 194 and
Vehicle Load Limits 0 129.
Reset the Tire Pressure Monitor System.
See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation
0 196.
Check that all wheel nuts are properly
tightened. See “Wheel Nut Torque”
under Capacities and Specifications
0 238, and “Removing the Flat Tire and
Installing the Spare Tire” under Tire
Changing 0 206.
{ Warning
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the
parts to which it is fastened, can
cause wheel nuts to become loose
over time. The wheel could come off
and cause a crash. When changing a
wheel, remove any rust or dirt from
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
200
Vehicle Care
four digits of the DOT Tire Identification
Number (TIN) molded into one side of the
tire sidewall. The last four digits of the TIN
indicate the tire manufactured date. The
first two digits represent the week and the
last two digits, the year. For example, the
third week of the year 2020 would have a
4-digit DOT date of 0320. Week 01 is the
first full week (Sunday through Saturday) of
each year.
Warning (Continued)
places where the wheel attaches to
the vehicle. In an emergency, a cloth
or paper towel can be used; however,
use a scraper or wire brush later to
remove all rust or dirt.
Lightly coat the inner diameter of the
wheel hub opening with wheel bearing
grease after a wheel change or tire
rotation to prevent corrosion or rust
buildup.
{ Warning
Do not apply grease to the wheel
mounting surface, wheel conical
seats, or the wheel nuts or bolts.
Grease applied to these areas could
cause a wheel to become loose or
come off, resulting in a crash.
When It Is Time for New Tires
Factors, such as maintenance, temperatures,
driving speeds, vehicle loading, and road
conditions affect the wear rate of the tires.
Vehicle Storage
Treadwear indicators are one way to tell
when it is time for new tires. Treadwear
indicators appear when the tires have only
1.6 mm (1/16 in) or less of tread remaining.
See Tire Inspection 0 199 and
Tire Rotation 0 199 for additional
information.
The rubber in tires ages over time. This also
applies to the spare tire, if the vehicle has
one, even if it is never used. Multiple factors
including temperatures, loading conditions,
and inflation pressure maintenance affect
how fast aging takes place. GM recommends
that tires, including the spare if equipped,
be replaced after six years, regardless of
tread wear. To identify the age of a tire, use
the tire manufacture date, which is the last
Tires age when stored normally mounted on
a parked vehicle. Park a vehicle that will be
stored for at least a month in a cool, dry,
clean area away from direct sunlight to slow
aging. This area should be free of grease,
gasoline, or other substances that can
deteriorate rubber.
Parking for an extended period can cause
flat spots on the tires that may result in
vibrations while driving. When storing a
vehicle for at least a month, remove the
tires or raise the vehicle to reduce the
weight from the tires.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Buying New Tires
GM has developed and matched specific
tires for the vehicle. The original
equipment tires installed were designed
to meet General Motors Tire
Performance Criteria Specification (TPC
Spec) system rating. When replacement
tires are needed, GM strongly
recommends buying tires with the same
TPC Spec rating.
GM's exclusive TPC Spec system
considers over a dozen critical
specifications that impact the overall
performance of the vehicle, including
brake system performance, ride and
handling, traction control, and tire
pressure monitoring performance. GM's
TPC Spec number is molded onto the
tire's sidewall near the tire size. If the
tires have an all-season tread design,
the TPC spec number will be followed
by MS, for mud and snow. See Tire
Sidewall Labeling 0 190.
GM recommends replacing worn tires in
complete sets of four. Uniform tread
depth on all tires will help to maintain
the performance of the vehicle. Braking
and handling performance may be
adversely affected if all the tires are not
replaced at the same time. If proper
rotation and maintenance have been
done, all four tires should wear out at
about the same time. See Tire Rotation
0 199. However, if it is necessary to
replace only one axle set of worn tires,
place the new tires on the rear axle.
Winter tires with the same speed rating
as the original equipment tires may not
be available for H, V, W, Y, and ZR
speed rated tires. Never exceed the
winter tires’ maximum speed capability
when using winter tires with a lower
speed rating.
{ Warning
Tires could explode during improper
service. Attempting to mount or
dismount a tire could cause injury or
death. Only your dealer or authorized
tire service center should mount or
dismount the tires.
201
{ Warning
Mixing tires of different sizes, brands,
or types may cause loss of control of
the vehicle, resulting in a crash or
other vehicle damage. Use the
correct size, brand, and type of tire
on all wheels.
{ Warning
Using bias-ply tires on the vehicle
may cause the wheel rim flanges to
develop cracks after many miles of
driving. A tire and/or wheel could fail
suddenly and cause a crash. Use only
radial-ply tires with the wheels on
the vehicle.
If the vehicle tires must be replaced
with a tire that does not have a TPC
Spec number, make sure they are the
same size, load range, speed rating, and
construction (radial) as the original
tires.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
202
Vehicle Care
Vehicles that have a tire pressure
monitoring system could give an
inaccurate low-pressure warning if
non-TPC Spec rated tires are installed.
See Tire Pressure Monitor System 0 195.
The Tire and Loading Information Label
indicates the original equipment tires
on the vehicle. See Vehicle Load Limits
0 129.
Different Size Tires and Wheels
If wheels or tires are installed that are a
different size than the original equipment
wheels and tires, vehicle performance,
including its braking, ride and handling
characteristics, stability, and resistance to
rollover may be affected. If the vehicle has
electronic systems such as antilock brakes,
rollover airbags, traction control, electronic
stability control, or All-Wheel Drive, the
performance of these systems can also be
affected.
{ Warning
If different sized wheels are used, there
may not be an acceptable level of
performance and safety if tires not
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
recommended for those wheels are
selected. This increases the chance of a
crash and serious injury. Only use GM
specific wheel and tire systems developed
for the vehicle, and have them properly
installed by a GM certified technician.
See Buying New Tires 0 201 and
Accessories and Modifications 0 160.
Wheel Covers
Installation
Tighten the wheel nut caps by hand while
pressing on the center of the wheel cover
with the other hand. Then tighten an
additional one-quarter turn with the wheel
wrench.
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
The following information relates to the
system developed by the United States
National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA), which grades
tires by treadwear, traction, and
temperature performance. This applies
only to vehicles sold in the United
States. The grades are molded on the
sidewalls of most passenger car tires.
The Uniform Tire Quality Grading
(UTQG) system does not apply to deep
tread, winter tires, compact spare tires,
tires with nominal rim diameters of
10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm), or to some
limited-production tires.
While the tires available on General
Motors passenger cars and light trucks
may vary with respect to these grades,
they must also conform to federal
safety requirements and additional
General Motors Tire Performance
Criteria (TPC) standards.
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall between
tread shoulder and maximum section
width. For example:
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A
All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform to
Federal Safety Requirements In Addition
To These Grades.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative
rating based on the wear rate of the
tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government
test course. For example, a tire graded
150 would wear one and one-half (1½)
times as well on the government course
as a tire graded 100. The relative
performance of tires depends upon the
actual conditions of their use, however,
and may depart significantly from the
norm due to variations in driving habits,
service practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
Traction
The traction grades, from highest to
lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those
grades represent the tire's ability to
stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on specified
government test surfaces of asphalt and
concrete. A tire marked C may have
poor traction performance. Warning:
The traction grade assigned to this tire
is based on straight-ahead braking
traction tests, and does not include
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning,
or peak traction characteristics.
loading, either separately or in
combination, can cause heat buildup
and possible tire failure.
Temperature
Wheel Alignment and Tire
Balance
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B, and C, representing the
tire's resistance to the generation of
heat and its ability to dissipate heat
when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified indoor laboratory test
wheel. Sustained high temperature can
cause the material of the tire to
degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to
sudden tire failure. The grade C
corresponds to a level of performance
which all passenger car tires must meet
under the Federal Motor Safety
Standard No. 109. Grades B and A
represent higher levels of performance
on the laboratory test wheel than the
minimum required by law. Warning:
The temperature grade for this tire is
established for a tire that is properly
inflated and not overloaded. Excessive
speed, underinflation, or excessive
203
The tires and wheels were aligned and
balanced at the factory to provide the
longest tire life and best overall
performance. Adjustments to wheel
alignment and tire balancing are not
necessary on a regular basis. Consider an
alignment check if there is unusual tire wear
or the vehicle is significantly pulling to one
side or the other. Some slight pull to the
left or right, depending on the crown of the
road and/or other road surface variations
such as troughs or ruts, is normal. If the
vehicle is vibrating when driving on a
smooth road, the tires and wheels may
need to be rebalanced. See your dealer for
proper diagnosis.
Wheel Replacement
Replace any wheel that is bent, cracked,
or badly rusted or corroded. If wheel nuts
keep coming loose, the wheel, wheel bolts,
and wheel nuts should be replaced. If the
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
204
Vehicle Care
wheel leaks air, replace it. Some aluminum
wheels can be repaired. See your dealer if
any of these conditions exist.
Your dealer will know the kind of wheel that
is needed.
Each new wheel should have the same
load-carrying capacity, diameter, width,
offset, and be mounted the same way as
the one it replaces.
Replace wheels, wheel bolts, wheel nuts,
or Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)
sensors with new GM original equipment
parts.
{ Warning
Using the wrong replacement wheels,
wheel bolts, or wheel nuts can be
dangerous. It could affect the braking and
handling of the vehicle. Tires can lose air,
and cause loss of control, causing a crash.
Always use the correct wheel, wheel
bolts, and wheel nuts for replacement.
Caution
Warning (Continued)
The wrong wheel can also cause
problems with bearing life, brake cooling,
speedometer or odometer calibration,
headlamp aim, bumper height, vehicle
ground clearance, and tire or tire chain
clearance to the body and chassis.
brakes, suspension, or other vehicle parts.
The area damaged by the tire chains
could cause loss of control and a crash.
Used Replacement Wheels
{ Warning
Replacing a wheel with a used one is
dangerous. How it has been used or how
far it has been driven may be unknown.
It could fail suddenly and cause a crash.
When replacing wheels, use a new GM
original equipment wheel.
Tire Chains
{ Warning
Do not use tire chains. There is not
enough clearance. Tire chains used on a
vehicle without the proper amount of
clearance can cause damage to the
(Continued)
Use another type of traction device only
if its manufacturer recommends it for the
vehicle's tire size combination and road
conditions. Follow that manufacturer's
instructions. To avoid vehicle damage,
drive slow and readjust or remove the
traction device if it contacts the vehicle.
Do not spin the wheels. If traction
devices are used, install them on the
front tires.
If a Tire Goes Flat
It is unusual for a tire to blow out while
driving, especially if the tires are maintained
properly. See Tires 0 189. If air goes out of a
tire, it is much more likely to leak out
slowly. But if there is ever a blowout, here
are a few tips about what to expect and
what to do:
If a front tire fails, the flat tire creates a
drag that pulls the vehicle toward that side.
Take your foot off the accelerator pedal and
grip the steering wheel firmly. Steer to
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
maintain lane position, and then gently
brake to a stop, well off the road,
if possible.
A rear blowout, particularly on a curve, acts
much like a skid and may require the same
correction as used in a skid. Stop pressing
the accelerator pedal and steer to straighten
the vehicle. It may be very bumpy and
noisy. Gently brake to a stop, well off the
road, if possible.
{ Warning
Driving on a flat tire will cause
permanent damage to the tire.
Re-inflating a tire after it has been driven
on while severely underinflated or flat
may cause a blowout and a serious crash.
Never attempt to re-inflate a tire that has
been driven on while severely
underinflated or flat. Have your dealer or
an authorized tire service center repair or
replace the flat tire as soon as possible.
205
{ Warning
Warning (Continued)
Lifting a vehicle and getting under it to
do maintenance or repairs is dangerous
without the appropriate safety equipment
and training. If a jack is provided with
the vehicle, it is designed only for
changing a flat tire. If it is used for
anything else, you or others could be
badly injured or killed if the vehicle slips
off the jack. If a jack is provided with the
vehicle, only use it for changing a
flat tire.
2. Put an automatic transmission in
P (Park) or a manual transmission in
1 (First) or R (Reverse).
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and
wheel damage by driving slowly to a level
place, well off the road, if possible. Turn on
the hazard warning flashers. See Hazard
Warning Flashers 0 93.
When the vehicle has a flat tire (2), use the
following example as a guide to assist in the
placement of the wheel blocks (1),
if equipped.
3. Turn off the engine and do not
restart while the vehicle is raised.
4. Do not allow passengers to remain
in the vehicle.
5. Place wheel blocks, if equipped, on
both sides of the tire at the opposite
corner of the tire being changed.
{ Warning
Changing a tire can be dangerous. The
vehicle can slip off the jack and roll over
or fall causing injury or death. Find a
level place to change the tire. To help
prevent the vehicle from moving:
1. Set the parking brake firmly.
(Continued)
1. Wheel Block (If Equipped)
2. Flat Tire
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
206
Vehicle Care
The following information explains how to
repair or change a tire.
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the
Spare Tire
Tire Changing
1. Do a safety check before proceeding. See
If a Tire Goes Flat 0 204.
2. If there is a wheel cover, remove the
wheel nut caps to access the wheel nuts.
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools
The spare tire and tools are located in the
storage compartment in the rear of the
vehicle.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1. Strap
2. Jack
To
1.
2.
3.
4.
Wheel Wrench
Screwdriver
Tow Eye
Screwdriver Handle
Jack Handle Extension
access the spare tire and tools:
Open the liftgate. See Liftgate 0 17.
Lift the trim cover.
Remove the jack, tools, and spare tire.
Place them near the tire being changed.
3. Turn the wheel wrench counterclockwise
to loosen the wheel nuts. Do not remove
them yet.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
5. Attach the jack handle extension to the
jack by sliding the hook through the end
of the jack.
6. Turn the wheel wrench clockwise until
the lift head is firmly contacting the
proper lifting point nearest the flat tire.
{ Warning
4. Place the jack at the position marked
with a half circle.
Getting under a vehicle when it is lifted
on a jack is dangerous. If the vehicle slips
off the jack, you could be badly injured
or killed. Never get under a vehicle when
it is supported only by a jack.
{ Warning
Raising the vehicle with the jack
improperly positioned can damage the
vehicle and even make the vehicle fall. To
help avoid personal injury and vehicle
damage, be sure to fit the jack lift head
into the proper location before raising
the vehicle.
207
{ Warning
Lifting a vehicle and getting under it to
do maintenance or repairs is dangerous
without the appropriate safety equipment
and training. If a jack is provided with
the vehicle, it is designed only for
changing a flat tire. If it is used for
anything else, you or others could be
badly injured or killed if the vehicle slips
off the jack. If a jack is provided with the
vehicle, only use it for changing a
flat tire.
7. Turn the wheel wrench clockwise to raise
the vehicle far enough off the ground so
there is enough room for the spare tire
to fit underneath the wheel well.
8. Turn the wheel nuts counterclockwise to
remove them.
9. Remove the flat tire.
{ Warning
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the
parts to which it is fastened, can
make wheel nuts become loose after
time. The wheel could come off and
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
208
Vehicle Care
Warning (Continued)
cause a crash. When changing a
wheel, remove any rust or dirt from
places where the wheel attaches to
the vehicle. In an emergency, a cloth
or a paper towel can be used;
however, use a scraper or wire brush
later to remove all rust or dirt.
{ Warning
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts
because the nuts might come loose. The
vehicle's wheel could fall off, causing a
crash.
12. Reinstall the wheel nuts. Turn each nut
clockwise, by hand, until the wheel is
held against the hub.
13. Lower the vehicle by turning the wheel
wrench counterclockwise. Lower the jack
completely.
Caution
Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead
to brake pulsation and rotor damage. To
avoid expensive brake repairs, evenly
tighten the wheel nuts in the proper
sequence and to the proper torque
specification. See Capacities and
Specifications 0 238 for the wheel nut
torque specification.
{ Warning
10. Remove any rust or dirt from the wheel
bolts, mounting surfaces, and spare
wheel.
11. Place the spare tire on the
wheel-mounting surface.
Wheel nuts that are improperly or
incorrectly tightened can cause the
wheels to become loose or come off. The
wheel nuts should be tightened with a
torque wrench to the proper torque
specification after replacing. Follow the
torque specification supplied by the
aftermarket manufacturer when using
accessory locking wheel nuts. See
Capacities and Specifications 0 238 for
original equipment wheel nut torque
specifications.
14. Tighten the wheel nuts firmly with the
wheel wrench in a crisscross sequence, as
shown.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
209
Caution
Wheel covers will not fit on the vehicle's
compact spare. If you try to put a wheel
cover on the compact spare, the cover or
the spare could be damaged.
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools
{ Warning
Storing a jack, a tire, or other equipment
in the passenger compartment of the
vehicle could cause injury. In a sudden
stop or collision, loose equipment could
strike someone. Store all these in the
proper place.
1. Remove the load compartment cover.
2. Lift the load floor.
3. Place the tool container and the flat tire
upright into the tool box spare.
4. Pull the release knob on top of the rear
seatback to move it forward.
5. Route the loop end of the strap through
the seatback latch.
6. Route the hook end of the strap through
the loop and securely fasten it to the
seatback latch.
7. Pull back the rear seatbacks.
8. Attach the hook to the liftgate latch.
9. Tighten the strap and secure it using the
buckle.
The compact spare tire is for temporary use
only. Replace the compact spare tire with a
full-size tire as soon as you can. See
Compact Spare Tire 0 209.
Compact Spare Tire
{ Warning
Driving with more than one compact
spare tire at a time could result in loss of
braking and handling. This could lead to a
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
210
Vehicle Care
Warning (Continued)
Caution
crash and you or others could be injured.
Use only one compact spare tire at
a time.
When the compact spare is installed, do
not take the vehicle through an
automatic car wash with guide rails. The
compact spare can get caught on the rails
which can damage the tire, wheel, and
other parts of the vehicle.
If this vehicle has a compact spare tire, it
was fully inflated when new; however, it
can lose air over time. Check the inflation
pressure regularly. It should be 420 kPa
(60 psi).
Stop as soon as possible and check that the
spare tire is correctly inflated after being
installed on the vehicle. The compact spare
tire is designed for temporary use only. The
vehicle will perform differently with the
spare tire installed and it is recommended
that the vehicle speed be limited to 80 km/h
(50 mph). To conserve the tread of the spare
tire, have the standard tire repaired or
replaced as soon as convenient and return
the spare tire to the storage area.
When using a compact spare tire, the AWD
(if equipped), ABS, and Traction Control
systems may engage until the spare tire is
recognized by the vehicle, especially on
slippery roads. Adjust driving to reduce
possible wheel slip.
Do not use the compact spare on other
vehicles.
Do not mix the compact spare tire or wheel
with other wheels or tires. They will not fit.
Keep the spare tire and its wheel together.
Caution
Tire chains will not fit the compact spare.
Using them can damage the vehicle and
the chains. Do not use tire chains on the
compact spare.
Jump Starting
If the battery has run down, try to use
another vehicle and some jumper cables to
start your vehicle. Be sure to use the
following steps to do it safely.
{ Warning
WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and
related accessories can expose you to
chemicals including lead and lead
compounds, which are known to the
State of California to cause cancer and
birth defects or other reproductive harm.
Wash hands after handling. For more
information go to
www.P65Warnings.ca.gov.
See the warning on the back cover.
{ Warning
Batteries can hurt you. They can be
dangerous because:
. They contain acid that can burn you.
Jump Starting - North America
. They contain gas that can explode or
For more information about the vehicle
battery, see Battery - North America 0 175.
. They contain enough electricity to
ignite.
burn you.
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Warning (Continued)
If you do not follow these steps exactly,
some or all of these things can hurt you.
Caution
Ignoring these steps could result in costly
damage to the vehicle that would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty. Trying
to start the vehicle by pushing or pulling
it will not work, and it could damage the
vehicle.
2. Discharged Battery Positive (+)
Terminal
3. Good Battery Positive (+) Terminal
4. Good Battery Negative (–) Terminal
The discharged battery positive (+) terminal
is in the engine compartment on the driver
side of the vehicle. See Engine Compartment
Overview 0 163.
The discharged battery negative (–)
grounding point is in front of the engine
cover or an engine mounting bolt.
The good battery positive (+) terminal and
good battery negative (–) terminal are on
the battery of the vehicle providing the
jump start.
The discharged battery positive (+) terminal
is under a trim cover. Open the cover to
expose the post.
These locations are used instead of a direct
connection to the battery.
1. Check the other vehicle. It must have a
12-volt battery with a negative ground
system.
1. Discharged Battery Negative (–)
Grounding Point
211
Caution
If the other vehicle does not have a
12-volt system with a negative ground,
both vehicles can be damaged. Only use
a vehicle that has a 12-volt system with a
negative ground for jump starting.
2. Position the two vehicles so that they
are not touching.
3. Set the parking brake firmly and put the
shift lever in P (Park) with an automatic
transmission, or Neutral with a manual
transmission. See Shifting Into Park 0 138
with an automatic transmission,
or Parking (Manual Transmission) 0 139
with a manual transmission.
Caution
If any accessories are left on or plugged
in during the jump starting procedure,
they could be damaged. The repairs
would not be covered by the vehicle
warranty. Whenever possible, turn off or
unplug all accessories on either vehicle
when jump starting.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
212
Vehicle Care
4. Turn the ignition off. Turn off all lights
and accessories in both vehicles, except
the hazard warning flashers if needed.
{ Warning
An electric fan can start up even when
the engine is not running and can injure
you. Keep hands, clothing, and tools
away from any underhood electric fan.
{ Warning
Using a match near a battery can cause
battery gas to explode. People have been
hurt doing this, and some have been
blinded. Use a flashlight if you need
more light.
Battery fluid contains acid that can burn
you. Do not get it on you. If you
accidentally get it in your eyes or on
your skin, flush the place with water and
get medical help immediately.
{ Warning
Fans or other moving engine parts can
injure you badly. Keep your hands away
from moving parts once the engine is
running.
5. Connect one end of the red positive (+)
cable to the discharged battery
positive (+) terminal.
6. Connect the other end of the red
positive (+) cable to the good battery
positive (+) terminal.
7. Connect one end of the black negative
(–) cable to the good battery negative
(–) terminal.
8. Connect the other end of the black
negative (–) cable to the discharged
battery negative (–) grounding point.
9. Start the engine in the vehicle with the
good battery and run the engine at idle
speed for at least four minutes.
10. Try to start the vehicle that had the
dead battery. If it will not start after a
few tries, it probably needs service.
Caution
If the jumper cables are connected or
removed in the wrong order, electrical
shorting may occur and damage the
vehicle. The repairs would not be covered
by the vehicle warranty. Always connect
and remove the jumper cables in the
correct order, making sure that the cables
do not touch each other or other metal.
Jumper Cable Removal
Reverse the sequence exactly when
removing the jumper cables.
After starting the disabled vehicle and
removing the jumper cables, allow it to idle
for several minutes.
Towing the Vehicle
Caution
Incorrectly transporting a disabled vehicle
may cause damage to the vehicle. Use
proper tire straps to secure the vehicle to
the flatbed tow truck. Do not strap or
hook to any frame, underbody,
or suspension component not specified
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Caution (Continued)
below. Do not move vehicles with drive
axle tires on the ground. Damage is not
covered by the vehicle warranty.
Caution
The vehicle may be equipped with an
electric parking brake and/or a
mechanical transmission range select
shifter. In the event of a loss of 12-volt
battery power, the electric parking brake
cannot be released, and the vehicle
cannot be shifted to N (Neutral). Tire
skates or dollies must be used under the
non-rolling tires to prevent damage while
loading/unloading the vehicle. Dragging
the vehicle will cause damage not
covered by the vehicle warranty.
Caution
The vehicle may be equipped with a tow
eye. Improper use of the tow eye may
cause damage to the vehicle and is not
covered by the vehicle warranty.
If equipped, use the tow eye to load the
(Continued)
Caution (Continued)
vehicle onto a flatbed tow truck from a
flat road surface, or to move the vehicle
a very short distance at a walking pace.
The tow eye is not designed for off-road
recovery. The vehicle must be in
N (Neutral) with the electric parking
brake released when using the tow eye.
Contact a professional towing service if the
disabled vehicle must be transported. GM
recommends a flatbed tow truck to
transport a disabled vehicle. Use ramps to
help reduce approach angles, if necessary.
213
the vehicle with a known good 12-volt
battery, shift the car into N (Neutral), and
release the electric parking brake. Refer to
Jump Starting - North America 0 210.
. If unsuccessful, the vehicle will not move.
Tire skates or dollies must be used under
the non-rolling tires to prevent vehicle
damage.
Front Tow Eye
The tow eye is in the spare tire and tools
kit, in the storage compartment in the rear
of the vehicle.
If equipped, a tow eye may be located near
the spare tire or emergency jack. Do not use
the tow eye to pull the vehicle from the
snow, mud, sand, or ditch. Tow eye threads
may have right or left-hand threads. Use
caution when installing or removing the
tow eye.
The vehicle must be in N (Neutral) and the
electric parking brake must be released
when loading the vehicle onto a flatbed tow
truck.
. If the 12-volt battery is dead and/or
electric parking brake is not released, the
vehicle will not move. Try to jump start
Carefully open the cover in the fascia by
using the small notch that conceals the tow
eye socket.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
214
Vehicle Care
Install the tow eye into the socket and turn
it until it stops. When the tow eye is
removed, reinstall the cover with the notch
in the original position.
Recreational Vehicle Towing
Recreational vehicle towing refers to towing
the vehicle behind another vehicle, such as
behind a motor home. The two most
common types of recreational vehicle
towing are known as dinghy towing and
dolly towing. Dinghy towing is towing the
vehicle with all four wheels on the ground.
Dolly towing is towing the vehicle with two
wheels on the ground and two wheels up
on a device known as a dolly.
Here are some important things to consider
before recreational vehicle towing:
. Before towing the vehicle, become
familiar with the local laws that apply to
recreational vehicle towing. These laws
may vary by region.
. The towing capacity of the towing
vehicle. Be sure to read the tow vehicle
manufacturer's recommendations.
. How far the vehicle will be towed. Some
vehicles have restrictions on how far and
how long they can tow.
. The proper towing equipment. See your
dealer or trailering professional for
additional advice and equipment
recommendations.
. If the vehicle is ready to be towed. Just
as preparing the vehicle for a long trip,
make sure the vehicle is prepared to be
towed.
Dinghy Towing (with Automatic
Transmission)
Caution
Use of a shield mounted in front of the
vehicle grille could restrict airflow and
cause damage to the transmission. The
repairs would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty. If using a shield, only
use one that attaches to the towing
vehicle.
Caution
If the vehicle is towed with all four
wheels on the ground, the drivetrain
components could be damaged. The
repairs would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty. Do not tow the vehicle
with all four wheels on the ground.
Vehicles with an automatic transmission
should not be towed with all four wheels on
the ground. If the vehicle must be towed, a
dolly should be used. See "Dolly Towing"
following.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Dinghy Towing (with Manual
Transmission)
5. Cover the negative battery post with a
non-conductive material to prevent any
contact with the negative battery
terminal.
6. Release the parking brake.
Caution
If 113 km/h (70 mph) is exceeded while
towing the vehicle, it could be damaged.
Never exceed 113 km/h (70 mph) while
towing the vehicle.
To dinghy tow the vehicle from the front
with all four wheels on the ground:
1. Position the vehicle to tow and then
secure it to the tow vehicle.
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Shift the transmission to Neutral.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable at
the battery. See “Negative Battery Cable
Disconnection” under Battery - North
America 0 175.
215
Caution
Towing the vehicle from the rear could
damage it. Also, repairs would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty. Never
have the vehicle towed from the rear.
To
1.
2.
3.
4.
disconnect the towed vehicle:
Park on a level surface.
Apply the parking brake.
Make sure that the ignition is off.
Remove any tape, glue, or excess
material from the negative battery post.
5. Connect the battery. See “Negative
Battery Cable Reconnection” under
Battery - North America 0 175.
6. Disconnect the vehicle from the tow
vehicle.
7. Release the parking brake.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
216
Vehicle Care
Dolly Towing
Washing the Vehicle
To preserve the vehicle's finish, wash it
often and out of direct sunlight.
Caution
Caution
To tow the vehicle with the two rear wheels
on the ground and the front wheels on a
dolly:
1. Put the front wheels on a dolly.
2. Shift an automatic transmission into
P (Park) or a manual transmission into
1 (First) gear.
3. Set the parking brake.
4. Clamp the steering wheel in a
straight-ahead position with a clamping
device designed for towing.
5. Turn the ignition off.
6. Secure the vehicle to the dolly.
7. Release the parking brake.
Towing the vehicle from the rear could
damage it. Also, repairs would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty. Never
have the vehicle towed from the rear.
Appearance Care
Exterior Care
Locks
Locks are lubricated at the factory. Use a
de-icing agent only when absolutely
necessary, and have the locks greased after
using. See Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants 0 234.
Do not use petroleum-based, acidic,
or abrasive cleaning agents as they can
damage the vehicle's paint, metal,
or plastic parts. If damage occurs, it
would not be covered by the vehicle
warranty. Approved cleaning products can
be obtained from your dealer. Follow all
manufacturer directions regarding correct
product usage, necessary safety
precautions, and appropriate disposal of
any vehicle care product.
Caution
Avoid using high-pressure washes closer
than 30 cm (12 in) to the surface of the
vehicle. Use of power washers exceeding
8 274 kPa (1,200 psi) can result in
damage or removal of paint and decals.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Caution
Caution (Continued)
Do not power wash any component
under the hood that has this e
symbol.
This could cause damage that would not
be covered by the vehicle warranty.
If using an automatic car wash, follow the
car wash instructions. The windshield wiper
and rear window wiper, if equipped, must
be off. Remove any accessories that may be
damaged or interfere with the car wash
equipment.
Rinse the vehicle well, before washing and
after, to remove all cleaning agents
completely. If they are allowed to dry on
the surface, they could stain.
Dry the finish with a soft, clean chamois or
an all-cotton towel to avoid surface
scratches and water spotting.
Cleaning Underhood Components
Caution
Do not power wash any component
under the hood that has this e
symbol.
(Continued)
This could cause damage that would not
be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Solvents or aggressive cleaners may harm
underhood components. The usages of these
chemicals should be avoided.
Recommend water only.
A pressure washer may be used, but care
must be utilized. The following criteria must
be followed:
. Water pressure must be kept below
14 000 KPa (2,000 PSI).
. Water temperature must be below 80 °C
(180 °F).
. Spray nozzle with a 40 degree wide angle
spray pattern or wider must be used.
. Nozzle must be kept at least 30 cm (1 ft)
away from all surfaces.
Finish Care
Application of aftermarket clearcoat sealant/
wax materials is not recommended.
If painted surfaces are damaged, see your
dealer to have the damage assessed and
repaired. Foreign materials such as calcium
chloride and other salts, ice melting agents,
road oil and tar, tree sap, bird droppings,
217
chemicals from industrial chimneys, etc., can
damage the vehicle's finish if they remain
on painted surfaces. Wash the vehicle as
soon as possible. If necessary, use
non-abrasive cleaners that are marked safe
for painted surfaces to remove foreign
matter.
Occasional hand waxing or mild polishing
should be done to remove residue from the
paint finish. See your dealer for approved
cleaning products.
Do not apply waxes or polishes to uncoated
plastic, vinyl, rubber, decals, simulated
wood, or flat paint as damage can occur.
Caution
Machine compounding or aggressive
polishing on a basecoat/clearcoat paint
finish may damage it. Use only
non-abrasive waxes and polishes that are
made for a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish
on the vehicle.
To keep the paint finish looking new, keep
the vehicle garaged or covered whenever
possible.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
218
Vehicle Care
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal Moldings
Caution
Failure to clean and protect the bright
metal moldings can result in a hazy
white finish or pitting. This damage
would not be covered by the vehicle
warranty.
The bright metal moldings on the vehicle
are aluminum, chrome, or stainless steel. To
prevent damage always follow these
cleaning instructions:
. Be sure the molding is cool to the touch
before applying any cleaning solution
. Use only approved cleaning solutions for
aluminum, chrome, or stainless steel.
Some cleaners are highly acidic or contain
alkaline substances and can damage the
moldings
. Always dilute a concentrated cleaner
according to the manufacturer’s
instructions
. Do not use cleaners that are not intended
for automotive use
. Use a nonabrasive wax on the vehicle
after washing to protect and extend the
molding finish
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses,
Emblems, Decals, and Stripes
Caution
Using wax on low gloss black finish
stripes can increase the gloss level and
create a non-uniform finish. Clean low
gloss stripes with soap and water only.
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a soft
cloth, and a car washing soap to clean
exterior lamps, lenses, emblems, decals, and
stripes. Follow instructions under "Washing
the Vehicle" previously in this section.
Air Intakes
Lamp covers are made of plastic, and some
have a UV protective coating. Do not clean
or wipe them when dry.
Clear debris from the air intakes, between
the hood and windshield, when washing the
vehicle.
Do not use any of the following on lamp
covers:
. Abrasive or caustic agents
. Washer fluids and other cleaning agents
in higher concentrations than suggested
by the manufacturer
. Solvents, alcohols, fuels, or other harsh
cleaners
. Ice scrapers or other hard items
. Aftermarket appearance caps or covers
while the lamps are illuminated, due to
excessive heat generated
Caution
Failure to clean lamps properly can cause
damage to the lamp cover that would
not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Windshield and Wiper Blades
Clean the outside of the windshield with
glass cleaner.
Clean rubber blades using a lint-free cloth or
paper towel soaked with windshield washer
fluid or a mild detergent. Wash the
windshield thoroughly when cleaning the
blades. Bugs, road grime, sap, and a buildup
of vehicle wash/wax treatments may cause
wiper streaking.
Replace the wiper blades if they are worn or
damaged. Damage can be caused by
extreme dusty conditions, sand, salt, heat,
sun, snow, and ice.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Weatherstrips
Caution
Apply weatherstrip lubricant on
weatherstrips to make them last longer, seal
better, and not stick or squeak. Lubricate
weatherstrips at least once a year. Hot, dry
climates may require more frequent
application. Black marks from rubber
material on painted surfaces can be removed
by rubbing with a clean cloth. See
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 234.
Chrome wheels and chrome wheel trim
may be damaged if the vehicle is not
washed after driving on roads that have
been sprayed with magnesium chloride or
calcium chloride. These are used on roads
for conditions such as dust and ice.
Always wash the chrome with soap and
water after exposure.
Tires
Use a stiff brush with tire cleaner to clean
the tires.
Caution
Using petroleum-based tire dressing
products on the vehicle may damage the
paint finish and/or tires. When applying a
tire dressing, always wipe off any
overspray from all painted surfaces on
the vehicle.
Wheels and Wheel Trim
Use a soft, clean cloth with mild soap and
water to clean the wheels. After rinsing
thoroughly with clean water, dry with a
soft, clean towel. A wax may then be
applied.
Caution
To avoid surface damage on wheels and
wheel trim, do not use strong soaps,
chemicals, abrasive polishes, cleaners,
or brushes. Use only GM approved
cleaners. Do not drive the vehicle through
an automatic car wash that uses silicon
carbide tire/wheel cleaning brushes.
Damage could occur and the repairs
would not be covered by the vehicle
warranty.
Brake System
Visually inspect brake lines and hoses for
proper hook-up, binding, leaks, cracks,
chafing, etc. Inspect disc brake pads for wear
219
and rotors for surface condition. Inspect
drum brake linings/shoes for wear or cracks.
Inspect all other brake parts.
Steering, Suspension, and Chassis
Components
Visually inspect steering, suspension, and
chassis components for damaged, loose,
or missing parts or signs of wear at least
once a year.
Inspect power steering for proper
attachment, connections, binding, leaks,
cracks, chafing, etc.
Visually check constant velocity joint boots
and axle seals for leaks.
Body Component Lubrication
Lubricate all key lock cylinders, hood hinges,
liftgate hinges, and the steel fuel door
hinges, unless the components are plastic.
Applying silicone grease on weatherstrips
with a clean cloth will make them last
longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
220
Vehicle Care
Underbody Maintenance
Chemical Paint Spotting
At least twice a year, spring and fall, use
plain water to flush any corrosive materials
from the underbody. Take care to
thoroughly clean any areas where mud and
other debris can collect.
Airborne pollutants can fall upon and attack
painted vehicle surfaces causing blotchy,
ring-shaped discolorations, and small,
irregular dark spots etched into the paint
surface. See “Finish Care” previously in this
section.
Do not directly power wash the transfer
case and/or front/rear axle output seals.
High pressure water can overcome the seals
and contaminate the fluid. Contaminated
fluid will decrease the life of the transfer
case and/or axles and should be replaced.
Sheet Metal Damage
If the vehicle is damaged and requires sheet
metal repair or replacement, make sure the
body repair shop applies anti-corrosion
material to parts repaired or replaced to
restore corrosion protection.
Original manufacturer replacement parts will
provide the corrosion protection while
maintaining the vehicle warranty.
Finish Damage
Quickly repair minor chips and scratches
with touch-up materials available from your
dealer to avoid corrosion. Larger areas of
finish damage can be corrected in your
dealer's body and paint shop.
Interior Care
To prevent dirt particle abrasions, regularly
clean the vehicle's interior. Before using
cleaners, read and follow all safety
instructions on the label. While cleaning the
interior, open the doors and windows to get
proper ventilation. Newspapers or dark
garments can transfer color to the vehicle’s
interior.
Caution
Immediately remove cleaners, hand
lotions, sunscreen, and insect repellent
from all interior surfaces or permanent
damage may result.
Caution
Use cleaners specifically designed for the
surfaces being cleaned to prevent
permanent damage to the vehicle. Apply
all cleaners directly to a cleaning cloth.
Do not spray cleaners on any switches or
controls.
When using liquid soap cleaners, follow the
directions on the specific cleaner or soap
solution for dilution instructions.
Caution
To prevent damage:
. Never use a razor or any other sharp
.
.
.
.
object to remove soil from any interior
surface
Never use a brush with stiff bristles.
Never rub any surface aggressively or
with too much pressure.
Do not get any exposed electrical
components wet.
Do not use laundry detergents or
dishwashing soaps with degreasers. Do
not use solutions that contain strong
or caustic soap.
(Continued)
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Caution (Continued)
Caution
. Do not heavily saturate the upholstery
To prevent scratching, never use abrasive
cleaners on automotive glass. Abrasive
cleaners or aggressive cleaning may
damage the rear window defogger.
when cleaning.
. Do not use solvents or cleaners
containing solvents.
. Do not use disinfecting wipes that are
scented or contain bleach. Do not use
wipes or cleaners that show a color
transfer to the wipe or change the
appearance of the interior surface
when used.
. Do not use scented or gel-type hand
sanitizers. If hand sanitizer comes in
contact with interior surfaces of the
vehicle, blot immediately and clean
with a soft cloth dampened with a
mild soap and water solution.
Interior Glass
To clean, use a microfiber cloth fabric
dampened with water. Wipe droplets left
behind with a clean dry cloth. If necessary,
use a commercial glass cleaner after
cleaning with plain water.
Cleaning the windshield with water during
the first three to six months of ownership
will reduce tendency to fog.
Speaker Covers
Vacuum around a speaker cover gently, so
that the speaker will not be damaged. Clean
spots with water and mild soap.
Coated Moldings
Coated moldings should be cleaned.
. When lightly soiled, wipe with a sponge
or soft, lint-free cloth dampened with
water.
. When heavily soiled, use warm soapy
water.
Vinyl/Rubber
If equipped with vinyl floor and rubber floor
mats, use a soft cloth and/or brush
dampened with water to remove dust and
loose dirt. For more thorough cleaning, use
a mild soap and water solution.
221
{ Warning
Do not use cleaners that contain silicone,
wax-based products, or cleaners that
increase gloss on vinyl/rubber floor and
mats. These cleaners can permanently
change the appearance and feel of the
vinyl/rubber and can make the floor
slippery. Your foot could slip while
operating the vehicle, and you could lose
control, resulting in a crash. You or
others could be injured.
Fabric/Carpet/Suede
Start by vacuuming the surface using a soft
brush attachment. If a rotating vacuum
brush attachment is being used, only use it
on the floor carpet. Before cleaning, gently
remove as much of the soil as possible:
. Gently blot liquids with a paper towel.
Continue blotting until no more soil can
be removed.
. For solid soils, remove as much as
possible prior to vacuuming.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
222
Vehicle Care
To clean:
1. Saturate a clean, lint-free colorfast cloth
with water. Microfiber cloth is
recommended to prevent lint transfer to
the fabric or carpet.
2. Remove excess moisture by gently
wringing until water does not drip from
the cleaning cloth.
3. Start on the outside edge of the soil and
gently rub toward the center. Fold the
cleaning cloth to a clean area frequently
to prevent forcing the soil into the
fabric.
4. Continue gently rubbing the soiled area
until there is no longer any color
transfer from the soil to the cleaning
cloth.
5. If the soil is not completely removed,
use a mild soap solution followed only
by plain water.
If the soil is not completely removed, it may
be necessary to use a commercial upholstery
cleaner or spot lifter. Test a small hidden
area for colorfastness before using a
commercial upholstery cleaner or spot lifter.
If ring formation occurs, clean the entire
fabric or carpet.
After cleaning, use a paper towel to blot
excess moisture.
Cleaning High Gloss Surfaces and Vehicle
Information and Radio Displays
Use a microfiber cloth on high gloss surfaces
or vehicle displays. First, use a soft bristle
brush to remove dirt that can scratch the
surface. Then gently clean by rubbing with a
microfiber cloth. Never use window cleaners
or solvents. Periodically hand wash the
microfiber cloth separately, using mild soap.
Do not use bleach or fabric softener. Rinse
thoroughly and air dry before next use.
Caution
Do not attach a device with a suction cup
to the display. This may cause damage
and would not be covered by the vehicle
warranty.
Instrument Panel, Leather, Vinyl, Other
Plastic Surfaces, Low Gloss Paint
Surfaces, and Natural Open Pore Wood
Surfaces
Use a soft bristle brush to remove dust from
knobs and crevices on the instrument
cluster. Use a soft microfiber cloth
dampened with water to remove dust and
loose dirt. For a more thorough cleaning,
use a soft microfiber cloth dampened with a
mild soap and water solution.
Caution
Soaking or saturating leather, especially
perforated leather, as well as other
interior surfaces, may cause permanent
damage. Wipe excess moisture from
these surfaces after cleaning and allow
them to dry naturally. Never use heat,
steam, or spot removers. Do not use
liquids that contain alcohol or solvents on
leather seats. Do not use cleaners that
contain silicone or wax-based products.
Cleaners containing these solvents can
permanently change the appearance and
feel of leather or soft trim, and are not
recommended.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Vehicle Care
Do not use cleaners that increase gloss,
especially on the instrument panel. Reflected
glare can decrease visibility through the
windshield under certain conditions.
Caution
Use of air fresheners may cause
permanent damage to plastics and
painted surfaces. If an air freshener
comes in contact with any plastic or
painted surface in the vehicle, blot
immediately and clean with a soft cloth
dampened with a mild soap solution.
Damage caused by air fresheners would
not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Cargo Cover and Convenience Net
If equipped, wash with warm water and
mild detergent. Do not use chlorine bleach.
Rinse with cold water, and then dry
completely.
Care of Seat Belts
Keep belts clean and dry.
{ Warning
Do not bleach or dye seat belt webbing.
It may severely weaken the webbing. In
a crash, they might not be able to
provide adequate protection. Clean and
rinse seat belt webbing only with mild
soap and lukewarm water. Allow the
webbing to dry.
Floor Mats
{ Warning
If a floor mat is the wrong size or is not
properly installed, it can interfere with
the pedals. Interference with the pedals
can cause unintended acceleration and/or
increased stopping distance which can
cause a crash and injury. Make sure the
floor mat does not interfere with the
pedals.
223
Use the following guidelines for proper floor
mat use:
. The original equipment floor mats are
designed for your vehicle. If the floor
mats need to be replaced, it is
recommended that GM-certified floor
mats are purchased. Non-GM floor mats
may not fit properly and may interfere
with the pedals. Always check that the
floor mats do not interfere with the
pedals.
. Do not use a floor mat if the vehicle is
not equipped with a floor mat retainer on
the driver side floor.
. Use the floor mat with the correct side
up. Do not turn it over.
. Do not place anything on top of the
driver side floor mat.
. Use only a single floor mat on the
driver side.
. Do not place one floor mat on top of
another.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
224
Vehicle Care
Removing and Replacing the Floor Mats
Pull up on the rear of the floor mat to
unlock each retainer and remove.
Reinstall by lining up the floor mat retainer
openings over the carpet retainers and snap
into position.
Make sure the floor mat is properly secured
in place.
Verify the floor mat does not interfere with
the pedals.
Cleaning Rubber Floor Mats (All-Weather
Mats and Floor Liners)
See “Vinyl/Rubber” under Interior Care
0 220 for important cleaning information.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Service and Maintenance
Service and Maintenance
General Information
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Maintenance Schedule
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Special Application Services
Special Application Services . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Additional Maintenance and Care
Additional Maintenance and Care . . . . . . 231
Recommended Fluids, Lubricants, and
Parts
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . 235
Maintenance Records
Maintenance Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
General Information
Your vehicle is an important investment.
This section describes the required
maintenance for the vehicle. Follow this
schedule to help protect against major repair
expenses resulting from neglect or
inadequate maintenance. It may also help to
maintain the value of the vehicle if it is
sold. It is the responsibility of the owner to
have all required maintenance performed.
Your dealer has trained technicians who can
perform required maintenance using genuine
replacement parts. They have up-to-date
tools and equipment for fast and accurate
diagnostics. Many dealers have extended
evening and Saturday hours, courtesy
transportation, and online scheduling to
assist with service needs.
Your dealer recognizes the importance of
providing competitively priced maintenance
and repair services. With trained technicians,
the dealer is the place for routine
maintenance such as oil changes and tire
rotations and additional maintenance items
like tires, brakes, batteries, and wiper blades.
225
Caution
Damage caused by improper maintenance
can lead to costly repairs and may not be
covered by the vehicle warranty.
Maintenance intervals, checks,
inspections, recommended fluids, and
lubricants are important to keep the
vehicle in good working condition.
Do not have chemical flushes that are not
approved by GM performed on the
vehicle. The use of flushes, solvents,
cleaners, or lubricants that are not
approved by GM could damage the
vehicle, requiring expensive repairs that
are not covered by the vehicle warranty.
The Tire Rotation and Required Services are
the responsibility of the vehicle owner. It is
recommended to have your dealer perform
these services every 12 000 km/7,500 mi.
Proper vehicle maintenance helps to keep
the vehicle in good working condition,
improves fuel economy, and reduces vehicle
emissions.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
226
Service and Maintenance
Because of the way people use vehicles,
maintenance needs vary. There may need to
be more frequent checks and services. The
Additional Required Services - Normal are for
vehicles that:
. Carry passengers and cargo within
recommended limits on the Tire and
Loading Information label. See Vehicle
Load Limits 0 129.
. Are driven on reasonable road surfaces
within legal driving limits.
. Use the recommended fuel. See
Recommended Fuel 0 155.
Refer to the information in the Maintenance
Schedule Additional Required Services Normal chart.
The Additional Required Services - Severe are
for vehicles that are:
. Mainly driven in heavy city traffic in hot
weather.
. Mainly driven in hilly or mountainous
terrain.
. Frequently towing a trailer.
. Used for high speed or competitive
driving.
. Used for taxi, police, or delivery service.
Refer to the information in the Maintenance
Schedule Additional Required Services Severe chart.
{ Warning
Performing maintenance work can be
dangerous and can cause serious injury.
Perform maintenance work only if the
required information, proper tools, and
equipment are available. If they are not,
see your dealer to have a trained
technician do the work. See Doing Your
Own Service Work 0 160.
Maintenance Schedule
Owner Checks and Services
Check the engine oil level. See Engine Oil
0 164.
Once a Month
. Check the tire inflation pressures. See Tire
Pressure 0 194.
. Inspect the tires for wear. See Tire
Inspection 0 199.
. Check the windshield washer fluid level.
See Washer Fluid 0 172.
Engine Oil Change
When the : % CHANGE DIC message
displays, have the engine oil and filter
changed within the next 1 000 km/600 mi.
If driven under the best conditions, the
engine oil life system may not indicate the
need for vehicle service for up to a year.
The engine oil and filter must be changed at
least once a year and the oil life system
must be reset. Your trained dealer technician
can perform this work. If the engine oil life
system is reset accidentally, service the
vehicle within 5 000 km/3,000 mi since the
last service. Reset the oil life system when
the oil is changed. See Engine Oil Life
System 0 166.
Air Conditioning Desiccant (Replace Every
Seven Years)
The air conditioning system requires
maintenance every seven years. This service
requires replacement of the desiccant to
help the longevity and efficient operation of
the air conditioning system. This service can
be complex. See your dealer.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Service and Maintenance
Tire Rotation and Required Services
Every 12 000 km/7,500 mi
Rotate the tires, if recommended for the
vehicle, and perform the following services.
See Tire Rotation 0 199.
. Check engine oil level and oil
life percentage. If needed, change engine
oil and filter, and reset oil life system.
See Engine Oil 0 164 and
Engine Oil Life System 0 166.
. Check engine coolant level. See Cooling
System 0 168.
. Check windshield washer fluid level. See
Washer Fluid 0 172.
. Check tire inflation pressures. See Tire
Pressure 0 194.
. Inspect tire wear. See Tire Inspection
0 199.
. Visually check for fluid leaks.
. Inspect engine air cleaner filter. See
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter 0 167.
. Inspect brake system. See Exterior Care
0 216.
. Visually inspect steering, suspension, and
chassis components for damage, including
cracks or tears in the rubber boots, loose
or missing parts, or signs of wear at least
once a year. See Exterior Care 0 216.
. Inspect power steering for proper
.
.
.
.
.
.
attachment, connections, binding, leaks,
cracks, chafing, etc.
Visually inspect halfshafts and drive
shafts for excessive wear, lubricant leaks,
and/or damage including: tube dents or
cracks, constant velocity joint or universal
joint looseness, cracked or missing boots,
loose or missing boot clamps, center
bearing excessive looseness, loose or
missing fasteners, and axle seal leaks.
Check restraint system components. See
Safety System Check 0 36.
Visually inspect the fuel system including
the evaporative (EVAP) system for
damage or leaks. Visually check all fuel
pipes, vapor lines, and hoses for proper
attachment, connection, routing, and
condition.
Visually inspect exhaust system and
nearby heat shields for loose or damaged
parts.
Lubricate body components. See Exterior
Care 0 216.
Check starter switch. See Starter Switch
Check 0 176.
227
. Check automatic transmission shift lock
.
.
.
.
.
control function. See Automatic
Transmission Shift Lock Control Function
Check 0 176.
Check ignition transmission lock. See
Ignition Transmission Lock Check 0 176.
Check parking brake and automatic
transmission park mechanism. See Park
Brake and P (Park) Mechanism Check
0 177.
Check accelerator pedal for damage, high
effort, or binding. Replace if needed.
Visually inspect gas strut for signs of
wear, cracks, or other damage. Check the
hold open ability of the strut. If the hold
open is low, service the gas strut. See Gas
Strut(s) 0 178.
Inspect sunroof track and seal,
if equipped. See Sunroof 0 23.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
4 8 000 km /30, 000 m i
60 000 km /37, 500 m i
72 000 km /4 5, 000 m i
84 000 km /52 , 500 m i
96 000 km /60, 000 m i
1 08 000 km /67, 500 m i
1 2 0 000 km /75, 000 m i
1 32 000 km /82 , 500 m i
1 4 4 000 km /90, 000 m i
1 56 000 km /97, 500 m i
1 68 000 km /1 05, 000 m i
1 80 000 km /1 1 2 , 500 m i
1 92 000 km /1 2 0, 000 m i
2 04 000 km /1 2 7, 500 m i
2 1 6 000 km /1 35, 000 m i
2 2 8 000 km /1 4 2 , 500 m i
2 4 0 000 km /1 50, 000 m i
Rotate tires and perform Required Services. Check engine oil
level and oil life percentage. Change engine oil and filter,
if needed.
36 000 km /2 2 , 500 m i
Maintenance Schedule Additional
Required Services - Normal
2 4 000 km /1 5, 000 m i
Service and Maintenance
1 2 000 km /7, 500 m i
228
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
Replace passenger compartment air filter. (1)
@
@
@
@
Replace engine air cleaner filter. (2)
@
@
@
@
Replace spark plugs. Inspect spark plug wires and/or boots.
@
Change manual transmission fluid, if equipped.
@
Drain and fill engine cooling system. (3)
@
Visually inspect accessory drive belts (4)
@
Replace brake/clutch fluid. (5)
Replace front and rear wiper blades. (6)
Replace hood and/or body lift support gas struts. (7)
Replace air conditioning desiccant. (8)
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Service and Maintenance
Footnotes — Maintenance Schedule
Additional Required Services - Normal
(6) Or every 12 months, whichever comes
first. See Wiper Blade Replacement 0 177.
(1) Or every two years, whichever comes
first. More frequent passenger compartment
air filter replacement may be needed if
driving in areas with heavy traffic, poor air
quality, high dust levels, or environmental
allergens. Passenger compartment air filter
replacement may also be needed if there is
reduced airflow, window fogging, or odors.
Your GM dealer can help determine when to
replace the filter.
(7) Or every 10 years, whichever comes first.
See Gas Strut(s) 0 178.
(2) Or every four years, whichever comes
first. If driving in dusty conditions, inspect
the filter at each oil change or more often
as needed. See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter
0 167.
(3) Or every five years, whichever comes
first. See Cooling System 0 168.
(4) Or every ten years, whichever comes
first. Inspect for fraying, excessive cracking,
or damage; replace, if needed.
(5) If equipped with automatic transmission,
replace brake fluid every five years.
If equipped with manual transmission,
replace brake/clutch fluid every three years.
See Brake Fluid 0 174.
(8) Replace air conditioning desiccant every
seven years.
229
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
4 8 000 km /30, 000 m i
60 000 km /37, 500 m i
72 000 km /4 5, 000 m i
84 000 km /52 , 500 m i
96 000 km /60, 000 m i
1 08 000 km /67, 500 m i
1 2 0 000 km /75, 000 m i
1 32 000 km /82 , 500 m i
1 4 4 000 km /90, 000 m i
1 56 000 km /97, 500 m i
1 68 000 km /1 05, 000 m i
1 80 000 km /1 1 2 , 500 m i
1 92 000 km /1 2 0, 000 m i
2 04 000 km /1 2 7, 500 m i
2 1 6 000 km /1 35, 000 m i
2 2 8 000 km /1 4 2 , 500 m i
2 4 0 000 km /1 50, 000 m i
Rotate tires and perform Required Services. Check engine oil
level and oil life percentage. Change engine oil and filter,
if needed.
36 000 km /2 2 , 500 m i
Maintenance Schedule Additional
Required Services - Severe
2 4 000 km /1 5, 000 m i
Service and Maintenance
1 2 000 km /7, 500 m i
230
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
Replace passenger compartment air filter. (1)
@
@
@
@
Replace engine air cleaner filter. (2)
@
@
@
@
@
Replace spark plugs. Inspect spark plug wires and/or boots.
Change automatic transmission fluid and filter.
@
@
@
Change manual transmission fluid, if equipped.
@
@
@
Drain and fill engine cooling system. (3)
@
Visually inspect accessory drive belts. (4)
@
Replace brake/clutch fluid. (5)
Replace front and rear wiper blades. (6)
Replace hood and/or body lift support gas struts. (7)
Replace air conditioning desiccant. (8)
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
@
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Service and Maintenance
Footnotes — Maintenance Schedule
Additional Required Services - Severe
(6) Or every 12 months, whichever comes
first. See Wiper Blade Replacement 0 177.
(1) Or every two years, whichever comes
first. More frequent passenger compartment
air filter replacement may be needed if
driving in areas with heavy traffic, poor air
quality, high dust levels, or environmental
allergens. Passenger compartment air filter
replacement may also be needed if there is
reduced airflow, window fogging, or odors.
Your GM dealer can help determine when to
replace the filter.
(7) Or every 10 years, whichever comes first.
See Gas Strut(s) 0 178.
(2) Or every four years, whichever comes
first. If driving in dusty conditions, inspect
the filter at each oil change or more often
as needed. See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter
0 167.
(3) Or every five years, whichever comes
first. See Cooling System 0 168.
(4) Or every ten years, whichever comes
first. Inspect for fraying, excessive cracking,
or damage; replace, if needed.
(5) If equipped with automatic transmission,
replace brake fluid every five years.
If equipped with manual transmission,
replace brake/clutch fluid every three years.
See Brake Fluid 0 174.
(8) Replace air conditioning desiccant every
seven years.
231
assessment with a multi-point inspection to
recommend when your vehicle may need
attention.
The following list is intended to explain the
services and conditions to look for that may
indicate services are required.
Battery
Special Application Services
. Severe Commercial Use Vehicles Only:
Lubricate chassis components every oil
change.
. Have underbody flushing service
performed. See "Underbody Maintenance"
in Exterior Care 0 216.
Additional Maintenance
and Care
Your vehicle is an important investment and
caring for it properly may help to avoid
future costly repairs. To maintain vehicle
performance, additional maintenance
services may be required.
It is recommended that your dealer perform
these services — their trained dealer
technicians know your vehicle best. Your
dealer can also perform a thorough
The 12-volt battery supplies power to start
the engine and operate any additional
electrical accessories.
. To avoid break-down or failure to start
the vehicle, maintain a battery with full
cranking power.
. Trained dealer technicians have the
diagnostic equipment to test the battery
and ensure that the connections and
cables are corrosion-free.
Belts
. Belts may need replacing if they squeak
or show signs of cracking or splitting.
. Trained dealer technicians have access to
tools and equipment to inspect the belts
and recommend adjustment or
replacement when necessary.
Brakes
Brakes stop the vehicle and are crucial to
safe driving.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
232
Service and Maintenance
. Signs of brake wear may include chirping,
. Signs that the headlamps need attention
. Signs that the tires need to be replaced
grinding, or squealing noises, or difficulty
stopping.
. Trained dealer technicians have access to
tools and equipment to inspect the brakes
and recommend quality parts engineered
for the vehicle.
include dimming, failure to light, cracking,
or damage. The brake lamps need to be
checked periodically to ensure that they
light when braking.
. With a multi-point inspection, your dealer
can check the lamps and note any
concerns.
include three or more visible treadwear
indicators; cord or fabric showing through
the rubber; cracks or cuts in the tread or
sidewall; or a bulge or split in the tire.
. Trained dealer technicians can inspect and
recommend the right tires. Your dealer
can also provide tire/wheel balancing
services to ensure smooth vehicle
operation at all speeds. Your dealer sells
and services name brand tires.
Fluids
Proper fluid levels and approved fluids
protect the vehicle’s systems and
components. See Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants 0 234 for GM approved fluids.
. Engine oil and windshield washer fluid
levels should be checked at every fuel fill.
. Instrument cluster lights may come on to
indicate that fluids may be low and need
to be filled.
Hoses
Hoses transport fluids and should be
regularly inspected to ensure that there are
no cracks or leaks. With a multi-point
inspection, your dealer can inspect the hoses
and advise if replacement is needed.
Lamps
Properly working headlamps, taillamps, and
brake lamps are important to see and be
seen on the road.
Shocks and Struts
Shocks and struts help aid in control for a
smoother ride.
. Signs of wear may include steering wheel
vibration, bounce/sway while braking,
longer stopping distance, or uneven
tire wear.
. As part of the multi-point inspection,
trained dealer technicians can visually
inspect the shocks and struts for signs of
leaking, blown seals, or damage, and can
advise when service is needed.
Tires
Tires need to be properly inflated, rotated,
and balanced. Maintaining the tires can save
money and fuel, and can reduce the risk of
tire failure.
Vehicle Care
To help keep the vehicle looking like new,
vehicle care products are available from your
dealer. For information on how to clean and
protect the vehicle’s interior and exterior,
see Interior Care 0 220 and
Exterior Care 0 216.
Wheel Alignment
Wheel alignment is critical for ensuring that
the tires deliver optimal wear and
performance.
. Signs that the alignment may need to be
adjusted include pulling, improper vehicle
handling, or unusual tire wear.
. Your dealer has the required equipment
to ensure proper wheel alignment.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Service and Maintenance
Windshield
For safety, appearance, and the best
viewing, keep the windshield clean and
clear.
. Signs of damage include scratches, cracks,
and chips.
. Trained dealer technicians can inspect the
windshield and recommend proper
replacement if needed.
Wiper Blades
Wiper blades need to be cleaned and kept in
good condition to provide a clear view.
. Signs of wear include streaking, skipping
across the windshield, and worn or split
rubber.
. Trained dealer technicians can check the
wiper blades and replace them when
needed.
233
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
234
Service and Maintenance
Recommended Fluids, Lubricants, and Parts
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants
Fluids and lubricants identified below by name or specification, including fluids or lubricants not listed here, can be obtained from your dealer.
Usage
Brake/Clutch Hydraulic System
Fluid/Lubricant
DOT 4 Hydraulic Brake Fluid.
Engine Coolant
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and use only DEX-COOL Coolant. See Cooling System
0 168.
Engine Oil
Engine oil meeting the dexos1 specification of the proper SAE viscosity grade. ACDelco dexos1
full synthetic is recommended. See Engine Oil 0 164.
Hood Latch Assembly, Secondary Latch, Pivots, Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol or lubricant meeting requirements of NLGI #2, Category LB
Spring Anchor, and Release Pawl
or GC-LB.
Key Lock Cylinders, Hood and Door Hinges
Transmission
Windshield Washer
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube. See your dealer.
See your dealer.
Automotive windshield washer fluid that meets regional freeze protection requirements.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Service and Maintenance
Maintenance Replacement Parts
Replacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer.
Part
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter
Engine Oil Filter
GM Part Number
ACDelco Part Number
95238310
A3227C
12696048 / 12706595
PF64
Passenger Compartment Air Filter
95369731
CF202
Spark Plugs
12637197
41-124
95391363
—
95391365
—
95391371
—
Wiper Blades
IDriver Side – 60 cm (23.6 in)
IPassenger Side – 35 cm (13.8 in)
IRear
235
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
236
Service and Maintenance
Maintenance Records
After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the type of services performed
in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts.
Date
Odometer Reading
Serviced By
Services Performed
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Technical Data
Technical Data
Vehicle Identification
Vehicle Identification
Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN)
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . 237
Service Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Vehicle Data
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . 238
Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
237
Engine Identification
The eighth character in the VIN is the
engine code. This code identifies the
vehicle's engine, specifications, and
replacement parts. See “Engine
Specifications” under Capacities and
Specifications 0 238 for the vehicle's
engine code.
Service Parts Identification
This legal identifier is in the front corner of
the instrument panel, on the driver side of
the vehicle. It can be seen through the
windshield from outside. The Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN) also appears on
the Vehicle Certification label and certificates
of title and registration.
There may be a large barcode on the
certification label on the center pillar that
you can scan for the following information:
. Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
. Model designation
. Paint information
. Production options
If there is not a large barcode on this label,
then you will find this same information on
a label inside of the glove box.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
238
Technical Data
Vehicle Data
Capacities and Specifications
The following approximate capacities are given in metric and English conversions. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 234 for more
information.
Application
Air Conditioning Refrigerant
Engine Cooling System*
Capacities
Metric
English
For the air conditioning system refrigerant type and charge
amount, see the refrigerant label under the hood. See your
dealer for more information.
4.8 L
5.0 qt
Engine Oil with Filter
4.0 L
4.2 qt
Fuel Tank
35.0 L
9.0 gal
140 Y
100 lb ft
Wheel Nut Torque
All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in this manual. Recheck fluid level
after filling.
*Engine cooling system capacity values are based on the entire cooling system and its components.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Technical Data
Engine Specifications
Engine
1.4L L4
VIN Code
Transmission
Spark Plug Gap
A
Automatic and Manual
0.80–0.90 mm (0.031–0.035 in)
Spark plug gaps are preset by the manufacturer. Re-gapping the spark plug is not recommended and can damage the spark plug.
239
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
240
Technical Data
Engine Drive Belt Routing
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Customer Information
Customer Information
Customer Information
Customer Information
Customer Satisfaction Procedure
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . 241
Customer Assistance Offices . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Customer Assistance for Text Telephone
(TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
GM Mobility Reimbursement
Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . 244
Scheduling Service Appointments . . . . . . 245
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . 245
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Publication Ordering Information . . . . . . 248
Radio Frequency Statement . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Reporting Safety Defects
Reporting Safety Defects to the United
States Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Reporting Safety Defects to the
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Reporting Safety Defects to General
Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . 250
Cybersecurity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Your satisfaction and goodwill are important
to your dealer and to Chevrolet. Normally,
any concerns with the sales transaction or
the operation of the vehicle will be resolved
by your dealer's sales or service
departments. Sometimes, however, despite
the best intentions of all concerned,
misunderstandings can occur. If your concern
has not been resolved to your satisfaction,
the following steps should be taken:
STEP ONE : Discuss your concern with a
member of dealership management.
Normally, concerns can be quickly resolved
at that level. If the matter has already been
reviewed with the sales, service, or parts
manager, contact the owner of your
dealership or the general manager.
STEP TWO : If after contacting a member of
dealership management, it appears your
concern cannot be resolved by your
dealership without further help, in the U.S.,
call the Chevrolet Customer Assistance
Center at 1-800-222-1020. In Canada, call
General Motors of Canada Customer Care
Centre at 1-800-263-3777 (English),
or 1-800-263-7854 (French).
241
We encourage you to call the toll-free
number in order to give your inquiry
prompt attention. Have the following
information available to give the Customer
Assistance representative:
. Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). This is
available from the vehicle registration or
title, or the plate at the top left of the
instrument panel and visible through the
windshield.
. Dealership name and location.
. Vehicle delivery date and present mileage.
When contacting Chevrolet, remember that
your concern will likely be resolved at a
dealer's facility. That is why we suggest
following Step One first.
STEP THREE — U.S. Owners : Both General
Motors and your dealer are committed to
making sure you are completely satisfied
with your new vehicle. However, if you
continue to remain unsatisfied after
following the procedure outlined in
Steps One and Two, you can file with the
Better Business Bureau (BBB) AUTO LINE
Program to enforce your rights.
The BBB AUTO LINE Program is an
out-of-court program administered by BBB
National Programs, Inc. to settle automotive
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
242
Customer Information
General Motors reserves the right to change
eligibility limitations and/or discontinue its
participation in this program.
or call the General Motors Customer Care
Centre, 1-800-263-3777 (English),
1-800-263-7854 (French), or write to:
The Mediation/Arbitration Program
c/o Customer Care Centre
General Motors of Canada Company
Mail Code: CA1-163-005
1908 Colonel Sam Drive
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7
Telephone: 1-800-955-5100
http://www.bbb.org/council/
programs-services/
dispute-handling-and-resolution/bbb-auto-line
STEP THREE — Canadian Owners : In the
event that you do not feel your concerns
have been addressed after following the
procedure outlined in Steps One and Two,
General Motors of Canada Company wants
you to be aware of its participation in a
no-charge Mediation/Arbitration Program.
General Motors of Canada Company has
committed to binding arbitration of owner
disputes involving factory-related vehicle
service claims. The program provides for the
review of the facts involved by an impartial
third party arbiter, and may include an
informal hearing before the arbiter. The
program is designed so that the entire
dispute settlement process, from the time
you file your complaint to the final decision,
should be completed in about 70 days. We
believe our impartial program offers
advantages over courts in most jurisdictions
because it is informal, quick, and free of
charge.
This program is available in all 50 states and
the District of Columbia. Eligibility is limited
by vehicle age, mileage, and other factors.
For further information concerning eligibility
in the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration
Plan (CAMVAP), call toll-free 1-800-207-0685,
1-800-222-1020
1-800-833-2438 (For Text Telephone Devices
(TTYs))
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-243-8872
disputes regarding vehicle repairs or the
interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. Although you may be required to
resort to this informal dispute resolution
program prior to filing a court action, use of
the program is free of charge and your case
will generally be heard within 40 days.
If you do not agree with the decision given
in your case, you may reject it and proceed
with any other venue for relief available
to you.
You may contact the BBB AUTO LINE
Program using the toll-free telephone
number or write them at the following
address:
BBB AUTO LINE a Division of
BBB National Programs, Inc.
1676 International Drive
Suite 550
McLean, VA 22102
Your inquiry should be accompanied by the
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
Customer Assistance Offices
Chevrolet encourages customers to call the
toll-free number for assistance. However, if a
customer wishes to write or e-mail
Chevrolet, the letter should be addressed to:
United States and Puerto Rico
Chevrolet Motor Division
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center
P.O. Box 33170
Detroit, MI 48232-5170
www.Chevrolet.com
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Customer Information
From U.S. Virgin Islands:
1-800-496-9994
Canada
General Motors of Canada Company
Customer Care Centre, Mail Code:
CA1-163-005
1908 Colonel Sam Drive
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7
www.gm.ca
1-800-263-3777 (English)
1-800-263-7854 (French)
1-800-263-3830 (For Text Telephone devices
(TTYs))
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-268-6800
Overseas
Please contact the local General Motors
Business Unit.
Customer Assistance for Text
Telephone (TTY) Users
To assist customers who are deaf, hard of
hearing, or speech-impaired and who use
Text Telephones (TTYs), Chevrolet has TTY
equipment available at its Customer
Assistance Center. Any TTY user in the U.S.
can communicate with Chevrolet by dialing:
1-800-833-2438. TTY users in Canada can dial
1-800-263-3830.
J : View active recalls by Vehicle
Online Owner Center
H : Manage your profile and payment
The Chevrolet Owner Center (U.S.)
my.chevrolet.com
Learn more about your vehicle features,
shop for and manage your connected
services and OnStar plans, and access
diagnostic information specific to your
vehicle.
Membership Benefits
E : Download owner’s manuals and view
vehicle-specific how-to videos.
G : View maintenance schedules, alerts, and
Vehicle Diagnostic Information. Schedule
service appointments.
I : View service records from your
dealership and add your own.
D : Select a preferred dealer and view
locations, maps, phone numbers, and hours.
r : Track your vehicle’s warranty
information.
243
Identification Number (VIN). See Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN) 0 237.
information. View your GM Rewards Card
earnings and My Chevrolet Rewards points.
F : Chat with online help representatives.
Visit my.chevrolet.com and create an
account today.
Chevrolet Owner Centre (Canada)
mychevrolet.ca
Visit the Chevrolet Owner Centre at
mychevrolet.ca (English) or my.chevrolet.ca
(French) to access similar benefits to the
U.S. site.
GM Mobility Reimbursement
Program
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
244
Customer Information
This program is available to qualified
applicants for cost reimbursement, up to
certain limits, of eligible aftermarket
adaptive equipment required for the vehicle,
such as hand controls or a wheelchair/
scooter lift for the vehicle.
To learn about the GM Mobility program,
see www.gmmobility.com or call the GM
Mobility Assistance Center at 1-800-323-9935.
Text Telephone (TTY) users, call
1-800-833-9935.
General Motors of Canada also has a
Mobility program. See www.gm.ca, or call
1-800-GM-DRIVE (800-463-7483) for details.
TTY users call 1-800-263-3830.
Roadside Assistance Program
For U.S.-purchased vehicles, call
1-800-243-8872. (Text Telephone (TTY):
1-888-889-2438.)
For Canadian-purchased vehicles, call
1-800-268-6800.
Service is available 24 hours a day, 365 days
a year.
Calling for Assistance
When calling Roadside Assistance, have the
following information ready:
. Your name, home address, and home
telephone number
. Telephone number of your location
. Location of the vehicle
. Model, year, color, and license plate
number of the vehicle
. Odometer reading, Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN), and delivery date of the
vehicle
. Description of the problem
Coverage
Services are provided for the duration of the
vehicle’s powertrain warranty.
In the U.S., anyone driving the vehicle is
covered. In Canada, a person driving the
vehicle without permission from the owner
is not covered.
Roadside Assistance is not a part of the New
Vehicle Limited Warranty. General Motors
North America and Chevrolet reserve the
right to make any changes or discontinue
the Roadside Assistance program at any
time without notification.
General Motors North America and Chevrolet
reserve the right to limit services or
payment to an owner or driver if they
decide the claims are made too often, or the
same type of claim is made many times.
Services Provided
. Emergency Fuel Delivery: Delivery of
enough fuel for the vehicle to get to the
nearest service station.
. Lock-Out Service: Service to unlock the
vehicle if you are locked out. A remote
unlock may be available if you have
OnStar. For security reasons, the driver
must present identification before this
service is given.
. Emergency Tow from a Public Road or
Highway: Tow to the nearest Chevrolet
dealer for warranty service, or if the
vehicle was in a crash and cannot be
driven. Assistance is not given when the
vehicle is stuck in the sand, mud,
or snow.
. Flat Tire Change: Service to change a flat
tire with the spare tire. The spare tire,
if equipped, must be in good condition
and properly inflated. It is the owner's
responsibility for the repair or
replacement of the tire if it is not covered
by the warranty.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Customer Information
. Battery Jump Start: Service to jump start
a dead battery.
. Trip Interruption Benefits and Assistance:
If your trip is interrupted due to a
warranty event, incidental expenses may
be reimbursed within the Powertrain
warranty period. Items considered are
reasonable and customary hotel, meals,
rental car, or a vehicle being delivered
back to the customer, up to 500 miles.
Services Not Included in Roadside
Assistance
. Impound towing caused by violation of
any laws
. Legal fines
. Mounting, dismounting, or changing of
snow tires, chains, or other traction
devices
Service is not provided if a vehicle is in an
area that is not accessible to the service
vehicle or is not a regularly traveled or
maintained public road, which includes ice
and winter roads. Off-road use is not
covered.
Services Specific to Canadian-Purchased
Vehicles
. Fuel Delivery: Reimbursement is up to
7 liters. Propane and other fuels are not
provided through this service.
. Lock-Out Service: Vehicle registration is
required.
. Trip Interruption Benefits and Assistance:
Must be over 150 km from where your
trip was started to qualify.
Pre-authorization, original detailed
receipts, and a copy of the repair orders
are required. Once authorization has been
received, the Roadside Assistance advisor
will help to make arrangements and
explain how to receive payment.
. Alternative Service: If assistance cannot
be provided right away, the Roadside
Assistance advisor may give permission to
get local emergency road service. You will
receive payment, up to $100, after
sending the original receipt to Roadside
Assistance. Mechanical failures may be
covered, however any cost for parts and
labor for repairs not covered by the
warranty are the owner responsibility.
245
Scheduling Service Appointments
When the vehicle requires warranty service,
contact your dealer and request an
appointment. By scheduling a service
appointment and advising the service
consultant of your transportation needs,
your dealer can help minimize your
inconvenience.
If the vehicle cannot be scheduled into the
service department immediately, keep
driving it until it can be scheduled for
service, unless, of course, the problem is
safety related. If it is, please call your
dealership, let them know this, and ask for
instructions.
If your dealer requests you to bring the
vehicle for service, you are urged to do so
as early in the work day as possible to
allow for same-day repair.
Courtesy Transportation Program
To enhance your ownership experience, we
and our participating dealers are proud to
offer Courtesy Transportation, a customer
support program for vehicles with the
Bumper-to-Bumper (Base Warranty Coverage
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
246
Customer Information
period in Canada), Federal Emission,
Extended Powertrain or Electric specific
warranties in both the U.S. and Canada.
Several Courtesy Transportation options are
available to assist in reducing inconvenience
when warranty repairs are required.
Courtesy Transportation is not a part of the
New Vehicle Limited Warranty. A separate
manual entitled “Limited Warranty and
Owner Assistance Information” furnished
with each new vehicle provides detailed
warranty coverage information.
Transportation Options
Warranty service can generally be
completed while you wait. However, if you
are unable to do so, your dealer may offer
the following transportation options:
Shuttle Service
This includes one-way or round-trip shuttle
service within reasonable time and distance
parameters of your dealer's area.
Public Transportation or Fuel Reimbursement
If overnight warranty repairs are needed,
and public transportation is used, the
expense must be supported by original
receipts and within the maximum amount
allowed by GM. If U.S. customers arrange
their own transportation, limited
reimbursement for reasonable fuel expenses
may be available. Claim amounts should
reflect actual costs and be supported by
original receipts. See your dealer for
information.
General Motors reserves the right to
unilaterally modify, change, or discontinue
Courtesy Transportation at any time and to
resolve all questions of claim eligibility
pursuant to the terms and conditions
described herein at its sole discretion.
Courtesy Rental Vehicle
Collision Damage Repair
For an overnight warranty repair, the dealer
may provide an available courtesy rental
vehicle or provide for reimbursement of a
rental vehicle. Reimbursement is limited and
must be supported by original receipts as
well as a signed and completed rental
agreement and meet state/provincial, local,
and rental vehicle provider requirements.
Requirements vary and may include
minimum age requirements, insurance
coverage, credit card, etc. Additional fees
such as fuel, rental vehicle insurance, taxes,
levies, usage fees, excessive mileage,
or rental usage beyond the completion of
the repair are also your responsibility.
It may not be possible to provide a like
vehicle as a courtesy rental.
Additional Program Information
All program options, such as shuttle service,
may not be available at every dealer.
Contact your dealer for specific availability.
If the vehicle is involved in a collision and it
is damaged, have the damage repaired by a
qualified technician using the proper
equipment and quality replacement parts.
Poorly performed collision repairs diminish
the vehicle resale value, and safety
performance can be compromised in
subsequent collisions.
Collision Parts
Genuine GM Collision parts are new parts
made with the same materials and
construction methods as the parts with
which the vehicle was originally built.
Genuine GM Collision parts are the best
choice to ensure that the vehicle's designed
appearance, durability, and safety are
preserved. The use of Genuine GM parts can
help maintain the GM New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Customer Information
Recycled original equipment parts may also
be used for repair. These parts are typically
removed from vehicles that were total losses
in prior crashes. In most cases, the parts
being recycled are from undamaged sections
of the vehicle. A recycled original equipment
GM part may be an acceptable choice to
maintain the vehicle's originally designed
appearance and safety performance;
however, the history of these parts is not
known. Such parts are not covered by the
GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any
related failures are not covered by that
warranty.
Aftermarket collision parts are also available.
These are made by companies other than
GM and may not have been tested for the
vehicle. As a result, these parts may fit
poorly, exhibit premature durability/
corrosion problems, and may not perform
properly in subsequent collisions.
Aftermarket parts are not covered by the
GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any
vehicle failure related to such parts is not
covered by that warranty.
Repair Facility
GM also recommends that you choose a
collision repair facility that meets your
needs before you ever need collision repairs.
Your dealer may have a collision repair
center with GM-trained technicians and
state-of-the-art equipment, or be able to
recommend a collision repair center that has
GM-trained technicians and comparable
equipment.
Insuring the Vehicle
Protect your investment in the GM vehicle
with comprehensive and collision insurance
coverage. There are significant differences in
the quality of coverage afforded by various
insurance policy terms. Many insurance
policies provide reduced protection to the
GM vehicle by limiting compensation for
damage repairs through the use of
aftermarket collision parts. Some insurance
companies will not specify aftermarket
collision parts. When purchasing insurance,
we recommend that you ensure that the
vehicle will be repaired with GM original
equipment collision parts. If such insurance
coverage is not available from your current
insurance carrier, consider switching to
another insurance carrier.
If the vehicle is leased, the leasing company
may require you to have insurance that
ensures repairs with Genuine GM Original
Equipment Manufacturer (OEM) parts or
Genuine Manufacturer replacement parts.
247
Read the lease carefully, as you may be
charged at the end of the lease for poor
quality repairs.
If a Crash Occurs
If there has been an injury, call emergency
services for help. Do not leave the scene of
a crash until all matters have been taken
care of. Move the vehicle only if its position
puts you in danger, or you are instructed to
move it by a police officer.
Give only the necessary information to
police and other parties involved in the
crash.
For emergency towing see Roadside
Assistance Program 0 244.
Gather the following information:
. Driver name, address, and telephone
number
. Driver license number
. Owner name, address, and telephone
number
. Vehicle license plate number
. Vehicle make, model, and model year
. Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
. Insurance company and policy number
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
248
Customer Information
. General description of the damage to the
other vehicle
Choose a reputable repair facility that uses
quality replacement parts. See “Collision
Parts” earlier in this section.
If the airbag has inflated, see What Will You
See after an Airbag Inflates? 0 41.
Managing the Vehicle Damage Repair
Process
In the event that the vehicle requires
damage repairs, GM recommends that you
take an active role in its repair. If you have
a pre-determined repair facility of choice,
take the vehicle there, or have it towed
there. Specify to the facility that any
required replacement collision parts be
original equipment parts, either new
Genuine GM parts or recycled original GM
parts. Remember, recycled parts will not be
covered by the GM vehicle warranty.
Insurance pays the bill for the repair, but
you must live with the repair. Depending on
your policy limits, your insurance company
may initially value the repair using
aftermarket parts. Discuss this with the
repair professional, and insist on Genuine
GM parts. Remember, if the vehicle is
leased, you may be obligated to have the
vehicle repaired with Genuine GM parts,
even if your insurance coverage does not
pay the full cost.
If another party's insurance company is
paying for the repairs, you are not obligated
to accept a repair valuation based on that
insurance company's collision policy repair
limits, as you have no contractual limits
with that company. In such cases, you can
have control of the repair and parts choices
as long as the cost stays within reasonable
limits.
Publication Ordering Information
Service Manuals
Service manuals have the diagnosis and
repair information on the engine,
transmission, axle, suspension, brakes,
electrical system, steering system, body, etc.
Customer Literature
Owner’s manuals are written specifically for
owners and are intended to provide basic
operational information about the vehicle.
The owner’s manual includes the
Maintenance Schedule for all models.
Customer literature publications available for
purchase include owner’s manuals, warranty
manuals, and portfolios. Portfolios include an
owner’s manual, warranty manual,
if applicable, and zip lock bag or pouch.
Current and Past Models
Service manuals and customer literature are
available for many current and past model
year GM vehicles.
To order, call 1-800-551-4123 Monday–Friday,
8:00 a.m.–6:00 p.m. eastern time
For credit card orders only (VISA,
MasterCard, or Discover), see Helm, Inc. at:
www.helminc.com.
To order by mail, write to:
Helm, Incorporated
Attention: Customer Service
47911 Halyard Drive
Plymouth, MI 48170
Make checks payable in U.S. funds.
Radio Frequency Statement
This vehicle uses license-exempt
transmitters / receivers / systems that
operate on a radio frequency that complies
with Part 15/Part 18 of the Federal
Communications Commission (FCC) rules and
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Customer Information
with Innovation, Science and Economic
Development (ISED) Canada's license-exempt
RSS(s) / RSP-100 / ICES-GEN.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. The device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. The device must accept any interference
received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the device.
Changes or modifications to any of these
systems by other than an authorized service
facility could void authorization to use this
equipment.
Reporting Safety Defects
Reporting Safety Defects to the
United States Government
If you believe that your vehicle has a
defect which could cause a crash or
could cause injury or death, you should
immediately inform the National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying General
Motors.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it
may open an investigation, and if it
finds that a safety defect exists in a
group of vehicles, it may order a recall
and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA
cannot become involved in individual
problems between you, your dealer,
or General Motors.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at
1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go
to http://www.safercar.gov; or
write to:
Administrator, NHTSA
1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E.
Washington, D.C. 20590
You can also obtain other information
about motor vehicle safety from
http://www.safercar.gov.
Reporting Safety Defects to the
Canadian Government
If you live in Canada, and you believe
that the vehicle has a safety defect,
notify Transport Canada immediately,
249
and notify General Motors of Canada
Company. Call Transport Canada at
1-800-333-0510; go to:
www.tc.gc.ca/recalls (English)
www.tc.gc.ca/rappels (French)
or write to:
Transport Canada
Motor Vehicle Safety Directorate
Defect Investigations and Recalls
Division
80 Noel Street
Gatineau, QC J8Z 0A1
Reporting Safety Defects to
General Motors
In addition to notifying NHTSA (or Transport
Canada) in a situation like this, notify
General Motors.
In the U.S., call 1-800-222-1020, or write:
Chevrolet Motor Division
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center
P.O. Box 33170
Detroit, MI 48232-5170
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
250
Customer Information
In Canada, call 1-800-263-3777 (English) or
1-800-263-7854 (French), or write:
General Motors of Canada Company
Customer Care Centre, Mail Code:
CA1-163-005
1908 Colonel Sam Drive
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7
In Mexico, call 800-466-0811 or
800-508-0000.
In other Central America and Caribbean
Countries, call 52-555-901-2369.
Vehicle Data Recording and
Privacy
The vehicle has a number of computers that
record information about the vehicle’s
performance and how it is driven or used.
For example, the vehicle uses computer
modules to monitor and control engine and
transmission performance, to monitor the
conditions for airbag deployment and
deploy them in a crash, and, if equipped, to
provide antilock braking to help the driver
control the vehicle. These modules may
store data to help the dealer technician
service the vehicle or to help GM improve
safety or features. Some modules may also
store data about how the vehicle is
operated, such as rate of fuel consumption
or average speed. These modules may retain
personal preferences, such as radio presets,
seat positions, and temperature settings.
Cybersecurity
GM collects information about the use of
your vehicle including operational and safety
related information. We collect this
information to provide, evaluate, improve,
and troubleshoot our products and services
and to develop new products and services.
The protection of vehicle electronics systems
and customer data from unauthorized
outside electronic access or control is
important to GM. GM maintains appropriate
security standards, practices, guidelines and
controls aimed at defending the vehicle and
the vehicle service ecosystem against
unauthorized electronic access, detecting
possible malicious activity in related
networks, and responding to suspected
cybersecurity incidents in a timely,
coordinated and effective manner. Security
incidents could impact your safety or
compromise your private data. To minimize
security risks, please do not connect your
vehicle electronic systems to unauthorized
devices or connect your vehicle to any
unknown or untrusted networks (such as
Bluetooth, WIFI or similar technology). In
the event you suspect any security incident
impacting your data or the safe operation of
your vehicle, please stop operating your
vehicle and contact your dealer.
Event Data Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with an event data
recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR
is to record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an air bag
deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data
that will assist in understanding how a
vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is
designed to record data related to vehicle
dynamics and safety systems for a short
period of time, typically 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record
such data as:
. How various systems in your vehicle were
operating;
. Whether or not the driver and passenger
safety belts were buckled/fastened;
. How far (if at all) the driver was
depressing the accelerator and/or brake
pedal; and,
. How fast the vehicle was traveling.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Customer Information
These data can help provide a better
understanding of the circumstances in which
crashes and injuries occur.
Note
EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only
if a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no
data are recorded by the EDR under normal
driving conditions and no personal data
(e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location)
are recorded. However, other parties, such
as law enforcement, could combine the EDR
data with the type of personally identifying
data routinely acquired during a crash
investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special
equipment is required, and access to the
vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to
the vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such
as law enforcement, that have the special
equipment, can read the information if they
have access to the vehicle or the EDR.
GM will not access these data or share it
with others except: with the consent of the
vehicle owner or, if the vehicle is leased,
with the consent of the lessee; in response
to an official request by police or similar
government office; as part of GM's defense
of litigation through the discovery process;
or, as permitted by law. Data that GM
collects or receives may also be used for GM
research needs or may be made available to
others for research purposes, where a need
is shown and the data is not tied to a
specific vehicle or vehicle owner.
OnStar
If the vehicle is equipped with OnStar and
has an active service plan, additional data
may be collected and transmitted through
the OnStar system. This includes information
about the vehicle’s operation; collisions
involving the vehicle; the use of the vehicle
and its features, including infotainment; and
the location and approximate GPS speed of
the vehicle. Refer to the OnStar Terms and
Conditions and Privacy Statement on the
OnStar website.
See OnStar Additional Information 0 254.
251
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
252
OnStar
OnStar
OnStar Overview
The OnStar system status light is next to
the OnStar buttons. If the status light is:
. Solid Green: System is ready.
. Flashing Green: On a call.
. Red: Indicates a problem.
. Off: System is off. Press Q twice to
speak with an OnStar Advisor.
= Voice Command Button
Q Blue OnStar Button
> Red Emergency Button
Press Q or call 1-888-4ONSTAR
(1-888-466-7827) to speak to an Advisor.
OnStar Overview
OnStar Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
OnStar Services
Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
OnStar Additional Information
OnStar Additional Information . . . . . . . . . 254
This vehicle may be equipped with a
comprehensive, in-vehicle system that can
connect to an OnStar Advisor for Emergency,
Security, Navigation, Connections, and
Diagnostics Services. OnStar services may
require a paid service plan and data plan.
OnStar requires the vehicle battery and
electrical system, cellular service, and GPS
satellite signals to be available and
operating. OnStar acts as a link to existing
emergency service providers. OnStar may
collect information about you and your
vehicle, including location information. See
OnStar User Terms, Privacy Statement, and
Software Terms for more details including
system limitations at www.onstar.com (U.S.)
or www.onstar.ca (Canada).
Functionality of the Voice Command button
may vary by vehicle and region.
Press
= to:
. Open the OnStar app on the infotainment
display. If equipped, the infotainment
system has OnStar controls in the
embedded OnStar app on the Home Page.
Most OnStar functions that can be
performed with the buttons can be done
using the app. To open the app, touch the
OnStar icon on the Home Page. App
updates require a corresponding service
plan. Features vary by region and model.
Features are subject to change. For more
information, see my.chevrolet.com/learn
or press Q.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
OnStar
Or
. Give OnStar Turn-by-Turn Navigation voice
commands.
. Obtain and customize the Wi-Fi hotspot
name or SSID and password, if equipped.
Press
Q to connect to an Advisor to:
. Verify account information or update
contact information.
. Get driving directions.
. Receive a Diagnostic check of the vehicle's
key operating systems.
. Receive Roadside Assistance.
. Manage Wi-Fi Settings, if equipped.
Press > to get a priority connection to an
OnStar Advisor available 24/7 to:
. Get help for an emergency.
. Be a Good Samaritan or respond to an
AMBER Alert.
. Get assistance in severe weather or other
crisis situations and find evacuation
routes.
253
OnStar Services
Security
Emergency
If equipped, OnStar provides these services:
. With Stolen Vehicle Assistance, OnStar
Advisors can use GPS to pinpoint the
vehicle and help authorities quickly
recover it.
. With Remote Ignition Block, if equipped,
OnStar can block the engine from being
restarted.
. With Stolen Vehicle Slowdown,
if equipped, OnStar can work with law
enforcement to gradually slow the
vehicle down.
Emergency Services require an active safety
and security plan. With Automatic Crash
Response, built-in sensors can automatically
alert a specially trained OnStar Advisor who
is immediately connected in to the vehicle
to help.
Press > for a priority connection to an
OnStar Advisor who can contact emergency
service providers, direct them to your exact
location, and relay important information.
With OnStar Crisis Assist, specially trained
Advisors are available 24 hours a day, 7 days
a week, to provide a central point of
contact, assistance, and information during a
crisis.
With Roadside Assistance, Advisors can
locate a nearby service provider to help with
a flat tire, a battery jump, or an empty
gas tank.
Theft Alarm Notification
If equipped, if the doors are locked and the
vehicle alarm sounds, a notification by text,
e-mail, or phone call will be sent. If the
vehicle is stolen, an OnStar Advisor can work
with authorities to recover the vehicle.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
254
OnStar
OnStar Additional
Information
In-Vehicle Audio Messages
Audio messages may play important
information at the following times:
. Prior to vehicle purchase. Press Q to set
up an account.
. After change in ownership and at
90 days.
Transferring Service
Press Q to request account transfer
eligibility information. The Advisor can
cancel or change account information.
Selling/Transferring the Vehicle
Call 1-888-4ONSTAR (1-888-466-7827)
immediately to terminate your OnStar or
connected services if the vehicle is disposed
of, sold, transferred, or if the lease ends.
Reactivation for Subsequent Owners
Press Q and follow the prompts to speak to
an Advisor as soon as possible. The Advisor
will update vehicle records and explain
OnStar or connected service options.
How OnStar Service Works
Automatic Crash Response, Emergency
Services, Crisis Assist, Stolen Vehicle
Assistance, Remote Services, and Roadside
Assistance are available on most vehicles.
Not all OnStar services are available
everywhere or on all vehicles. For more
information, a full description of OnStar
services, system limitations, and OnStar User
Terms, Privacy Statement, and Software
Terms:
. Call 1-888-4ONSTAR (1-888-466-7827).
. See www.onstar.com (U.S.).
. See www.onstar.ca (Canada).
. Call TTY 1-877-248-2080.
. Press Q to speak with an Advisor.
OnStar or connected services cannot work
unless the vehicle is in a place where OnStar
has an agreement with a wireless service
provider for service in that area. The
wireless service provider must also have
coverage, network capacity, reception, and
technology compatible with OnStar or
connected services. Service involving location
information about the vehicle cannot work
unless GPS signals are available,
unobstructed, and compatible with the
OnStar hardware. OnStar or connected
services may not work if the OnStar
equipment is not properly installed or it has
not been properly maintained. If equipment
or software is added, connected,
or modified, OnStar or connected services
may not work. Other problems beyond the
control of OnStar — such as hills, tall
buildings, tunnels, weather, electrical system
design and architecture of the vehicle,
damage to the vehicle in a crash, or wireless
phone network congestion or jamming —
may prevent service.
See Radio Frequency Statement 0 248.
Services for People with Disabilities
Advisors provide services to help with
physical disabilities and medical conditions.
Press Q to help:
. Locate a gas station with an attendant to
pump gas.
. Find a hotel, restaurant, etc., that meets
accessibility needs.
. Provide directions to the closest hospital
or pharmacy in urgent situations.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
OnStar
TTY Users
Languages
OnStar has the ability to communicate to
deaf, hard-of-hearing, or speech-impaired
customers while in the vehicle. The available
TTY system can provide in-vehicle access to
all OnStar services, except Virtual Advisor
and OnStar Turn-by-Turn Navigation.
The vehicle can be programmed to respond
in multiple languages. Press Q and ask for
an Advisor. Advisors are available in English,
Spanish, and French. Available languages
may vary by country.
If equipped, TTY mode can be turned on or
off by touching Settings, then Apps, and
then Phone. When TTY mode is on, phone
calls can be made or received with OnStar
using the infotainment display.
OnStar Personal Identification
Number (PIN)
A PIN is needed to access some OnStar
services. The PIN will need to be changed
the first time when speaking with an
Advisor. To change the OnStar PIN, contact
an OnStar Advisor by pressing Q or calling
1-888-4ONSTAR.
Warranty
OnStar equipment may be warranted as part
of the vehicle warranty.
Potential Issues
OnStar cannot perform Remote Door Unlock
or Stolen Vehicle Assistance after the vehicle
has been off continuously for an extended
period of time without an ignition cycle. To
find out the duration of time that applies
for the vehicle, contact an OnStar Advisor by
pressing Q or calling 1-888-4ONSTAR. If the
vehicle has not been started for an extended
period of time, OnStar can contact Roadside
Assistance or a locksmith to help gain access
to the vehicle.
Global Positioning System (GPS)
. Obstruction of the GPS can occur in a
large city with tall buildings; in parking
garages; around airports; in tunnels and
underpasses; or in an area with very
dense trees. If GPS signals are not
available, the OnStar system should still
255
operate to call OnStar. However, OnStar
could have difficulty identifying the exact
location.
. In emergency situations, OnStar can use
the last stored GPS location to send to
emergency responders.
A temporary loss of GPS can cause loss of
the ability to send a Turn-by-Turn
Navigation route. The Advisor may give a
verbal route or may ask for a call back after
the vehicle is driven into an open area.
Cellular and GPS Antennas
Cellular reception is required for OnStar to
send remote signals to the vehicle. Do not
place items over or near the antenna to
prevent blocking cellular and GPS signal
reception.
Unable to Connect to OnStar Message
If there is limited cellular coverage or the
cellular network has reached maximum
capacity, this message may come on. Press
Q to try the call again or try again after
driving a few miles into another
cellular area.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
256
OnStar
Vehicle and Power Issues
OnStar services require a vehicle electrical
system, wireless service, and GPS satellite
technologies to be available and operating
for features to function properly. These
systems may not operate if the battery is
discharged or disconnected.
Add-on Electrical Equipment
The OnStar system is integrated into the
electrical architecture of the vehicle. Do not
add any electrical equipment. See Add-On
Electrical Equipment 0 158. Added electrical
equipment may interfere with the operation
of the OnStar system and cause it to not
operate.
Vehicle Software Updates
OnStar or GM may remotely deliver
software updates or changes to the vehicle
without further notice or consent. These
updates or changes may enhance or
maintain safety, security, or the operation
of the vehicle or the vehicle systems.
Software updates or changes may affect or
erase data or settings that are stored in the
vehicle, such as saved navigation
destinations or pre-set radio stations.
Neither OnStar nor GM is responsible for
any affected or erased data or settings.
These updates or changes may also collect
personal information. Such collection is
described in the OnStar privacy statement or
separately disclosed at the time of
installation. These updates or changes may
also cause a system to automatically
communicate with GM servers to collect
information about vehicle system status,
identify whether updates or changes are
available, or deliver updates or changes. An
active OnStar agreement constitutes consent
to these software updates or changes and
agreement that either OnStar or GM may
remotely deliver them to the vehicle.
Privacy
The complete OnStar Privacy Statement may
be found at www.onstar.com (U.S.),
or www.onstar.ca (Canada). We recommend
that you review it. If you have any
questions, call 1-888-4ONSTAR
(1-888-466-7827) or press Q to speak with
an Advisor. Users of wireless
communications are cautioned that the
privacy of any information sent via wireless
cellular communications cannot be assured.
Third parties may unlawfully intercept or
access transmissions and private
communications without consent.
OnStar - Software Acknowledgements
To obtain the source code under GPL, LGPL,
MPL, and other open source licenses, that is
contained in this product, please visit
http://opensource.lge.com. In addition to
the source code, all referred license terms,
warranty disclaimers, and copyright notices
are available for download. This offer is valid
for a period of three years after our last
shipment of this product. This offer is valid
to anyone in receipt of this information.
*Provided through LG Electronics Inc., who is
solely responsible for provisions of related
OSS compliance.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Connected Services
Connected Services
Connected Services
Connected Services
Navigation
Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Navigation requires a specific OnStar or
connected service plan.
Press Q to receive Turn-by-Turn directions
or have them sent to the vehicle’s
navigation screen, if equipped. Select
Turn-by-Turn Directions from the Services
tab of the OnStar app to call an Advisor or
select a recent or favorite destination. Touch
the navigation icons to select home, address,
or place. A destination transfer from OnStar
will show the detail view of the destination
when it is transferred from OnStar to the
Navigation application. See www.onstar.com
for a coverage map. Services vary by model.
Map coverage is available in the United
States and Canada.
Turn-by-Turn Navigation
1. Press Q to connect to an Advisor.
2. Request directions to be downloaded to
the vehicle.
3. Follow the voice-guided commands.
257
Using Voice Commands During a
Planned Route
Functionality of the Voice Command button,
if equipped, may vary by vehicle and region.
For some vehicles, press = to open the
OnStar app on the infotainment display.
Send Destination to Vehicle
Directions can be sent to the vehicle’s
navigation screen, if equipped.
Press Q, then ask the Advisor to download
directions to the vehicle’s navigation system,
if equipped. After the call ends, the
navigation screen will provide prompts to
begin driving directions. Routes that are sent
to the navigation screen can only be
canceled through the navigation system.
See www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca
(Canada).
Connections
The following services help with staying
connected.
For coverage maps, see www.onstar.com
(U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada).
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
258
Connected Services
Ensuring Security
. Change the default passwords for the
Wi-Fi hotspot and myChevrolet mobile
application. Make these passwords
different from each other and use a
combination of letters and numbers to
increase the security.
. Change the default name of the SSID
(Service Set Identifier). This is your
network’s name that is visible to other
wireless devices. Choose a unique name
and avoid family names or vehicle
descriptions.
Wi-Fi Hotspot (If Equipped)
The vehicle may have a built-in Wi-Fi
hotspot that provides access to the Internet
and web content at 4G LTE speed. Up to
seven mobile devices can be connected.
A data plan is required. Use the in-vehicle
controls only when it is safe to do so.
1. To retrieve Wi-Fi hotspot information,
press = to open the OnStar app on the
infotainment display, then select Wi-Fi
Hotspot. On some vehicles, touch Wi-Fi
or Wi-Fi Settings on the screen.
2. The Wi-Fi settings will display the Wi-Fi
hotspot name (SSID), password, and on
some vehicles, the connection type (no
Internet connection, 3G, 4G, 4G LTE), and
signal quality (poor, good, excellent). The
LTE icon shows connection to Wi-Fi. It is
possible that the icon may not illuminate
even though the vehicle has an active
connection.
3. To change the SSID or password, press
Q or call 1-888-4ONSTAR to connect
with an Advisor. On some vehicles, the
SSID and password can be changed in
the Wi-Fi Hotspot menu.
After initial set-up, your vehicle’s Wi-Fi
hotspot will connect automatically to your
mobile devices. Manage data usage by
turning Wi-Fi on or off on your mobile
device, using the myChevrolet mobile app,
or by contacting an OnStar Advisor. On
some vehicles, Wi-Fi can also be managed
from the Wi-Fi Hotspot menu.
MyChevrolet Mobile App (If Available)
Download the myChevrolet mobile app to
compatible Apple and Android smartphones.
Chevrolet users can access the following
services from a smartphone:
. Remotely start/stop the vehicle,
if factory-equipped.
. Lock/unlock doors, if equipped with
automatic locks.
. Activate the horn and lamps.
. Check the vehicle’s fuel level, oil life,
or tire pressure, if factory-equipped with
the Tire Pressure Monitor System.
. Send destinations to the vehicle.
. Locate the vehicle on a map (U.S.
market only).
. Turn the vehicle's Wi-Fi hotspot on/off,
manage settings, and monitor data
consumption, if equipped.
. Locate a dealer and schedule service.
. Request Roadside Assistance.
. Set a parking reminder with pin drop,
take a photo, make a note, and set a
timer.
. Connect with Chevrolet on social media.
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/9/21
Connected Services
Features are subject to change. For
myChevrolet mobile app information and
compatibility, see my.chevrolet.com.
An active OnStar or connected service plan
may be required. A compatible device,
factory-installed remote start, and power
locks are required. Data rates apply. See
www.onstar.com for details and system
limitations.
Remote Services
Contact an OnStar Advisor to unlock the
doors or sound the horn and flash the
lamps.
Marketplace
OnStar Advisors can provide offers from
restaurants and retailers on your route, help
locate hotels, or book a room. These services
vary by market.
Diagnostics
By monitoring and reporting on the vehicle's
key systems, OnStar Advanced Diagnostics,
if equipped, provides a way to keep up on
maintenance. Capabilities vary by model.
See www.onstar.com for details and system
limitations. Features are subject to change.
For updates on feature capabilities, see
my.chevrolet.com. Message and data rates
may apply.
259
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
260
Index
Index
A
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Additional Information
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Additional Maintenance and Care . . . . . . . . .231
Agreements
Trademarks and License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Air Conditioning Regular Operation . . . . . . 120
Air Filter, Passenger Compartment . . . . . . . 120
Air Intake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Airbag System
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . 41
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . 41
What Will You See after an Airbag
Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . 40
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Airbags
Adding Equipment to the Vehicle . . . . . . . 46
Passenger Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Airbags (cont'd)
Servicing Airbag-Equipped Vehicles . . . . . . 45
System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Alarm
Vehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
All-Season Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Antenna
Multi-band . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Appearance Care
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Apple CarPlay and Android Auto . . . . . . . . . .110
Armrest
Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Assistance Program, Roadside . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Audio
Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Automatic
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Emergency Braking (AEB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Headlamp System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Automatic Transmission
Shift Lock Control Function Check . . . . . . 176
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Index
Auxiliary Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Avoiding Untrusted Media Devices . . . . . . . 102
B
Battery
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . 95
Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Battery - North America . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175, 210
Blade Replacement, Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Bluetooth
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106, 107
Bluetooth Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Brake
System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Automatic Emergency (AEB) . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Break-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Bulb Replacement
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal,
Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps . . . . . . 180
Bulb Replacement (cont'd)
High Intensity Discharge (HID)
Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
License Plate Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps,
and Back-up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
179
182
182
201
C
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
California
Perchlorate Materials
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
California Proposition
65 Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175, 210,
Back Cover
Camera
Rear Vision (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Canadian Vehicle Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Carbon Monoxide
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Cargo
Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Tie-Downs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Caution, Danger, and Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
261
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Check
Engine Light (Malfunction Indicator) . . . . 75
Ignition Transmission Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Child Restraints
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Lower Anchors and Tethers for
Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Securing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60, 62
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Cleaning
Exterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Climate Control Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Cluster, Instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Clutch, Hydraulic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Compartments
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
262
Index
Connected Services
Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Connections
Connected Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Control
Traction and Electronic Stability . . . . . . . 145
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Coolant
Engine Temperature Warning Light . . . . . 79
Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Courtesy Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . 245
Cover
Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Covers
Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Customer Information
Publications Ordering Information . . . . . 248
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . .241
Cybersecurity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
D
Damage Repair, Collision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Danger, Warning, and Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Data Collection
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Data Recorders, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Diagnostics
Connected Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Distracted Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Door
Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Power Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Drive Belt Routing, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Driver Assistance Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Driving
Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Driving (cont'd)
If the Vehicle is Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Impaired . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
E
Electrical Equipment, Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Electrical System
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . 185
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Instrument Panel Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Overload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Emergency
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Engine
Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Check Light (Malfunction Indicator) . . . . . 75
Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . 79
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Index
Engine (cont'd)
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Power Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Reduced Power Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Running While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Extended Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Extender, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Exterior Lamps Off Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . 95
F
Filter,
Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Flashers, Hazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Fluid
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System . . . . .152
Frequency Statement
Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Front Fog Lamp
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Front Seat Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Front Seats
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Fuel
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Economy, Driving for Better . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . 158
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Prohibited Fuels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Recommended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Top Tier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Fuses
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . 185
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Instrument Panel Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . 187
263
G
Gas Strut(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Gauges
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Warning Lights and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . 71
General Information
Service and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
GM Mobility Reimbursement
Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
H
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Headlamps
Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . 92
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
264
Index
Headlamps (cont'd)
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal,
Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps . . . . . . 180
High Intensity Discharge (HID)
Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Lamps On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Heated Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Heater
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Hood Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
How to Wear Seat Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . .32
HVAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Hydraulic Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
I
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132, 134
Ignition Transmission Lock Check . . . . . . . . 176
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Indicator
Owner Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Vehicle Ahead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Infants and Young Children, Restraints . . . . 48
Information
Publication Ordering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Interior Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 96
J
Jack
Auxiliary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Jump Starting - North America . . . . . . . . . . . 210
K
Keyless Entry
Remote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 11
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
L
Labeling, Tire Sidewall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Lamps
Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Exterior Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Exterior Lamps Off Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Lamps (cont'd)
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . 95
License Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) . . . 75
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) . . . . . . . . . . .154
Lane Departure Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
LATCH System
Replacing Parts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . 60
LATCH, Lower Anchors and Tethers for
Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
LED Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Lighting
Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Illumination Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Lights
Airbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Antilock Brake System (ABS)
Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Brake System Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Check Engine (Malfunction Indicator) . . . 75
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Index
Lights (cont'd)
Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Engine Coolant Temperature
Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Engine Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Front Fog Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
High-Beam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Hood Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Lane Departure Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Low Fuel Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Operate Pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Reduced Engine Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Seat Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Service Vehicle Soon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
StabiliTrak OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Traction Control System
(TCS)/StabiliTrak . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Traction Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Ultrasonic Parking Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Up-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Warning, Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Locks
Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Locks (cont'd)
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Lower Anchors and Tethers for
Children (LATCH System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
M
Maintenance
Air Conditioning Regular Operation . . . . 120
Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Maintenance and Care
Additional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Manual Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Media
Avoiding Untrusted Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Messages
Engine Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
265
Messages (cont'd)
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86, 87
Vehicle Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Mirrors
Convex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Manual Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Mirrors, Interior Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Monitor System, Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Multi-band Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
N
Navigation
Connected Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
O
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Off-Road
Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Oil
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Older Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
266
Index
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
OnStar Additional Information . . . . . . . . . . . 254
OnStar Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
OnStar Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
OnStar Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Operate Pedal Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Operation
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Outlets
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Owner Manual Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
P
Park
Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Brake and P (Park) Mechanism
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Extended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Parking (cont'd)
Ultrasonic Sensor Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . 74
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . 120
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Perchlorate Materials Requirements,
California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Personalization
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Phone
Apple CarPlay and Android Auto . . . . . . . 110
Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106, 107
Port
USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Power
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Protection, Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Reduced Engine Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Retained Accessory (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Power Steering Warning Lights . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Privacy
Vehicle Data Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Program
Courtesy Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Prohibited Fuels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Proposition 65 Warning,
California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175, 210,
Back Cover
Publication Ordering Information . . . . . . . . 248
R
Radio Frequency Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Radios
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Satellite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Rear Vision Camera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Rear Window Washer/Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Recommended
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . 234
Records
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Reduced Engine Power Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Reimbursement Program, GM
Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Index
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8, 9, 11
Replacement Parts
Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Replacing Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Replacing LATCH System Parts after a
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Replacing Seat Belt System Parts after
a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Reporting Safety Defects
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Restraints
Where to Put . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . .138
Roads
Driving, Wet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Roof
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Routing, Engine Drive Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . 140
S
Safety Defects Reporting
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Safety System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
How to Wear Seat Belts Properly . . . . . . . 32
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Replacing after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Seats
Adjustment, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Heated Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Securing Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60, 62
Security
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Vehicle Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
267
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . 160
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Maintenance Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Maintenance, General Information . . . . . 225
Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Vehicle Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Services
Special Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Servicing the Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Shift Lock Control Function Check,
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Shifting
Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Signals, Turn and Lane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Spare Tire
Compact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Special Application Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Specifications and Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
StabiliTrak
OFF Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
268
Index
Start Assist, Hill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Power, Warning Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Stoplamps and Back-up Lamps
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Storage Areas
Cargo Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Struts
Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
System
Forward Collision Alert (FCA) . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Roof Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Systems
Driver Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
T
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Taillamps
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19, 20
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
All-Season . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . 202
Tires (cont'd)
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . 203
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . 200
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Top Tier Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Towing
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Traction
Control System (TCS)/StabiliTrak
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Traction Control/Electronic Stability
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Trademarks and License Agreements . . . . . . 115
Transmission
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Fluid, Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Transportation Program, Courtesy . . . . . . . 245
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Turn Signal
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Chevrolet Spark Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U.S./Canada-15540556) 2022 - CRC - 4/19/21
Index
U
W
Ultrasonic Parking Sensor Light . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Up-Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
USB Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Using the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Using This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Warning
Brake System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Caution and Danger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Lane Departure (LDW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . 71
Warnings
Hazard Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Wheel Covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Wheels
Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Windshield
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Winter
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Wipers
Rear Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
V
Vehicle
Alarm System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Canadian Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86, 87
Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Service Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Speed Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Vehicle Ahead Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Vehicle Care
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . 250
Ventilation, Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
269
22_CHEV_Spark_COV_en_US_84816219A_2021APR20.pdf 1 4/16/2021 9:58:04 AM
C
M
Y
CM
MY
CY
CMY
K